WO2019171197A1 - 発光素子、表示装置、電子機器、有機化合物及び照明装置 - Google Patents
発光素子、表示装置、電子機器、有機化合物及び照明装置 Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- WO2019171197A1 WO2019171197A1 PCT/IB2019/051403 IB2019051403W WO2019171197A1 WO 2019171197 A1 WO2019171197 A1 WO 2019171197A1 IB 2019051403 W IB2019051403 W IB 2019051403W WO 2019171197 A1 WO2019171197 A1 WO 2019171197A1
- Authority
- WO
- WIPO (PCT)
- Prior art keywords
- light
- compound
- emitting element
- group
- carbon atoms
- Prior art date
Links
- 150000002894 organic compounds Chemical class 0.000 title claims description 106
- 239000000463 material Substances 0.000 claims abstract description 938
- 230000005284 excitation Effects 0.000 claims abstract description 283
- 125000006239 protecting group Chemical group 0.000 claims abstract description 156
- 125000000217 alkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims abstract description 76
- 150000001875 compounds Chemical class 0.000 claims description 373
- -1 diphenylamino group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 169
- 125000004432 carbon atom Chemical group C* 0.000 claims description 152
- 238000000295 emission spectrum Methods 0.000 claims description 113
- 125000003118 aryl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 77
- 125000001072 heteroaryl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 65
- 238000010521 absorption reaction Methods 0.000 claims description 45
- 125000001997 phenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C(*)C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 claims description 43
- 125000000753 cycloalkyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 38
- 125000004665 trialkylsilyl group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 33
- MWPLVEDNUUSJAV-UHFFFAOYSA-N anthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC3=CC=CC=C3C=C21 MWPLVEDNUUSJAV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 29
- 125000004986 diarylamino group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 24
- 229910052799 carbon Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 23
- 230000003111 delayed effect Effects 0.000 claims description 20
- 125000004429 atom Chemical group 0.000 claims description 18
- 239000001257 hydrogen Substances 0.000 claims description 13
- 229910052739 hydrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 claims description 13
- 125000004435 hydrogen atom Chemical class [H]* 0.000 claims description 11
- NRCMAYZCPIVABH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Quinacridone Chemical compound N1C2=CC=CC=C2C(=O)C2=C1C=C1C(=O)C3=CC=CC=C3NC1=C2 NRCMAYZCPIVABH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 10
- OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbon Chemical group [C] OKTJSMMVPCPJKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 9
- 125000002029 aromatic hydrocarbon group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 8
- 125000002080 perylenyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=C2C=CC=C3C4=CC=CC5=CC=CC(C1=C23)=C45)* 0.000 claims description 8
- WDECIBYCCFPHNR-UHFFFAOYSA-N chrysene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC=C3C4=CC=CC=C4C=CC3=C21 WDECIBYCCFPHNR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 6
- BBEAQIROQSPTKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C=CC3=CC=CC4=CC=C1C2=C43 BBEAQIROQSPTKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 6
- XBDYBAVJXHJMNQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tetrahydroanthracene Natural products C1=CC=C2C=C(CCCC3)C3=CC2=C1 XBDYBAVJXHJMNQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 5
- NIHNNTQXNPWCJQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N fluorene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2CC3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 NIHNNTQXNPWCJQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 5
- CSHWQDPOILHKBI-UHFFFAOYSA-N peryrene Natural products C1=CC(C2=CC=CC=3C2=C2C=CC=3)=C3C2=CC=CC3=C1 CSHWQDPOILHKBI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 5
- IFLREYGFSNHWGE-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC3=CC4=CC=CC=C4C=C3C=C21 IFLREYGFSNHWGE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 5
- UFWIBTONFRDIAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Naphthalene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC=CC=C21 UFWIBTONFRDIAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 4
- 150000001721 carbon Chemical class 0.000 claims description 4
- 125000005580 triphenylene group Chemical group 0.000 claims description 4
- GOLORTLGFDVFDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(1h-benzimidazol-2-yl)-7-(diethylamino)chromen-2-one Chemical compound C1=CC=C2NC(C3=CC4=CC=C(C=C4OC3=O)N(CC)CC)=NC2=C1 GOLORTLGFDVFDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 3
- SLGBZMMZGDRARJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Triphenylene Natural products C1=CC=C2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 SLGBZMMZGDRARJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 3
- GVEPBJHOBDJJJI-UHFFFAOYSA-N fluoranthrene Natural products C1=CC(C2=CC=CC=C22)=C3C2=CC=CC3=C1 GVEPBJHOBDJJJI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 claims description 3
- 238000012546 transfer Methods 0.000 abstract description 155
- 230000007246 mechanism Effects 0.000 abstract description 134
- 238000004020 luminiscence type Methods 0.000 abstract description 11
- 239000010410 layer Substances 0.000 description 454
- YXFVVABEGXRONW-UHFFFAOYSA-N Toluene Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC=C1 YXFVVABEGXRONW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 296
- 230000000052 comparative effect Effects 0.000 description 227
- 239000007787 solid Substances 0.000 description 159
- 239000000203 mixture Substances 0.000 description 136
- 238000005481 NMR spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 131
- 238000005259 measurement Methods 0.000 description 113
- VLKZOEOYAKHREP-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-Hexane Chemical compound CCCCCC VLKZOEOYAKHREP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 111
- 230000006870 function Effects 0.000 description 105
- 238000000034 method Methods 0.000 description 100
- GSDQYSSLIKJJOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-chloro-2-(3-chloroanilino)benzoic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CC=C(Cl)C=C1NC1=CC=CC(Cl)=C1 GSDQYSSLIKJJOG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 91
- 239000000758 substrate Substances 0.000 description 91
- 229910052757 nitrogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 81
- 230000005281 excited state Effects 0.000 description 78
- IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Atomic nitrogen Chemical compound N#N IJGRMHOSHXDMSA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 76
- 230000015572 biosynthetic process Effects 0.000 description 71
- 238000003786 synthesis reaction Methods 0.000 description 69
- 239000000370 acceptor Substances 0.000 description 67
- 239000000126 substance Substances 0.000 description 67
- 238000000862 absorption spectrum Methods 0.000 description 58
- 238000004519 manufacturing process Methods 0.000 description 54
- 238000002347 injection Methods 0.000 description 50
- 239000007924 injection Substances 0.000 description 50
- 239000000706 filtrate Substances 0.000 description 48
- 230000009849 deactivation Effects 0.000 description 42
- 238000001194 electroluminescence spectrum Methods 0.000 description 42
- 238000004768 lowest unoccupied molecular orbital Methods 0.000 description 42
- 239000000243 solution Substances 0.000 description 41
- 230000005525 hole transport Effects 0.000 description 40
- MFRIHAYPQRLWNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N sodium tert-butoxide Chemical compound [Na+].CC(C)(C)[O-] MFRIHAYPQRLWNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 40
- 230000002829 reductive effect Effects 0.000 description 39
- 238000003756 stirring Methods 0.000 description 39
- 239000012298 atmosphere Substances 0.000 description 34
- 238000000859 sublimation Methods 0.000 description 34
- 230000008022 sublimation Effects 0.000 description 34
- 239000002904 solvent Substances 0.000 description 33
- 125000001424 substituent group Chemical group 0.000 description 32
- 238000005401 electroluminescence Methods 0.000 description 31
- 230000008569 process Effects 0.000 description 29
- 238000000746 purification Methods 0.000 description 29
- VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicium dioxide Chemical compound O=[Si]=O VYPSYNLAJGMNEJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 28
- XEKOWRVHYACXOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethyl acetate Chemical compound CCOC(C)=O XEKOWRVHYACXOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 27
- 238000006243 chemical reaction Methods 0.000 description 27
- MILUBEOXRNEUHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N iridium(3+) Chemical compound [Ir+3] MILUBEOXRNEUHS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 26
- 239000011521 glass Substances 0.000 description 25
- 229910052751 metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 25
- 239000002184 metal Substances 0.000 description 25
- QJGQUHMNIGDVPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N nitrogen group Chemical group [N] QJGQUHMNIGDVPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 25
- 238000010898 silica gel chromatography Methods 0.000 description 25
- 238000000967 suction filtration Methods 0.000 description 24
- LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ethanol Chemical compound CCO LFQSCWFLJHTTHZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 23
- 239000007983 Tris buffer Substances 0.000 description 23
- 239000003086 colorant Substances 0.000 description 22
- 239000003446 ligand Substances 0.000 description 22
- YMWUJEATGCHHMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dichloromethane Chemical compound ClCCl YMWUJEATGCHHMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 21
- OKKJLVBELUTLKV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methanol Chemical compound OC OKKJLVBELUTLKV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 21
- BASFCYQUMIYNBI-UHFFFAOYSA-N platinum Chemical group [Pt] BASFCYQUMIYNBI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 21
- FKHIFSZMMVMEQY-UHFFFAOYSA-N talc Chemical compound [Mg+2].[O-][Si]([O-])=O FKHIFSZMMVMEQY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 21
- 230000007423 decrease Effects 0.000 description 20
- CNQCVBJFEGMYDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N lawrencium atom Chemical compound [Lr] CNQCVBJFEGMYDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 20
- TWNQGVIAIRXVLR-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxo(oxoalumanyloxy)alumane Chemical compound O=[Al]O[Al]=O TWNQGVIAIRXVLR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 20
- CTQNGGLPUBDAKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N O-Xylene Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC=C1C CTQNGGLPUBDAKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 19
- 239000008096 xylene Substances 0.000 description 19
- 125000005577 anthracene group Chemical group 0.000 description 18
- UKSZBOKPHAQOMP-SVLSSHOZSA-N (1e,4e)-1,5-diphenylpenta-1,4-dien-3-one;palladium Chemical compound [Pd].C=1C=CC=CC=1\C=C\C(=O)\C=C\C1=CC=CC=C1.C=1C=CC=CC=1\C=C\C(=O)\C=C\C1=CC=CC=C1 UKSZBOKPHAQOMP-SVLSSHOZSA-N 0.000 description 17
- 230000001976 improved effect Effects 0.000 description 17
- 238000007789 sealing Methods 0.000 description 17
- 230000002194 synthesizing effect Effects 0.000 description 17
- CUJRVFIICFDLGR-UHFFFAOYSA-N acetylacetonate Chemical compound CC(=O)[CH-]C(C)=O CUJRVFIICFDLGR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 16
- VNFWTIYUKDMAOP-UHFFFAOYSA-N sphos Chemical group COC1=CC=CC(OC)=C1C1=CC=CC=C1P(C1CCCCC1)C1CCCCC1 VNFWTIYUKDMAOP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 16
- 230000007704 transition Effects 0.000 description 16
- KDLHZDBZIXYQEI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Palladium Chemical compound [Pd] KDLHZDBZIXYQEI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 15
- 230000002950 deficient Effects 0.000 description 15
- 229910052741 iridium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 15
- 150000001412 amines Chemical class 0.000 description 14
- 238000010438 heat treatment Methods 0.000 description 14
- UHOVQNZJYSORNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzene Substances C1=CC=CC=C1 UHOVQNZJYSORNB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- 239000002131 composite material Substances 0.000 description 13
- 230000005283 ground state Effects 0.000 description 13
- GKOZUEZYRPOHIO-UHFFFAOYSA-N iridium atom Chemical compound [Ir] GKOZUEZYRPOHIO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 13
- CSNNHWWHGAXBCP-UHFFFAOYSA-L Magnesium sulfate Chemical compound [Mg+2].[O-][S+2]([O-])([O-])[O-] CSNNHWWHGAXBCP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 12
- 238000005859 coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 12
- 238000007872 degassing Methods 0.000 description 12
- 230000002349 favourable effect Effects 0.000 description 12
- 239000003921 oil Substances 0.000 description 12
- 238000006862 quantum yield reaction Methods 0.000 description 12
- 125000005595 acetylacetonate group Chemical group 0.000 description 11
- 150000004945 aromatic hydrocarbons Chemical class 0.000 description 11
- KKEYFWRCBNTPAC-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzene-dicarboxylic acid Natural products OC(=O)C1=CC=C(C(O)=O)C=C1 KKEYFWRCBNTPAC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 11
- 239000000969 carrier Substances 0.000 description 11
- 229920000642 polymer Polymers 0.000 description 11
- 230000006798 recombination Effects 0.000 description 11
- 238000005215 recombination Methods 0.000 description 11
- 238000011084 recovery Methods 0.000 description 11
- 238000005092 sublimation method Methods 0.000 description 11
- ODHXBMXNKOYIBV-UHFFFAOYSA-N triphenylamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 ODHXBMXNKOYIBV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 11
- XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N water Substances O XLYOFNOQVPJJNP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 11
- ZMXDDKWLCZADIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N N,N-Dimethylformamide Chemical compound CN(C)C=O ZMXDDKWLCZADIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- WYURNTSHIVDZCO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tetrahydrofuran Chemical compound C1CCOC1 WYURNTSHIVDZCO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- 229910052782 aluminium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 10
- XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium Chemical class [Al] XAGFODPZIPBFFR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- 125000000484 butyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 10
- 239000000460 chlorine Substances 0.000 description 10
- 238000004140 cleaning Methods 0.000 description 10
- 230000008878 coupling Effects 0.000 description 10
- 238000010168 coupling process Methods 0.000 description 10
- 238000002484 cyclic voltammetry Methods 0.000 description 10
- 230000000694 effects Effects 0.000 description 10
- 238000013213 extrapolation Methods 0.000 description 10
- 238000006722 reduction reaction Methods 0.000 description 10
- 125000000999 tert-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C(*)(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 10
- 238000012360 testing method Methods 0.000 description 10
- BWHDROKFUHTORW-UHFFFAOYSA-N tritert-butylphosphane Chemical compound CC(C)(C)P(C(C)(C)C)C(C)(C)C BWHDROKFUHTORW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 10
- HEDRZPFGACZZDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chloroform Chemical compound ClC(Cl)Cl HEDRZPFGACZZDS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 9
- 150000004982 aromatic amines Chemical group 0.000 description 9
- 150000001502 aryl halides Chemical class 0.000 description 9
- GQVWHWAWLPCBHB-UHFFFAOYSA-L beryllium;benzo[h]quinolin-10-olate Chemical compound [Be+2].C1=CC=NC2=C3C([O-])=CC=CC3=CC=C21.C1=CC=NC2=C3C([O-])=CC=CC3=CC=C21 GQVWHWAWLPCBHB-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 9
- 238000010586 diagram Methods 0.000 description 9
- 238000002189 fluorescence spectrum Methods 0.000 description 9
- 229910052697 platinum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 9
- 238000002360 preparation method Methods 0.000 description 9
- 230000009467 reduction Effects 0.000 description 9
- 239000004020 conductor Substances 0.000 description 8
- 125000000113 cyclohexyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 8
- 125000002524 organometallic group Chemical class 0.000 description 8
- 238000007254 oxidation reaction Methods 0.000 description 8
- 238000001296 phosphorescence spectrum Methods 0.000 description 8
- BWHMMNNQKKPAPP-UHFFFAOYSA-L potassium carbonate Chemical compound [K+].[K+].[O-]C([O-])=O BWHMMNNQKKPAPP-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 8
- 125000002924 primary amino group Chemical group [H]N([H])* 0.000 description 8
- 239000002096 quantum dot Substances 0.000 description 8
- 239000003566 sealing material Substances 0.000 description 8
- JBYBLHYEVCYGME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene Chemical compound C=1C=C2C(Br)=C3C=CC=CC3=C(Br)C2=CC=1C1=CC=CC=C1 JBYBLHYEVCYGME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 7
- REDXJYDRNCIFBQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N aluminium(3+) Chemical compound [Al+3] REDXJYDRNCIFBQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 7
- 125000003277 amino group Chemical group 0.000 description 7
- 125000006267 biphenyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 7
- 239000003153 chemical reaction reagent Substances 0.000 description 7
- 125000005843 halogen group Chemical group 0.000 description 7
- 150000002391 heterocyclic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 7
- 239000012212 insulator Substances 0.000 description 7
- PQXKHYXIUOZZFA-UHFFFAOYSA-M lithium fluoride Chemical compound [Li+].[F-] PQXKHYXIUOZZFA-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 7
- 239000012044 organic layer Substances 0.000 description 7
- 239000011368 organic material Substances 0.000 description 7
- YJVFFLUZDVXJQI-UHFFFAOYSA-L palladium(ii) acetate Chemical compound [Pd+2].CC([O-])=O.CC([O-])=O YJVFFLUZDVXJQI-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 7
- 238000010791 quenching Methods 0.000 description 7
- 230000000171 quenching effect Effects 0.000 description 7
- 238000001228 spectrum Methods 0.000 description 7
- 125000001637 1-naphthyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C2C(*)=C([H])C([H])=C([H])C2=C1[H] 0.000 description 6
- ZVFQEOPUXVPSLB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-tert-butylphenyl)-4-phenyl-5-(4-phenylphenyl)-1,2,4-triazole Chemical compound C1=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C1C(N1C=2C=CC=CC=2)=NN=C1C1=CC=C(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=C1 ZVFQEOPUXVPSLB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- DHDHJYNTEFLIHY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4,7-diphenyl-1,10-phenanthroline Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=NC2=C1C=CC1=C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C=CN=C21 DHDHJYNTEFLIHY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- AZFHXIBNMPIGOD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-hydroxypent-3-en-2-one iridium Chemical compound [Ir].CC(O)=CC(C)=O.CC(O)=CC(C)=O.CC(O)=CC(C)=O AZFHXIBNMPIGOD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Copper Chemical compound [Cu] RYGMFSIKBFXOCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- YLQBMQCUIZJEEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Furan Chemical group C=1C=COC=1 YLQBMQCUIZJEEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- YNPNZTXNASCQKK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phenanthrene Natural products C1=CC=C2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC2=C1 YNPNZTXNASCQKK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- JUJWROOIHBZHMG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyridine Chemical group C1=CC=NC=C1 JUJWROOIHBZHMG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 239000000956 alloy Substances 0.000 description 6
- 229910045601 alloy Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 239000002585 base Substances 0.000 description 6
- 230000008859 change Effects 0.000 description 6
- 238000010549 co-Evaporation Methods 0.000 description 6
- 150000004696 coordination complex Chemical class 0.000 description 6
- 229910052802 copper Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 239000010949 copper Substances 0.000 description 6
- 230000001747 exhibiting effect Effects 0.000 description 6
- 239000000284 extract Substances 0.000 description 6
- 238000004128 high performance liquid chromatography Methods 0.000 description 6
- 239000011229 interlayer Substances 0.000 description 6
- 239000011777 magnesium Substances 0.000 description 6
- 229910052943 magnesium sulfate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 235000019341 magnesium sulphate Nutrition 0.000 description 6
- 229910001507 metal halide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 150000005309 metal halides Chemical class 0.000 description 6
- IBHBKWKFFTZAHE-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-[4-[4-(n-naphthalen-1-ylanilino)phenyl]phenyl]-n-phenylnaphthalen-1-amine Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC=2)C=C1 IBHBKWKFFTZAHE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 125000001624 naphthyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 6
- 230000003647 oxidation Effects 0.000 description 6
- 229910052763 palladium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- LXNAVEXFUKBNMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N palladium(II) acetate Substances [Pd].CC(O)=O.CC(O)=O LXNAVEXFUKBNMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 229920003023 plastic Polymers 0.000 description 6
- 239000004033 plastic Substances 0.000 description 6
- WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N tungsten Chemical compound [W] WFKWXMTUELFFGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 6
- 229910052721 tungsten Inorganic materials 0.000 description 6
- 239000010937 tungsten Substances 0.000 description 6
- GHYOCDFICYLMRF-UTIIJYGPSA-N (2S,3R)-N-[(2S)-3-(cyclopenten-1-yl)-1-[(2R)-2-methyloxiran-2-yl]-1-oxopropan-2-yl]-3-hydroxy-3-(4-methoxyphenyl)-2-[[(2S)-2-[(2-morpholin-4-ylacetyl)amino]propanoyl]amino]propanamide Chemical compound C1(=CCCC1)C[C@@H](C(=O)[C@@]1(OC1)C)NC([C@H]([C@@H](C1=CC=C(C=C1)OC)O)NC([C@H](C)NC(CN1CCOCC1)=O)=O)=O GHYOCDFICYLMRF-UTIIJYGPSA-N 0.000 description 5
- FQJQNLKWTRGIEB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(4-tert-butylphenyl)-5-[3-[5-(4-tert-butylphenyl)-1,3,4-oxadiazol-2-yl]phenyl]-1,3,4-oxadiazole Chemical compound C1=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C1C1=NN=C(C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C=2OC(=NN=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C(C)(C)C)O1 FQJQNLKWTRGIEB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- GEQBRULPNIVQPP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-[3,5-bis(1-phenylbenzimidazol-2-yl)phenyl]-1-phenylbenzimidazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N1C2=CC=CC=C2N=C1C1=CC(C=2N(C3=CC=CC=C3N=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)=CC(C=2N(C3=CC=CC=C3N=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)=C1 GEQBRULPNIVQPP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- WBPXZSIKOVBSAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-tert-butylanthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC3=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C3C=C21 WBPXZSIKOVBSAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- MJKNHXCPGXUEDO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-ditert-butylaniline Chemical compound CC(C)(C)C1=CC(N)=CC(C(C)(C)C)=C1 MJKNHXCPGXUEDO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- FWXNJWAXBVMBGL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-n,9-n,10-n,10-n-tetrakis(4-methylphenyl)anthracene-9,10-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC(C)=CC=C1N(C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C(N(C=2C=CC(C)=CC=2)C=2C=CC(C)=CC=2)=C2C=CC=CC2=1)C1=CC=C(C)C=C1 FWXNJWAXBVMBGL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-O Ammonium Chemical compound [NH4+] QGZKDVFQNNGYKY-UHFFFAOYSA-O 0.000 description 5
- 229910008449 SnF 2 Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- 102000003978 Tissue Plasminogen Activator Human genes 0.000 description 5
- 108090000373 Tissue Plasminogen Activator Proteins 0.000 description 5
- XLOMVQKBTHCTTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc monoxide Chemical compound [Zn]=O XLOMVQKBTHCTTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 125000000732 arylene group Chemical group 0.000 description 5
- WZJYKHNJTSNBHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzo[h]quinoline Chemical compound C1=CN=C2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC2=C1 WZJYKHNJTSNBHV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 150000001716 carbazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 5
- 238000004040 coloring Methods 0.000 description 5
- 229940125797 compound 12 Drugs 0.000 description 5
- 125000006575 electron-withdrawing group Chemical group 0.000 description 5
- 238000001914 filtration Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000005484 gravity Effects 0.000 description 5
- 229910052736 halogen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 5
- AMGQUBHHOARCQH-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium;oxotin Chemical compound [In].[Sn]=O AMGQUBHHOARCQH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 125000001449 isopropyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 5
- 238000004776 molecular orbital Methods 0.000 description 5
- 230000003287 optical effect Effects 0.000 description 5
- 229920003227 poly(N-vinyl carbazole) Polymers 0.000 description 5
- 239000000047 product Substances 0.000 description 5
- 125000000714 pyrimidinyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 5
- HPALAKNZSZLMCH-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium;chloride;hydrate Chemical class O.[Na+].[Cl-] HPALAKNZSZLMCH-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 5
- PJANXHGTPQOBST-UHFFFAOYSA-N stilbene Chemical group C=1C=CC=CC=1C=CC1=CC=CC=C1 PJANXHGTPQOBST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- 125000000026 trimethylsilyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])[Si]([*])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 5
- COIOYMYWGDAQPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N tris(2-methylphenyl)phosphane Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C(=CC=CC=1)C)C1=CC=CC=C1C COIOYMYWGDAQPM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 5
- SZUVGFMDDVSKSI-WIFOCOSTSA-N (1s,2s,3s,5r)-1-(carboxymethyl)-3,5-bis[(4-phenoxyphenyl)methyl-propylcarbamoyl]cyclopentane-1,2-dicarboxylic acid Chemical compound O=C([C@@H]1[C@@H]([C@](CC(O)=O)([C@H](C(=O)N(CCC)CC=2C=CC(OC=3C=CC=CC=3)=CC=2)C1)C(O)=O)C(O)=O)N(CCC)CC(C=C1)=CC=C1OC1=CC=CC=C1 SZUVGFMDDVSKSI-WIFOCOSTSA-N 0.000 description 4
- MMRNFHSFEKCKAN-UHFFFAOYSA-N (3,5-dicyclohexylphenyl) trifluoromethanesulfonate Chemical compound FC(F)(F)S(=O)(=O)Oc1cc(cc(c1)C1CCCCC1)C1CCCCC1 MMRNFHSFEKCKAN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- UHXOHPVVEHBKKT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(2,2-diphenylethenyl)-4-[4-(2,2-diphenylethenyl)phenyl]benzene Chemical group C=1C=C(C=2C=CC(C=C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C=3C=CC=CC=3)=CC=2)C=CC=1C=C(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 UHXOHPVVEHBKKT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- HDMYKJVSQIHZLM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-[3,5-di(pyren-1-yl)phenyl]pyrene Chemical compound C1=CC(C=2C=C(C=C(C=2)C=2C3=CC=C4C=CC=C5C=CC(C3=C54)=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=C4C=CC=C5C=CC(C3=C54)=CC=2)=C2C=CC3=CC=CC4=CC=C1C2=C43 HDMYKJVSQIHZLM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- XESMNQMWRSEIET-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,9-dinaphthalen-2-yl-4,7-diphenyl-1,10-phenanthroline Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC(C=2C=C3C=CC=CC3=CC=2)=NC2=C1C=CC1=C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C=C(C=3C=C4C=CC=CC4=CC=3)N=C21 XESMNQMWRSEIET-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- VIZUPBYFLORCRA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-dinaphthalen-2-ylanthracene Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C(C2=CC3=CC=CC=C3C=C2)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1 VIZUPBYFLORCRA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- FCNCGHJSNVOIKE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-diphenylanthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 FCNCGHJSNVOIKE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- SXGIRTCIFPJUEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-anthracen-9-ylanthracene Chemical group C1=CC=CC2=CC3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C=C4C=CC=CC4=3)=C21 SXGIRTCIFPJUEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Dimethylsulphoxide Chemical compound CS(C)=O IAZDPXIOMUYVGZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- PAYRUJLWNCNPSJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-phenyl amine Natural products NC1=CC=CC=C1 PAYRUJLWNCNPSJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- SMWDFEZZVXVKRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Quinoline Chemical compound N1=CC=CC2=CC=CC=C21 SMWDFEZZVXVKRB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silicon Chemical compound [Si] XUIMIQQOPSSXEZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- CDBYLPFSWZWCQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L Sodium Carbonate Chemical compound [Na+].[Na+].[O-]C([O-])=O CDBYLPFSWZWCQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 4
- NRTOMJZYCJJWKI-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titanium nitride Chemical compound [Ti]#N NRTOMJZYCJJWKI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- HEDRZPFGACZZDS-MICDWDOJSA-N Trichloro(2H)methane Chemical compound [2H]C(Cl)(Cl)Cl HEDRZPFGACZZDS-MICDWDOJSA-N 0.000 description 4
- LNUFLCYMSVYYNW-ZPJMAFJPSA-N [(2r,3r,4s,5r,6r)-2-[(2r,3r,4s,5r,6r)-6-[(2r,3r,4s,5r,6r)-6-[(2r,3r,4s,5r,6r)-6-[[(3s,5s,8r,9s,10s,13r,14s,17r)-10,13-dimethyl-17-[(2r)-6-methylheptan-2-yl]-2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,11,12,14,15,16,17-tetradecahydro-1h-cyclopenta[a]phenanthren-3-yl]oxy]-4,5-disulfo Chemical compound O([C@@H]1[C@@H](COS(O)(=O)=O)O[C@@H]([C@@H]([C@H]1OS(O)(=O)=O)OS(O)(=O)=O)O[C@@H]1[C@@H](COS(O)(=O)=O)O[C@@H]([C@@H]([C@H]1OS(O)(=O)=O)OS(O)(=O)=O)O[C@@H]1[C@@H](COS(O)(=O)=O)O[C@H]([C@@H]([C@H]1OS(O)(=O)=O)OS(O)(=O)=O)O[C@@H]1C[C@@H]2CC[C@H]3[C@@H]4CC[C@@H]([C@]4(CC[C@@H]3[C@@]2(C)CC1)C)[C@H](C)CCCC(C)C)[C@H]1O[C@H](COS(O)(=O)=O)[C@@H](OS(O)(=O)=O)[C@H](OS(O)(=O)=O)[C@H]1OS(O)(=O)=O LNUFLCYMSVYYNW-ZPJMAFJPSA-N 0.000 description 4
- SORGEQQSQGNZFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N [azido(phenoxy)phosphoryl]oxybenzene Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1OP(=O)(N=[N+]=[N-])OC1=CC=CC=C1 SORGEQQSQGNZFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000002947 alkylene group Chemical group 0.000 description 4
- JFDZBHWFFUWGJE-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzonitrile Chemical compound N#CC1=CC=CC=C1 JFDZBHWFFUWGJE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- FJDQFPXHSGXQBY-UHFFFAOYSA-L caesium carbonate Chemical compound [Cs+].[Cs+].[O-]C([O-])=O FJDQFPXHSGXQBY-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 4
- 229910000024 caesium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- XJHCXCQVJFPJIK-UHFFFAOYSA-M caesium fluoride Chemical compound [F-].[Cs+] XJHCXCQVJFPJIK-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 4
- 229910052791 calcium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 239000011575 calcium Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229940125904 compound 1 Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 229940126543 compound 14 Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 229940125782 compound 2 Drugs 0.000 description 4
- 229940126214 compound 3 Drugs 0.000 description 4
- VPUGDVKSAQVFFS-UHFFFAOYSA-N coronene Chemical compound C1=C(C2=C34)C=CC3=CC=C(C=C3)C4=C4C3=CC=C(C=C3)C4=C2C3=C1 VPUGDVKSAQVFFS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000004093 cyano group Chemical group *C#N 0.000 description 4
- 150000004985 diamines Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- IYYZUPMFVPLQIF-UHFFFAOYSA-N dibenzothiophene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C3=CC=CC=C3SC2=C1 IYYZUPMFVPLQIF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- IYYZUPMFVPLQIF-ALWQSETLSA-N dibenzothiophene Chemical group C1=CC=CC=2[34S]C3=C(C=21)C=CC=C3 IYYZUPMFVPLQIF-ALWQSETLSA-N 0.000 description 4
- ZUOUZKKEUPVFJK-UHFFFAOYSA-N diphenyl Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 ZUOUZKKEUPVFJK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- GUVUOGQBMYCBQP-UHFFFAOYSA-N dmpu Chemical compound CN1CCCN(C)C1=O GUVUOGQBMYCBQP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 125000003983 fluorenyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC=2C3=CC=CC=C3CC12)* 0.000 description 4
- 125000005549 heteroarylene group Chemical group 0.000 description 4
- AMWRITDGCCNYAT-UHFFFAOYSA-L hydroxy(oxo)manganese;manganese Chemical compound [Mn].O[Mn]=O.O[Mn]=O AMWRITDGCCNYAT-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 4
- 239000012535 impurity Substances 0.000 description 4
- 125000000959 isobutyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 4
- 229910052749 magnesium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 239000011159 matrix material Substances 0.000 description 4
- 238000000691 measurement method Methods 0.000 description 4
- 150000002739 metals Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 125000002496 methyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 4
- 238000002156 mixing Methods 0.000 description 4
- 230000033116 oxidation-reduction process Effects 0.000 description 4
- 125000000843 phenylene group Chemical group C1(=C(C=CC=C1)*)* 0.000 description 4
- IEQIEDJGQAUEQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N phthalocyanine Chemical class N1C(N=C2C3=CC=CC=C3C(N=C3C4=CC=CC=C4C(=N4)N3)=N2)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1N=C1C2=CC=CC=C2C4=N1 IEQIEDJGQAUEQZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 4
- 229920000728 polyester Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 229910000027 potassium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 125000003373 pyrazinyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 4
- 150000003220 pyrenes Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 239000010453 quartz Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052761 rare earth metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 150000002910 rare earth metals Chemical class 0.000 description 4
- 238000010992 reflux Methods 0.000 description 4
- 229920005989 resin Polymers 0.000 description 4
- 239000011347 resin Substances 0.000 description 4
- 230000002441 reversible effect Effects 0.000 description 4
- 239000000565 sealant Substances 0.000 description 4
- 229910052710 silicon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 4
- 239000010703 silicon Substances 0.000 description 4
- 239000002356 single layer Substances 0.000 description 4
- 125000000391 vinyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])=C([H])[H] 0.000 description 4
- AOSZTAHDEDLTLQ-AZKQZHLXSA-N (1S,2S,4R,8S,9S,11S,12R,13S,19S)-6-[(3-chlorophenyl)methyl]-12,19-difluoro-11-hydroxy-8-(2-hydroxyacetyl)-9,13-dimethyl-6-azapentacyclo[10.8.0.02,9.04,8.013,18]icosa-14,17-dien-16-one Chemical compound C([C@@H]1C[C@H]2[C@H]3[C@]([C@]4(C=CC(=O)C=C4[C@@H](F)C3)C)(F)[C@@H](O)C[C@@]2([C@@]1(C1)C(=O)CO)C)N1CC1=CC=CC(Cl)=C1 AOSZTAHDEDLTLQ-AZKQZHLXSA-N 0.000 description 3
- QFLWZFQWSBQYPS-AWRAUJHKSA-N (3S)-3-[[(2S)-2-[[(2S)-2-[5-[(3aS,6aR)-2-oxo-1,3,3a,4,6,6a-hexahydrothieno[3,4-d]imidazol-4-yl]pentanoylamino]-3-methylbutanoyl]amino]-3-(4-hydroxyphenyl)propanoyl]amino]-4-[1-bis(4-chlorophenoxy)phosphorylbutylamino]-4-oxobutanoic acid Chemical compound CCCC(NC(=O)[C@H](CC(O)=O)NC(=O)[C@H](Cc1ccc(O)cc1)NC(=O)[C@@H](NC(=O)CCCCC1SC[C@@H]2NC(=O)N[C@H]12)C(C)C)P(=O)(Oc1ccc(Cl)cc1)Oc1ccc(Cl)cc1 QFLWZFQWSBQYPS-AWRAUJHKSA-N 0.000 description 3
- CQLOFDJXHRKXKS-UHFFFAOYSA-N (9,10-dibromoanthracen-2-yl)-trimethylsilane Chemical compound BrC=1C2=CC=CC=C2C(=C2C=CC(=CC=12)[Si](C)(C)C)Br CQLOFDJXHRKXKS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- UNILWMWFPHPYOR-KXEYIPSPSA-M 1-[6-[2-[3-[3-[3-[2-[2-[3-[[2-[2-[[(2r)-1-[[2-[[(2r)-1-[3-[2-[2-[3-[[2-(2-amino-2-oxoethoxy)acetyl]amino]propoxy]ethoxy]ethoxy]propylamino]-3-hydroxy-1-oxopropan-2-yl]amino]-2-oxoethyl]amino]-3-[(2r)-2,3-di(hexadecanoyloxy)propyl]sulfanyl-1-oxopropan-2-yl Chemical compound O=C1C(SCCC(=O)NCCCOCCOCCOCCCNC(=O)COCC(=O)N[C@@H](CSC[C@@H](COC(=O)CCCCCCCCCCCCCCC)OC(=O)CCCCCCCCCCCCCCC)C(=O)NCC(=O)N[C@H](CO)C(=O)NCCCOCCOCCOCCCNC(=O)COCC(N)=O)CC(=O)N1CCNC(=O)CCCCCN\1C2=CC=C(S([O-])(=O)=O)C=C2CC/1=C/C=C/C=C/C1=[N+](CC)C2=CC=C(S([O-])(=O)=O)C=C2C1 UNILWMWFPHPYOR-KXEYIPSPSA-M 0.000 description 3
- BUOWTUULDKULFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-bromo-3,5-ditert-butylbenzene Chemical compound CC(C)(C)C1=CC(Br)=CC(C(C)(C)C)=C1 BUOWTUULDKULFI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- DZZVYTDZXIORSS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-chloro-3,5-bis(4-cyclohexylphenyl)benzene Chemical compound Clc1cc(cc(c1)-c1ccc(cc1)C1CCCCC1)-c1ccc(cc1)C1CCCCC1 DZZVYTDZXIORSS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- QWENRTYMTSOGBR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1H-1,2,3-Triazole Chemical compound C=1C=NNN=1 QWENRTYMTSOGBR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- STTGYIUESPWXOW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,9-dimethyl-4,7-diphenyl-1,10-phenanthroline Chemical compound C=12C=CC3=C(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C=C(C)N=C3C2=NC(C)=CC=1C1=CC=CC=C1 STTGYIUESPWXOW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- UOCMXZLNHQBBOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(1,3-benzoxazol-2-yl)phenol zinc Chemical compound [Zn].Oc1ccccc1-c1nc2ccccc2o1.Oc1ccccc1-c1nc2ccccc2o1 UOCMXZLNHQBBOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZWEHNKRNPOVVGH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-Butanone Chemical compound CCC(C)=O ZWEHNKRNPOVVGH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- OBAJPWYDYFEBTF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-tert-butyl-9,10-dinaphthalen-2-ylanthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC(C3=C4C=CC=CC4=C(C=4C=C5C=CC=CC5=CC=4)C4=CC=C(C=C43)C(C)(C)C)=CC=C21 OBAJPWYDYFEBTF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- XOSNVHRFXASOIK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-bis(4-cyclohexylphenyl)aniline Chemical compound Nc1cc(cc(c1)-c1ccc(cc1)C1CCCCC1)-c1ccc(cc1)C1CCCCC1 XOSNVHRFXASOIK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- CINYXYWQPZSTOT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-[3-[3,5-bis(3-pyridin-3-ylphenyl)phenyl]phenyl]pyridine Chemical compound C1=CN=CC(C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C=2C=C(C=C(C=2)C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C=2C=NC=CC=2)C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C=2C=NC=CC=2)=C1 CINYXYWQPZSTOT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- OGGKVJMNFFSDEV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-methyl-n-[4-[4-(n-(3-methylphenyl)anilino)phenyl]phenyl]-n-phenylaniline Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=C(C)C=CC=2)=C1 OGGKVJMNFFSDEV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- USIXUMGAHVBSHQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-bis(3,5-diphenylphenyl)anthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC(C=2C=CC=CC=2)=CC(C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C=C(C=C(C=3)C=3C=CC=CC=3)C=3C=CC=CC=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=2)=C1 USIXUMGAHVBSHQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- VDHOGVHFPFGPIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[3-[5-(3-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)pyridin-3-yl]phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC(C=2C=NC=C(C=2)C=2C=CC=C(C=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)=CC=C1 VDHOGVHFPFGPIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- WKBOTKDWSSQWDR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Bromine atom Chemical compound [Br] WKBOTKDWSSQWDR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 238000006443 Buchwald-Hartwig cross coupling reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- OJRUSAPKCPIVBY-KQYNXXCUSA-N C1=NC2=C(N=C(N=C2N1[C@H]3[C@@H]([C@@H]([C@H](O3)COP(=O)(CP(=O)(O)O)O)O)O)I)N Chemical compound C1=NC2=C(N=C(N=C2N1[C@H]3[C@@H]([C@@H]([C@H](O3)COP(=O)(CP(=O)(O)O)O)O)O)I)N OJRUSAPKCPIVBY-KQYNXXCUSA-N 0.000 description 3
- OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N Calcium Chemical compound [Ca] OYPRJOBELJOOCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chlorine atom Chemical compound [Cl] ZAMOUSCENKQFHK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229940126657 Compound 17 Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 108091006149 Electron carriers Proteins 0.000 description 3
- UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrogen Chemical compound [H][H] UFHFLCQGNIYNRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N Magnesium Chemical compound [Mg] FYYHWMGAXLPEAU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZCQWOFVYLHDMMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Oxazole Chemical compound C1=COC=N1 ZCQWOFVYLHDMMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- FZWLAAWBMGSTSO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Thiazole Chemical compound C1=CSC=N1 FZWLAAWBMGSTSO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- YTPLMLYBLZKORZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N Thiophene Chemical group C=1C=CSC=1 YTPLMLYBLZKORZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ZMANZCXQSJIPKH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Triethylamine Chemical compound CCN(CC)CC ZMANZCXQSJIPKH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 238000006887 Ullmann reaction Methods 0.000 description 3
- DGEZNRSVGBDHLK-UHFFFAOYSA-N [1,10]phenanthroline Chemical compound C1=CN=C2C3=NC=CC=C3C=CC2=C1 DGEZNRSVGBDHLK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- ITOKSWHFPQBNSE-UHFFFAOYSA-N [1]benzofuro[3,2-d]pyrimidine Chemical group N1=CN=C2C3=CC=CC=C3OC2=C1 ITOKSWHFPQBNSE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 230000001133 acceleration Effects 0.000 description 3
- FZEYVTFCMJSGMP-UHFFFAOYSA-N acridone Chemical group C1=CC=C2C(=O)C3=CC=CC=C3NC2=C1 FZEYVTFCMJSGMP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- NIXOWILDQLNWCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N acrylic acid group Chemical group C(C=C)(=O)O NIXOWILDQLNWCW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229910052783 alkali metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 150000001340 alkali metals Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 150000001454 anthracenes Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 230000004888 barrier function Effects 0.000 description 3
- 125000005605 benzo group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 230000008033 biological extinction Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000004305 biphenyl Substances 0.000 description 3
- UFVXQDWNSAGPHN-UHFFFAOYSA-K bis[(2-methylquinolin-8-yl)oxy]-(4-phenylphenoxy)alumane Chemical compound [Al+3].C1=CC=C([O-])C2=NC(C)=CC=C21.C1=CC=C([O-])C2=NC(C)=CC=C21.C1=CC([O-])=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 UFVXQDWNSAGPHN-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 3
- GDTBXPJZTBHREO-UHFFFAOYSA-N bromine Substances BrBr GDTBXPJZTBHREO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229910052794 bromium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- XZCJVWCMJYNSQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N butyl pbd Chemical compound C1=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C1C1=NN=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)O1 XZCJVWCMJYNSQO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 229910052801 chlorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 150000001846 chrysenes Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 239000012230 colorless oil Substances 0.000 description 3
- 238000004891 communication Methods 0.000 description 3
- 229940125758 compound 15 Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 229940125898 compound 5 Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 125000001511 cyclopentyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 3
- 239000000412 dendrimer Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229920000736 dendritic polymer Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 238000013461 design Methods 0.000 description 3
- 238000011161 development Methods 0.000 description 3
- GQDKQZAEQBGVBS-UHFFFAOYSA-N dibenzo[g,p]chrysene Chemical class C1=CC=CC2=C3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C3=C(C=CC=C3)C3=C21 GQDKQZAEQBGVBS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- TXCDCPKCNAJMEE-UHFFFAOYSA-N dibenzofuran Chemical group C1=CC=C2C3=CC=CC=C3OC2=C1 TXCDCPKCNAJMEE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- WMKGGPCROCCUDY-PHEQNACWSA-N dibenzylideneacetone Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1\C=C\C(=O)\C=C\C1=CC=CC=C1 WMKGGPCROCCUDY-PHEQNACWSA-N 0.000 description 3
- DKHNGUNXLDCATP-UHFFFAOYSA-N dipyrazino[2,3-f:2',3'-h]quinoxaline-2,3,6,7,10,11-hexacarbonitrile Chemical group C12=NC(C#N)=C(C#N)N=C2C2=NC(C#N)=C(C#N)N=C2C2=C1N=C(C#N)C(C#N)=N2 DKHNGUNXLDCATP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000000428 dust Substances 0.000 description 3
- 125000005678 ethenylene group Chemical group [H]C([*:1])=C([H])[*:2] 0.000 description 3
- 125000001495 ethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 3
- 238000001704 evaporation Methods 0.000 description 3
- 125000004051 hexyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 3
- 150000002430 hydrocarbons Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- RAXXELZNTBOGNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N imidazole Natural products C1=CNC=N1 RAXXELZNTBOGNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 125000002883 imidazolyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 229910003437 indium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- PJXISJQVUVHSOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium(iii) oxide Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[In+3].[In+3] PJXISJQVUVHSOJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 150000007529 inorganic bases Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 230000003993 interaction Effects 0.000 description 3
- 239000002346 layers by function Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910052744 lithium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 229910021645 metal ion Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 229910000476 molybdenum oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- JKQOBWVOAYFWKG-UHFFFAOYSA-N molybdenum trioxide Chemical compound O=[Mo](=O)=O JKQOBWVOAYFWKG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 239000002086 nanomaterial Substances 0.000 description 3
- 239000012299 nitrogen atmosphere Substances 0.000 description 3
- 125000003261 o-tolyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(*)=C(C([H])=C1[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 3
- 229910052762 osmium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 150000004866 oxadiazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- PQQKPALAQIIWST-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxomolybdenum Chemical compound [Mo]=O PQQKPALAQIIWST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- NFHFRUOZVGFOOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N palladium;triphenylphosphane Chemical compound [Pd].C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 NFHFRUOZVGFOOS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 3
- 125000001147 pentyl group Chemical group C(CCCC)* 0.000 description 3
- 150000002987 phenanthrenes Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 150000005041 phenanthrolines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 125000001484 phenothiazinyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC=2SC3=CC=CC=C3NC12)* 0.000 description 3
- 125000001644 phenoxazinyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC=2OC3=CC=CC=C3NC12)* 0.000 description 3
- 229920002620 polyvinyl fluoride Polymers 0.000 description 3
- 150000004032 porphyrins Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- TYJJADVDDVDEDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-M potassium hydrogencarbonate Chemical compound [K+].OC([O-])=O TYJJADVDDVDEDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 3
- 125000001436 propyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 3
- 125000005581 pyrene group Chemical group 0.000 description 3
- 150000003222 pyridines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 229940083082 pyrimidine derivative acting on arteriolar smooth muscle Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 150000003230 pyrimidines Chemical class 0.000 description 3
- 239000010948 rhodium Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229910052707 ruthenium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 229930195734 saturated hydrocarbon Natural products 0.000 description 3
- 125000002914 sec-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 3
- 239000004065 semiconductor Substances 0.000 description 3
- 229940042055 systemic antimycotics triazole derivative Drugs 0.000 description 3
- 229910052723 transition metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 229910000314 transition metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 3
- 238000007740 vapor deposition Methods 0.000 description 3
- 239000011701 zinc Substances 0.000 description 3
- HTPBWAPZAJWXKY-UHFFFAOYSA-L zinc;quinolin-8-olate Chemical compound [Zn+2].C1=CN=C2C([O-])=CC=CC2=C1.C1=CN=C2C([O-])=CC=CC2=C1 HTPBWAPZAJWXKY-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 3
- JYEUMXHLPRZUAT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,3-triazine Chemical group C1=CN=NN=C1 JYEUMXHLPRZUAT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- RYHBNJHYFVUHQT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,4-Dioxane Chemical compound C1COCCO1 RYHBNJHYFVUHQT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ONBQEOIKXPHGMB-VBSBHUPXSA-N 1-[2-[(2s,3r,4s,5r)-3,4-dihydroxy-5-(hydroxymethyl)oxolan-2-yl]oxy-4,6-dihydroxyphenyl]-3-(4-hydroxyphenyl)propan-1-one Chemical compound O[C@@H]1[C@H](O)[C@@H](CO)O[C@H]1OC1=CC(O)=CC(O)=C1C(=O)CCC1=CC=C(O)C=C1 ONBQEOIKXPHGMB-VBSBHUPXSA-N 0.000 description 2
- IYZMXHQDXZKNCY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-n,1-n-diphenyl-4-n,4-n-bis[4-(n-phenylanilino)phenyl]benzene-1,4-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 IYZMXHQDXZKNCY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SPDPTFAJSFKAMT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-n-[4-[4-(n-[4-(3-methyl-n-(3-methylphenyl)anilino)phenyl]anilino)phenyl]phenyl]-4-n,4-n-bis(3-methylphenyl)-1-n-phenylbenzene-1,4-diamine Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC(N(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=C(C)C=CC=2)C=2C=C(C)C=CC=2)C=2C=C(C)C=CC=2)=C1 SPDPTFAJSFKAMT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ZABORCXHTNWZRV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 10-[4-(4,6-diphenyl-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl]phenoxazine Chemical compound O1C2=CC=CC=C2N(C2=CC=C(C=C2)C2=NC(=NC(=N2)C2=CC=CC=C2)C2=CC=CC=C2)C2=C1C=CC=C2 ZABORCXHTNWZRV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ASXSTQHYXCIZRV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 10-phenylspiro[acridine-9,10'-anthracene]-9'-one Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C(=O)C2=CC=CC=C2C1(C1=CC=CC=C11)C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=CC=C1 ASXSTQHYXCIZRV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- YRAJNWYBUCUFBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,2,6,6-tetramethylheptane-3,5-dione Chemical compound CC(C)(C)C(=O)CC(=O)C(C)(C)C YRAJNWYBUCUFBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- OOWLPGTVRWFLCX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,3,6,7-tetramethyl-9,10-dinaphthalen-1-ylanthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C=3C4=CC(C)=C(C)C=C4C(C=4C5=CC=CC=C5C=CC=4)=C4C=C(C(=CC4=3)C)C)=CC=CC2=C1 OOWLPGTVRWFLCX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- ZNMPPGWFJMSOPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,6-ditert-butylanthracene Chemical compound C1=C(C(C)(C)C)C=CC2=CC3=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C3C=C21 ZNMPPGWFJMSOPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- TYHPJCMZSCFGIX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(4-cyclohexylphenyl)-4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane Chemical compound O1C(C)(C)C(C)(C)OB1C1=CC=C(C2CCCCC2)C=C1 TYHPJCMZSCFGIX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- MNHPNCZSKTUPMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-tert-butyl-9,10-bis(4-phenylphenyl)anthracene Chemical compound C=12C=CC=CC2=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C2=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C2C=1C(C=C1)=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 MNHPNCZSKTUPMB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SLULKICAUPNLOM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-bis(3,5-ditert-butylphenyl)aniline Chemical compound C(C)(C)(C)C=1C=C(C=C(C=1)C(C)(C)C)C=1C=C(N)C=C(C=1)C1=CC(=CC(=C1)C(C)(C)C)C(C)(C)C SLULKICAUPNLOM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- RVNUUWJGSOHMRR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-dibromoaniline Chemical compound NC1=CC(Br)=CC(Br)=C1 RVNUUWJGSOHMRR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- BNVUXDJFSPYUKP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-ditert-butyl-N,N-diphenylaniline Chemical compound CC(C)(C)c1cc(cc(c1)C(C)(C)C)N(c1ccccc1)c1ccccc1 BNVUXDJFSPYUKP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- GRTDQSRHHHDWSQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,6-diphenyl-9-[4-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=2)C=2C3=CC(=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C3=C1 GRTDQSRHHHDWSQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LGDCSNDMFFFSHY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-butyl-n,n-diphenylaniline Polymers C1=CC(CCCC)=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 LGDCSNDMFFFSHY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- OPEKHRGERHDLRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-tert-butyl-n-(4-tert-butylphenyl)aniline Chemical compound C1=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C1NC1=CC=C(C(C)(C)C)C=C1 OPEKHRGERHDLRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- AEJARLYXNFRVLK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4H-1,2,3-triazole Chemical compound C1C=NN=N1 AEJARLYXNFRVLK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- MWQDBYKWEGXSJW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 6,12-dimethoxy-5,11-diphenylchrysene Chemical compound C12=C3C=CC=CC3=C(OC)C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)=C2C2=CC=CC=C2C(OC)=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 MWQDBYKWEGXSJW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NKEZXXDRXPPROK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-bis(2-naphthalen-1-ylphenyl)anthracene Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C(C2=CC=CC=C2C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC=2)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC2=CC=CC=C12 NKEZXXDRXPPROK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- BITWULPDIGXQDL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-bis[4-(2,2-diphenylethenyl)phenyl]anthracene Chemical compound C=1C=C(C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C=CC(C=C(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C=4C=CC=CC=4)=CC=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=2)C=CC=1C=C(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 BITWULPDIGXQDL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- DTGCMKMICLCAQU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[3-[2-(3-phenanthren-9-ylphenyl)ethenyl]phenyl]phenanthrene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C=3C=CC=C(C=3)C=CC=3C=C(C=CC=3)C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C=3)=CC3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 DTGCMKMICLCAQU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- UQVFZEYHQJJGPD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[4-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=C(N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=C1 UQVFZEYHQJJGPD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- VFUDMQLBKNMONU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[4-(4-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)phenyl]carbazole Chemical group C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=C1 VFUDMQLBKNMONU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- HOGUGXVETSOMRE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[4-[2-(4-phenanthren-9-ylphenyl)ethenyl]phenyl]phenanthrene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C3=CC=C(C=C3)C=CC=3C=CC(=CC=3)C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C=3)=CC3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 HOGUGXVETSOMRE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- NBYGJKGEGNTQBK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-phenyl-10-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)anthracene Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 NBYGJKGEGNTQBK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910017073 AlLi Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- XKRFYHLGVUSROY-UHFFFAOYSA-N Argon Chemical compound [Ar] XKRFYHLGVUSROY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 102100025982 BMP/retinoic acid-inducible neural-specific protein 1 Human genes 0.000 description 2
- ROFVEXUMMXZLPA-UHFFFAOYSA-N Bipyridyl Chemical class N1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=N1 ROFVEXUMMXZLPA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- UJOBWOGCFQCDNV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Carbazole Natural products C1=CC=C2C3=CC=CC=C3NC2=C1 UJOBWOGCFQCDNV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- VYZAMTAEIAYCRO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Chromium Chemical compound [Cr] VYZAMTAEIAYCRO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000005749 Copper compound Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920002430 Fibre-reinforced plastic Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 108010043121 Green Fluorescent Proteins Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 101000933342 Homo sapiens BMP/retinoic acid-inducible neural-specific protein 1 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- 101000715194 Homo sapiens Cell cycle and apoptosis regulator protein 2 Proteins 0.000 description 2
- VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N Hydrochloric acid Chemical compound Cl VEXZGXHMUGYJMC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Lithium Chemical compound [Li] WHXSMMKQMYFTQS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- AFVFQIVMOAPDHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N Methanesulfonic acid Chemical compound CS(O)(=O)=O AFVFQIVMOAPDHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PCLIMKBDDGJMGD-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-bromosuccinimide Chemical compound BrN1C(=O)CCC1=O PCLIMKBDDGJMGD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229920001167 Poly(triaryl amine) Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920002873 Polyethylenimine Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000004642 Polyimide Substances 0.000 description 2
- KYQCOXFCLRTKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CN=CC=N1 KYQCOXFCLRTKLS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N Pyrimidine Chemical compound C1=CN=CN=C1 CZPWVGJYEJSRLH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- UIIMBOGNXHQVGW-UHFFFAOYSA-M Sodium bicarbonate Chemical compound [Na+].OC([O-])=O UIIMBOGNXHQVGW-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- ATJFFYVFTNAWJD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Tin Chemical compound [Sn] ATJFFYVFTNAWJD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052769 Ytterbium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc Chemical compound [Zn] HCHKCACWOHOZIP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- XHCLAFWTIXFWPH-UHFFFAOYSA-N [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[V+5].[V+5] Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[V+5].[V+5] XHCLAFWTIXFWPH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000002253 acid Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000005073 adamantyl group Chemical group C12(CC3CC(CC(C1)C3)C2)* 0.000 description 2
- 150000001448 anilines Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 238000000231 atomic layer deposition Methods 0.000 description 2
- QVQLCTNNEUAWMS-UHFFFAOYSA-N barium oxide Chemical compound [Ba]=O QVQLCTNNEUAWMS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000008901 benefit Effects 0.000 description 2
- 235000010290 biphenyl Nutrition 0.000 description 2
- 125000006268 biphenyl-3-yl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C(C([H])=C1[H])C1=C([H])C(*)=C([H])C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 2
- HTJWUNNIRKDDIV-UHFFFAOYSA-N bis(1-adamantyl)-butylphosphane Chemical compound C1C(C2)CC(C3)CC2CC13P(CCCC)C1(C2)CC(C3)CC2CC3C1 HTJWUNNIRKDDIV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052793 cadmium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- BDOSMKKIYDKNTQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N cadmium atom Chemical compound [Cd] BDOSMKKIYDKNTQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052792 caesium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- TVFDJXOCXUVLDH-UHFFFAOYSA-N caesium atom Chemical compound [Cs] TVFDJXOCXUVLDH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000002915 carbonyl group Chemical group [*:2]C([*:1])=O 0.000 description 2
- 239000003054 catalyst Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052804 chromium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000011651 chromium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000005578 chrysene group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 238000000576 coating method Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229940126142 compound 16 Drugs 0.000 description 2
- 238000006482 condensation reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000008094 contradictory effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 150000001880 copper compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- GBRBMTNGQBKBQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L copper;diiodide Chemical compound I[Cu]I GBRBMTNGQBKBQE-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- 125000000332 coumarinyl group Chemical group O1C(=O)C(=CC2=CC=CC=C12)* 0.000 description 2
- 239000013078 crystal Substances 0.000 description 2
- BHQBDOOJEZXHPS-UHFFFAOYSA-N ctk3i0272 Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1C(C(=C(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C(=C1C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C(C=4C(=C(C=5C=CC=CC=5)C(C=5C=CC=CC=5)=C(C=5C=CC=CC=5)C=4C=4C=CC=CC=4)C=4C=CC=CC=4)=C4C=CC=CC4=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 BHQBDOOJEZXHPS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000001995 cyclobutyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- 125000000582 cycloheptyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])C1([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- QZXFDVKEMLWZNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N cyclohexa-1,4-diene-1,4-dicarboxylic acid Chemical compound OC(=O)C1=CCC(C(O)=O)=CC1 QZXFDVKEMLWZNW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- JHIVVAPYMSGYDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N cyclohexanone Chemical compound O=C1CCCCC1 JHIVVAPYMSGYDF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000001559 cyclopropyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C1([H])* 0.000 description 2
- NNBZCPXTIHJBJL-UHFFFAOYSA-N decalin Chemical compound C1CCCC2CCCCC21 NNBZCPXTIHJBJL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000000354 decomposition reaction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000002274 desiccant Substances 0.000 description 2
- 238000004455 differential thermal analysis Methods 0.000 description 2
- DMBHHRLKUKUOEG-UHFFFAOYSA-N diphenylamine Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1NC1=CC=CC=C1 DMBHHRLKUKUOEG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- SNRUBQQJIBEYMU-UHFFFAOYSA-N dodecane Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCCC SNRUBQQJIBEYMU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000005684 electric field Effects 0.000 description 2
- ADHNFLCTOCFIFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N europium(3+) 1,10-phenanthroline Chemical compound [Eu+3].c1cnc2c(c1)ccc1cccnc21 ADHNFLCTOCFIFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000000605 extraction Methods 0.000 description 2
- 239000000835 fiber Substances 0.000 description 2
- 239000011151 fibre-reinforced plastic Substances 0.000 description 2
- 125000001153 fluoro group Chemical group F* 0.000 description 2
- 239000011888 foil Substances 0.000 description 2
- 150000002367 halogens Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 150000002390 heteroarenes Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 229910052738 indium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- APFVFJFRJDLVQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N indium atom Chemical compound [In] APFVFJFRJDLVQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- PNDPGZBMCMUPRI-UHFFFAOYSA-N iodine Chemical compound II PNDPGZBMCMUPRI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 150000002500 ions Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- AWJUIBRHMBBTKR-UHFFFAOYSA-N isoquinoline Chemical compound C1=NC=CC2=CC=CC=C21 AWJUIBRHMBBTKR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000007788 liquid Substances 0.000 description 2
- FUJCRWPEOMXPAD-UHFFFAOYSA-N lithium oxide Chemical compound [Li+].[Li+].[O-2] FUJCRWPEOMXPAD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910001947 lithium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 125000000040 m-tolyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(*)=C([H])C(=C1[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- AUHZEENZYGFFBQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N mesitylene Substances CC1=CC(C)=CC(C)=C1 AUHZEENZYGFFBQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000001827 mesitylenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C(C(*)=C(C([H])=C1C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 2
- 229910044991 metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 150000004706 metal oxides Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- FQPSGWSUVKBHSU-UHFFFAOYSA-N methacrylamide Chemical compound CC(=C)C(N)=O FQPSGWSUVKBHSU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 238000001451 molecular beam epitaxy Methods 0.000 description 2
- BBNZOXKLBAWRSH-UHFFFAOYSA-N n,9-diphenyl-n-[4-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)phenyl]carbazol-3-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=2)C=C1 BBNZOXKLBAWRSH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LNFOMBWFZZDRKO-UHFFFAOYSA-N n,9-diphenyl-n-[4-[4-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)phenyl]phenyl]carbazol-3-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=2)C=C1 LNFOMBWFZZDRKO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- XAWQWMLNBYNXJX-UHFFFAOYSA-N n,n-diphenyl-9-[4-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)phenyl]carbazol-3-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC(=CC=3)C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C(C=4C=CC=CC=4)=C4C=CC=CC4=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 XAWQWMLNBYNXJX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- AJNJGJDDJIBTBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-(9,10-diphenylanthracen-2-yl)-n,9-diphenylcarbazol-3-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)=C3C=CC=CC3=C(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=2)C3=C1 AJNJGJDDJIBTBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- UMFJAHHVKNCGLG-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-Nitrosodimethylamine Chemical compound CN(C)N=O UMFJAHHVKNCGLG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000004108 n-butyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 2
- ORQBXQOJMQIAOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N nobelium Chemical compound [No] ORQBXQOJMQIAOY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- QGLKJKCYBOYXKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N nonaoxidotritungsten Chemical compound O=[W]1(=O)O[W](=O)(=O)O[W](=O)(=O)O1 QGLKJKCYBOYXKC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 150000007530 organic bases Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- AHLBNYSZXLDEJQ-FWEHEUNISA-N orlistat Chemical compound CCCCCCCCCCC[C@H](OC(=O)[C@H](CC(C)C)NC=O)C[C@@H]1OC(=O)[C@H]1CCCCCC AHLBNYSZXLDEJQ-FWEHEUNISA-N 0.000 description 2
- 230000001151 other effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- SLIUAWYAILUBJU-UHFFFAOYSA-N pentacene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC3=CC4=CC5=CC=CC=C5C=C4C=C3C=C21 SLIUAWYAILUBJU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000001792 phenanthrenyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC=2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC12)* 0.000 description 2
- 229920000301 poly(3-hexylthiophene-2,5-diyl) polymer Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920000078 poly(4-vinyltriphenylamine) Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920000553 poly(phenylenevinylene) Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920000139 polyethylene terephthalate Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000005020 polyethylene terephthalate Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920001721 polyimide Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 229920001343 polytetrafluoroethylene Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000004810 polytetrafluoroethylene Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229920000123 polythiophene Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 238000007639 printing Methods 0.000 description 2
- 230000001737 promoting effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 125000000168 pyrrolyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- 230000002040 relaxant effect Effects 0.000 description 2
- 238000009877 rendering Methods 0.000 description 2
- 229910052703 rhodium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- MHOVAHRLVXNVSD-UHFFFAOYSA-N rhodium atom Chemical compound [Rh] MHOVAHRLVXNVSD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- YYMBJDOZVAITBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N rubrene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=C(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C2=CC=CC=C2C(C=2C=CC=CC=2)=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 YYMBJDOZVAITBP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229920006395 saturated elastomer Polymers 0.000 description 2
- 239000011669 selenium Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910052814 silicon oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000002002 slurry Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910000029 sodium carbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 239000010935 stainless steel Substances 0.000 description 2
- 229910001220 stainless steel Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 150000003457 sulfones Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 238000004808 supercritical fluid chromatography Methods 0.000 description 2
- 238000001308 synthesis method Methods 0.000 description 2
- JBQYATWDVHIOAR-UHFFFAOYSA-N tellanylidenegermanium Chemical compound [Te]=[Ge] JBQYATWDVHIOAR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- KBLZDCFTQSIIOH-UHFFFAOYSA-M tetrabutylazanium;perchlorate Chemical compound [O-]Cl(=O)(=O)=O.CCCC[N+](CCCC)(CCCC)CCCC KBLZDCFTQSIIOH-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 2
- 125000005579 tetracene group Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- UGNWTBMOAKPKBL-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrachloro-1,4-benzoquinone Chemical class ClC1=C(Cl)C(=O)C(Cl)=C(Cl)C1=O UGNWTBMOAKPKBL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- FHCPAXDKURNIOZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N tetrathiafulvalene Chemical compound S1C=CSC1=C1SC=CS1 FHCPAXDKURNIOZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 150000003624 transition metals Chemical class 0.000 description 2
- 238000002834 transmittance Methods 0.000 description 2
- TVIVIEFSHFOWTE-UHFFFAOYSA-K tri(quinolin-8-yloxy)alumane Chemical compound [Al+3].C1=CN=C2C([O-])=CC=CC2=C1.C1=CN=C2C([O-])=CC=CC2=C1.C1=CN=C2C([O-])=CC=CC2=C1 TVIVIEFSHFOWTE-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 2
- 150000003852 triazoles Chemical group 0.000 description 2
- WLPUWLXVBWGYMZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N tricyclohexylphosphine Chemical compound C1CCCCC1P(C1CCCCC1)C1CCCCC1 WLPUWLXVBWGYMZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 125000002827 triflate group Chemical group FC(S(=O)(=O)O*)(F)F 0.000 description 2
- WJKHJLXJJJATHN-UHFFFAOYSA-N triflic anhydride Chemical compound FC(F)(F)S(=O)(=O)OS(=O)(=O)C(F)(F)F WJKHJLXJJJATHN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- FPZZZGJWXOHLDJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N trihexylphosphane Chemical compound CCCCCCP(CCCCCC)CCCCCC FPZZZGJWXOHLDJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- LENZDBCJOHFCAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N tris Chemical compound OCC(N)(CO)CO LENZDBCJOHFCAS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910001930 tungsten oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- 229910001935 vanadium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- NAWDYIZEMPQZHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N ytterbium Chemical compound [Yb] NAWDYIZEMPQZHO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 229910052725 zinc Inorganic materials 0.000 description 2
- YVTHLONGBIQYBO-UHFFFAOYSA-N zinc indium(3+) oxygen(2-) Chemical compound [O--].[Zn++].[In+3] YVTHLONGBIQYBO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 2
- 239000011787 zinc oxide Substances 0.000 description 2
- CJGUQZGGEUNPFQ-UHFFFAOYSA-L zinc;2-(1,3-benzothiazol-2-yl)phenolate Chemical compound [Zn+2].[O-]C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NC2=CC=CC=C2S1.[O-]C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NC2=CC=CC=C2S1 CJGUQZGGEUNPFQ-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 2
- RPCBIEHUQSGPNA-UHFFFAOYSA-N (3,5-ditert-butylphenyl)boronic acid Chemical compound CC(C)(C)C1=CC(B(O)O)=CC(C(C)(C)C)=C1 RPCBIEHUQSGPNA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- TZFLBWAKFGADPX-UHFFFAOYSA-N (3-bromo-5-trimethylsilylphenyl)-trimethylsilane Chemical compound C[Si](C)(C)C1=CC(Br)=CC([Si](C)(C)C)=C1 TZFLBWAKFGADPX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IWZZBBJTIUYDPZ-DVACKJPTSA-N (z)-4-hydroxypent-3-en-2-one;iridium;2-phenylpyridine Chemical compound [Ir].C\C(O)=C\C(C)=O.[C-]1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=N1.[C-]1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=N1 IWZZBBJTIUYDPZ-DVACKJPTSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KZPYGQFFRCFCPP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,1'-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene Chemical compound [Fe+2].C1=CC=C[C-]1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1.C1=CC=C[C-]1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 KZPYGQFFRCFCPP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- XGCDBGRZEKYHNV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,1-bis(diphenylphosphino)methane Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)CP(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 XGCDBGRZEKYHNV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FIDRAVVQGKNYQK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,3,4-tetrahydrotriazine Chemical compound C1NNNC=C1 FIDRAVVQGKNYQK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UPWZWQGQRNPKTE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,3-trimethylidenecyclopropane Chemical class C=C1C(=C)C1=C UPWZWQGQRNPKTE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RTSZQXSYCGBHMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,2,4-trichloro-3-prop-1-ynoxybenzene Chemical compound CC#COC1=C(Cl)C=CC(Cl)=C1Cl RTSZQXSYCGBHMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000005918 1,2-dimethylbutyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- FNKCOUREFBNNHG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,3-dibromo-5-chlorobenzene Chemical compound ClC1=CC(Br)=CC(Br)=C1 FNKCOUREFBNNHG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OCJBOOLMMGQPQU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1,4-dichlorobenzene Chemical compound ClC1=CC=C(Cl)C=C1 OCJBOOLMMGQPQU-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FQIHKGMNFAMMEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(3,5-diphenylphenyl)anthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC(C=2C=CC=CC=2)=CC(C=2C3=CC4=CC=CC=C4C=C3C=CC=2)=C1 FQIHKGMNFAMMEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FHVIAZQESRWCJO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-(3,5-ditert-butylphenyl)anthracene-9,10-diamine Chemical compound CC(C)(C)c1cc(cc(c1)C(C)(C)C)-c1cccc2c(N)c3ccccc3c(N)c12 FHVIAZQESRWCJO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VRHPTNPRFKGMEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-N,3-N,5-N-triphenyl-1-N,3-N,5-N-tris(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)benzene-1,3,5-triamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=C3C4=CC=CC=C4N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C3=CC=2)=CC(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=C3C4=CC=CC=C4N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C3=CC=2)=C1 VRHPTNPRFKGMEH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- XFDYBCQHRPMIGD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-N,6-N-bis(3-methylphenyl)-1-N,6-N-bis[3-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]pyrene-1,6-diamine Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC(N(C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C2(C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=C4C=CC(=C5C=CC(C3=C54)=CC=2)N(C=2C=C(C)C=CC=2)C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C2(C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC=CC=2)=C1 XFDYBCQHRPMIGD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MZOOQUNEOSFPPR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-N,6-N-bis(4-tert-butylphenyl)-1-N,6-N-bis[4-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]pyrene-1,6-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C1N(C=1C2=CC=C3C=CC(=C4C=CC(C2=C43)=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)C(C)(C)C)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)C1(C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C2(C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=C1 MZOOQUNEOSFPPR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IPNLBJDLLBQZDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-N,6-N-diphenyl-1-N,6-N-bis[4-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]pyrene-1,6-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C2=CC=C3C=CC(=C4C=CC(C2=C43)=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)C1(C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C2(C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=C1 IPNLBJDLLBQZDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FVTKYSBFHHVYJG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-bromo-3,5-dihexylbenzene Chemical compound CCCCCCC1=CC(Br)=CC(CCCCCC)=C1 FVTKYSBFHHVYJG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QXPAPGDQRWESTP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-n,1-n,4-n-triphenyl-4-n-(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)benzene-1,4-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 QXPAPGDQRWESTP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- XOYZGLGJSAZOAG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-n,1-n,4-n-triphenyl-4-n-[4-[4-(n-[4-(n-phenylanilino)phenyl]anilino)phenyl]phenyl]benzene-1,4-diamine Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 XOYZGLGJSAZOAG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FQNVFRPAQRVHKO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-n,4-n-bis(4-methylphenyl)-1-n,4-n-diphenylbenzene-1,4-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC(C)=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(C)=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 FQNVFRPAQRVHKO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KEHISZDJCIBJEK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-phenylanthracene-9,10-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(N)=C3C=CC=CC3=C(N)C2=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 KEHISZDJCIBJEK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- XNCMQRWVMWLODV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-phenylbenzimidazole Chemical compound C1=NC2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=CC=C1 XNCMQRWVMWLODV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IVYAYAWSXINSEF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 1-tert-butylperylene Chemical group C1=CC(C=2C(C(C)(C)C)=CC=C3C=2C2=CC=C3)=C3C2=CC=CC3=C1 IVYAYAWSXINSEF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NYPMWIHVZGWERR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 10-(3-dibenzothiophen-4-ylphenyl)phenanthro[9,10-b]pyrazine Chemical compound C1=C2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=NC=CN=C3C2=CC=C1C1=CC(C2=C3SC=4C(C3=CC=C2)=CC=CC=4)=CC=C1 NYPMWIHVZGWERR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CYPVTICNYNXTQP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 10-[4-[4-(9,9-dimethylacridin-10-yl)phenyl]sulfonylphenyl]-9,9-dimethylacridine Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C(C)(C)C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=C(S(=O)(=O)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C(C)(C)C3=CC=CC=C32)C=C1 CYPVTICNYNXTQP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WJFKNYWRSNBZNX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 10H-phenothiazine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2NC3=CC=CC=C3SC2=C1 WJFKNYWRSNBZNX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- TZMSYXZUNZXBOL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 10H-phenoxazine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2NC3=CC=CC=C3OC2=C1 TZMSYXZUNZXBOL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WAZCYXLGIFUKPS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 11-phenyl-12-[4-(11-phenylindolo[2,3-a]carbazol-12-yl)-6-(4-phenylphenyl)-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl]indolo[2,3-a]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=C(C=2N=C(N=C(N=2)N2C3=C4N(C=5C=CC=CC=5)C5=CC=CC=C5C4=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)N2C3=C4N(C=5C=CC=CC=5)C5=CC=CC=C5C4=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=C1 WAZCYXLGIFUKPS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JEBPFDQAOYARIB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,3,6,7-tetramethyl-9,10-dinaphthalen-2-ylanthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC(C=3C4=CC(C)=C(C)C=C4C(C=4C=C5C=CC=CC5=CC=4)=C4C=C(C(=CC4=3)C)C)=CC=C21 JEBPFDQAOYARIB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VSZFGUGKWSHSBM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,4,6-tri(carbazol-9-yl)-3,5-bis(3,6-diphenylcarbazol-9-yl)benzonitrile Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C1=2)C1=C(C#N)C(=C(C(=C1N1C2=CC=C(C=C2C=2C=C(C=CC1=2)C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2C=2C=CC=CC1=2)N1C2=CC=C(C=C2C=2C=C(C=CC1=2)C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2C=2C=CC=CC1=2 VSZFGUGKWSHSBM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BFTIPCRZWILUIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,5,8,11-tetratert-butylperylene Chemical group CC(C)(C)C1=CC(C2=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC=3C2=C2C=C(C=3)C(C)(C)C)=C3C2=CC(C(C)(C)C)=CC3=C1 BFTIPCRZWILUIY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- CNSRBJWFPJMRFB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2,8-diphenyl-4-[4-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]dibenzothiophene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=C(SC=2C3=CC(=CC=2C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C2(C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C42)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C3=C1 CNSRBJWFPJMRFB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- YDNOJUAQBFXZCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(2,3,4,5,6-pentafluorophenyl)acetonitrile Chemical compound FC1=C(F)C(F)=C(CC#N)C(F)=C1F YDNOJUAQBFXZCR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IZJOTDOLRQTPHC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-(4-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)-5-phenyl-1,3,4-oxadiazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NN=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)O1 IZJOTDOLRQTPHC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PJEQASXKXVZLEK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-N',7-N'-diphenyl-2-N',7-N'-bis[4-(N-phenylanilino)phenyl]-9,9'-spirobi[fluorene]-2',7'-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=C2C3(C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C43)C3=CC(=CC=C3C2=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 PJEQASXKXVZLEK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IXHWGNYCZPISET-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-[4-(dicyanomethylidene)-2,3,5,6-tetrafluorocyclohexa-2,5-dien-1-ylidene]propanedinitrile Chemical compound FC1=C(F)C(=C(C#N)C#N)C(F)=C(F)C1=C(C#N)C#N IXHWGNYCZPISET-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000006176 2-ethylbutyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])*)C([H])([H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000005916 2-methylpentyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- TUMRGNWURXLFBN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-n,7-n-bis(4-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)-9,9-dimethyl-2-n,7-n-diphenylfluorene-2,7-diamine Chemical compound C1=C2C(C)(C)C3=CC(N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C=4C=CC(=CC=4)N4C5=CC=CC=C5C5=CC=CC=C54)=CC=C3C2=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21)C1=CC=CC=C1 TUMRGNWURXLFBN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HONWGFNQCPRRFM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-n-(3-methylphenyl)-1-n,1-n,2-n-triphenylbenzene-1,2-diamine Chemical compound CC1=CC=CC(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C(=CC=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)=C1 HONWGFNQCPRRFM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000001622 2-naphthyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C2C([H])=C(*)C([H])=C([H])C2=C1[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000004135 2-norbornyl group Chemical group [H]C1([H])C([H])([H])C2([H])C([H])([H])C1([H])C([H])([H])C2([H])* 0.000 description 1
- VQGHOUODWALEFC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-phenylpyridine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=N1 VQGHOUODWALEFC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ONMVVYFKZFORGI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 2-tert-butyl-9,10-dinaphthalen-1-ylanthracene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C3=C4C=CC=CC4=C(C=4C5=CC=CC=C5C=CC=4)C4=CC=C(C=C43)C(C)(C)C)=CC=CC2=C1 ONMVVYFKZFORGI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DMEVMYSQZPJFOK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,4,5,6,9,10-hexazatetracyclo[12.4.0.02,7.08,13]octadeca-1(18),2(7),3,5,8(13),9,11,14,16-nonaene Chemical group N1=NN=C2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=NN=C3C2=N1 DMEVMYSQZPJFOK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HEOVYVZFXJHPHA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-dicyclohexylaniline Chemical compound Nc1cc(cc(c1)C1CCCCC1)C1CCCCC1 HEOVYVZFXJHPHA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PEZSSBYAUDZEMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,5-dicyclohexylphenol Chemical compound C=1C(O)=CC(C2CCCCC2)=CC=1C1CCCCC1 PEZSSBYAUDZEMO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GWHSOUPRKHXZPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,6-bis(3,5-diphenylphenyl)-9-phenylcarbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC(C=2C=CC=CC=2)=CC(C=2C=C3C4=CC(=CC=C4N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C3=CC=2)C=2C=C(C=C(C=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)=C1 GWHSOUPRKHXZPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GNWOHNVMSHTPKO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3,8-dicyclohexyl-1-N,6-N-diphenyl-1-N,6-N-bis[4-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]pyrene-1,6-diamine Chemical compound C1CCCCC1C(C1=CC=C23)=CC(N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C=4C=CC(=CC=4)C4(C5=CC=CC=C5C5=CC=CC=C54)C=4C=CC=CC=4)=C(C=C4)C1=C2C4=C(C1CCCCC1)C=C3N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)C1(C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 GNWOHNVMSHTPKO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MKAQNAJLIITRHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(3-dibenzothiophen-4-ylphenyl)phenanthro[9,10-b]pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C3=NC(C=4C=CC=C(C=4)C4=C5SC=6C(C5=CC=C4)=CC=CC=6)=CN=C3C3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 MKAQNAJLIITRHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WAJDLGKOJABKAN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-naphthalen-1-ylphenyl)-9-phenylcarbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N1C2=CC=C(C=3C=CC(=CC=3)C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C=CC=3)C=C2C2=CC=CC=C21 WAJDLGKOJABKAN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WQRYZOAFWABMBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(4-phenanthren-9-ylphenyl)-9-phenylcarbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N1C2=CC=C(C=3C=CC(=CC=3)C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C=3)C=C2C2=CC=CC=C21 WQRYZOAFWABMBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- FTZXDZQJFKXEGW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(9,9-dimethylacridin-10-yl)xanthen-9-one Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C(C)(C)C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=C2C(=O)C3=CC=CC=C3OC2=C1 FTZXDZQJFKXEGW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GKTLHQFSIDFAJH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-(9h-carbazol-3-yl)-9-phenylcarbazole Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1N1C2=CC=C(C=3C=C4C5=CC=CC=C5NC4=CC=3)C=C2C2=CC=CC=C21 GKTLHQFSIDFAJH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- TVMBOHMLKCZFFW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-N,6-N,9-triphenyl-3-N,6-N-bis(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)carbazole-3,6-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC(=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=2)C3=C1 TVMBOHMLKCZFFW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QIEWTACDLJLBTE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-N,6-N,9-triphenyl-3-N,6-N-bis[4-(N-phenylanilino)phenyl]carbazole-3,6-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=C2C3=CC(=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 QIEWTACDLJLBTE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DPECCMXOGAHFKQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-N,6-N-dinaphthalen-1-yl-9-phenyl-3-N,6-N-bis[4-(N-phenylanilino)phenyl]carbazole-3,6-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=C2C3=CC(=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C=CC=1)C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 DPECCMXOGAHFKQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- LLDZJTIZVZFNCM-UHFFFAOYSA-J 3-[18-(2-carboxyethyl)-8,13-diethyl-3,7,12,17-tetramethylporphyrin-21,24-diid-2-yl]propanoic acid;dichlorotin(2+) Chemical compound [H+].[H+].[Cl-].[Cl-].[Sn+4].[N-]1C(C=C2C(=C(C)C(=CC=3C(=C(C)C(=C4)N=3)CC)[N-]2)CCC([O-])=O)=C(CCC([O-])=O)C(C)=C1C=C1C(C)=C(CC)C4=N1 LLDZJTIZVZFNCM-UHFFFAOYSA-J 0.000 description 1
- PCUTZMWETFJZDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-[3-(3-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)phenyl]phenanthro[9,10-b]pyrazine Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC(C=2C=CC=C(C=2)C=2N=C3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C3=NC=2)=CC=C1 PCUTZMWETFJZDZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MFWOWURWNZHYLA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-[3-(3-dibenzothiophen-4-ylphenyl)phenyl]phenanthro[9,10-b]pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C3=NC(C=4C=CC=C(C=4)C=4C=CC=C(C=4)C4=C5SC=6C(C5=CC=C4)=CC=CC=6)=CN=C3C3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 MFWOWURWNZHYLA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- IHPRFEGMZFFUMH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-[4-(3,6-diphenylcarbazol-9-yl)phenyl]phenanthro[9,10-b]pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)C=2N=C3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C3=NC=2)C=2C3=CC(=CC=2)C=2C=CC=CC=2)C3=C1 IHPRFEGMZFFUMH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QVSJCRDHNCCXFC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 3-[9-[4-(4,6-diphenyl-1,3,5-triazin-2-yl)phenyl]carbazol-3-yl]-9-phenylcarbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NC(C=2C=CC=CC=2)=NC(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=C(C=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=C3C4=CC=CC=C4N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C3=CC=2)=N1 QVSJCRDHNCCXFC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000005917 3-methylpentyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- ALEAISKRDWWJRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4,6-bis(3-dibenzothiophen-4-ylphenyl)pyrimidine Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2SC2=C1C=CC=C2C1=CC(C=2C=C(N=CN=2)C=2C=CC=C(C=2)C2=C3SC=4C(C3=CC=C2)=CC=CC=4)=CC=C1 ALEAISKRDWWJRK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DGVHCUNJUVMAKG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4,6-bis(3-phenanthren-9-ylphenyl)pyrimidine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C=3C=CC=C(C=3)C=3C=C(N=CN=3)C=3C=CC=C(C=3)C=3C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C4C=3)=CC3=CC=CC=C3C2=C1 DGVHCUNJUVMAKG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UTKXUMCKRYEWMJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4,8-bis(3-dibenzothiophen-4-ylphenyl)-[1]benzofuro[3,2-d]pyrimidine Chemical compound C1=CC=C(C=2SC3=C(C=21)C=CC=C3)C=1C=C(C=CC=1)C=1C2=C(N=CN=1)C1=C(O2)C=CC(=C1)C1=CC(=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC2=C1SC1=C2C=CC=C1 UTKXUMCKRYEWMJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RVTNHUBWDWSZKX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-[3-[3-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]phenyl]dibenzofuran Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1(C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C=2C=C(C=CC=2)C=2C=3OC4=CC=CC=C4C=3C=CC=2)C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21 RVTNHUBWDWSZKX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MYDCZFAXCARGHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-[4-[3-(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)carbazol-9-yl]phenyl]-[1]benzofuro[3,2-d]pyrimidine Chemical compound C1(=CC=CC=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2C=2C=C(C=CC1=2)C=1C=CC=2N(C3=CC=CC=C3C=2C=1)C1=CC=C(C=C1)C=1C2=C(N=CN=1)C1=C(O2)C=CC=C1 MYDCZFAXCARGHR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- AWXGSYPUMWKTBR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-carbazol-9-yl-n,n-bis(4-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)aniline Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=C1 AWXGSYPUMWKTBR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000001255 4-fluorophenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(*)=C([H])C([H])=C1F 0.000 description 1
- 125000004861 4-isopropyl phenyl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C(=C([H])C([H])=C1*)C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- CRHRWHRNQKPUPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-n-naphthalen-1-yl-1-n,1-n-bis[4-(n-naphthalen-1-ylanilino)phenyl]-4-n-phenylbenzene-1,4-diamine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C=CC=1)C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=C3C=CC=2)C=C1 CRHRWHRNQKPUPO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OPYUBDQDQKABTN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 4-phenyl-6-[4-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]dibenzothiophene Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC2=C1SC1=C(C=3C=CC(=CC=3)C3(C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C43)C=3C=CC=CC=3)C=CC=C12 OPYUBDQDQKABTN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OKEZAUMKBWTTCR-AATRIKPKSA-N 5-methyl-2-[4-[(e)-2-[4-(5-methyl-1,3-benzoxazol-2-yl)phenyl]ethenyl]phenyl]-1,3-benzoxazole Chemical compound CC1=CC=C2OC(C3=CC=C(C=C3)/C=C/C3=CC=C(C=C3)C=3OC4=CC=C(C=C4N=3)C)=NC2=C1 OKEZAUMKBWTTCR-AATRIKPKSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UCVFLGABQASTCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 6-(3-dibenzothiophen-4-ylphenyl)phenanthro[9,10-b]pyrazine Chemical compound C1=CN=C2C3=CC(C=4C=CC=C(C=4)C4=C5SC=6C(C5=CC=C4)=CC=CC=6)=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C3C2=N1 UCVFLGABQASTCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JFHIIYSJKXQYIJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 7-[4-(10-phenyl-9-anthryl)phenyl]-7h-dibenzo[c,g]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=C(N2C3=C(C4=CC=CC=C4C=C3)C3=C4C=CC=CC4=CC=C32)C=C1 JFHIIYSJKXQYIJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZCYVEMRRCGMTRW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 7553-56-2 Chemical compound [I] ZCYVEMRRCGMTRW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- RZVHIXYEVGDQDX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-anthraquinone Chemical group C1=CC=C2C(=O)C3=CC=CC=C3C(=O)C2=C1 RZVHIXYEVGDQDX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UGQXRKWOYOPTCV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,10-dibromo-2,6-diphenylanthracene Chemical compound C1=C2C(Br)=C3C=CC(C=4C=CC=CC=4)=CC3=C(Br)C2=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 UGQXRKWOYOPTCV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- SNFCXVRWFNAHQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,9'-spirobi[fluorene] Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2C21C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C21 SNFCXVRWFNAHQX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- JSEQNGYLWKBMJI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,9-dimethyl-10h-acridine Chemical compound C1=CC=C2C(C)(C)C3=CC=CC=C3NC2=C1 JSEQNGYLWKBMJI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OAXLYKRMEWDQGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,9-dimethyl-2-n,2-n,7-n,7-n-tetraphenylfluorene-2,7-diamine Chemical compound C1=C2C(C)(C)C3=CC(N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C=4C=CC=CC=4)=CC=C3C2=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 OAXLYKRMEWDQGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GJWBRYKOJMOBHH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9,9-dimethyl-n-[4-(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)phenyl]-n-(4-phenylphenyl)fluoren-2-amine Chemical compound C1=C2C(C)(C)C3=CC=CC=C3C2=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C(C=C1)=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 GJWBRYKOJMOBHH-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OEYLQYLOSLLBTR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-(2-phenylphenyl)-10-[10-(2-phenylphenyl)anthracen-9-yl]anthracene Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=CC=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 OEYLQYLOSLLBTR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MZYDBGLUVPLRKR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-(3-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)carbazole Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC(N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)=CC=C1 MZYDBGLUVPLRKR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- YEDHTLQJDBFDHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[3-(9-phenylfluoren-9-yl)phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C1(C=2C=C(C=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21 YEDHTLQJDBFDHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- XCICDYGIJBPNPC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[4-[3,5-bis(4-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)phenyl]phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C12=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C2N1C1=CC=C(C=2C=C(C=C(C=2)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=C1 XCICDYGIJBPNPC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZWSVEGKGLOHGIQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-[4-[4-(4-carbazol-9-ylphenyl)-2,3,5,6-tetraphenylphenyl]phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C(C(=C(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C(C=1C=CC=CC=1)=C1C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N2C3=CC=CC=C3C3=CC=CC=C32)=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 ZWSVEGKGLOHGIQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DDCOSPFEMPUOFY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-phenyl-3-[4-(10-phenylanthracen-9-yl)phenyl]carbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=CC=C2)C2=C1C1=CC=C(C=2C=C3C4=CC=CC=C4N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C3=CC=2)C=C1 DDCOSPFEMPUOFY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VIJYEGDOKCKUOL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9-phenylcarbazole Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N1C2=CC=CC=C2C2=CC=CC=C21 VIJYEGDOKCKUOL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PQJUJGAVDBINPI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 9H-thioxanthene Chemical compound C1=CC=C2CC3=CC=CC=C3SC2=C1 PQJUJGAVDBINPI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-M Acetate Chemical compound CC([O-])=O QTBSBXVTEAMEQO-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- GDALETGZDYOOGB-UHFFFAOYSA-N Acridone Natural products C1=C(O)C=C2N(C)C3=CC=CC=C3C(=O)C2=C1O GDALETGZDYOOGB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZOXJGFHDIHLPTG-UHFFFAOYSA-N Boron Chemical compound [B] ZOXJGFHDIHLPTG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HLUJRHMQCIFZRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N C1(=CC=CC=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2C=2C=C(C=CC1=2)C=1C=CC=2N(C3=CC=CC=C3C=2C=1)C=1C2=C(N=CN=1)C1=C(O2)C=CC=C1 Chemical compound C1(=CC=CC=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2C=2C=C(C=CC1=2)C=1C=CC=2N(C3=CC=CC=C3C=2C=1)C=1C2=C(N=CN=1)C1=C(O2)C=CC=C1 HLUJRHMQCIFZRP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZYNFGMXIAPFYDQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N C1=CC=C(C=C1)N1C(=NN=C1C1=CC=C(C=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2N(C2=CC=CC=C2)C2=CC=CC=C12)C1=CC=CC=C1 Chemical compound C1=CC=C(C=C1)N1C(=NN=C1C1=CC=C(C=C1)N1C2=CC=CC=C2N(C2=CC=CC=C2)C2=CC=CC=C12)C1=CC=CC=C1 ZYNFGMXIAPFYDQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- ZKHISQHQYQCSJE-UHFFFAOYSA-N C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=C(C=C(C=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=C(C=C(C=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC(=CC=1)N(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 ZKHISQHQYQCSJE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- XMWRBQBLMFGWIX-UHFFFAOYSA-N C60 fullerene Chemical compound C12=C3C(C4=C56)=C7C8=C5C5=C9C%10=C6C6=C4C1=C1C4=C6C6=C%10C%10=C9C9=C%11C5=C8C5=C8C7=C3C3=C7C2=C1C1=C2C4=C6C4=C%10C6=C9C9=C%11C5=C5C8=C3C3=C7C1=C1C2=C4C6=C2C9=C5C3=C12 XMWRBQBLMFGWIX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 244000025254 Cannabis sativa Species 0.000 description 1
- 235000012766 Cannabis sativa ssp. sativa var. sativa Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 235000012765 Cannabis sativa ssp. sativa var. spontanea Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- BVKZGUZCCUSVTD-UHFFFAOYSA-L Carbonate Chemical compound [O-]C([O-])=O BVKZGUZCCUSVTD-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 229920000298 Cellophane Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000742 Cotton Polymers 0.000 description 1
- XDTMQSROBMDMFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Cyclohexane Chemical compound C1CCCCC1 XDTMQSROBMDMFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004593 Epoxy Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052691 Erbium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- PXGOKWXKJXAPGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N Fluorine Chemical compound FF PXGOKWXKJXAPGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- GYHNNYVSQQEPJS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Gallium Chemical compound [Ga] GYHNNYVSQQEPJS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000007818 Grignard reagent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 101000837344 Homo sapiens T-cell leukemia translocation-altered gene protein Proteins 0.000 description 1
- 239000002879 Lewis base Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910017911 MgIn Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- ZOKXTWBITQBERF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Molybdenum Chemical compound [Mo] ZOKXTWBITQBERF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- VUMVABVDHWICAZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N N-phenyl-N-[4-[4-[N-(9,9'-spirobi[fluorene]-2-yl)anilino]phenyl]phenyl]-9,9'-spirobi[fluorene]-2-amine Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3(C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C43)C3=CC=CC=C3C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C=2C=CC(=CC=2)N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C=C3C4(C5=CC=CC=C5C5=CC=CC=C54)C4=CC=CC=C4C3=CC=2)C=C1 VUMVABVDHWICAZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PHXQIAWFIIMOKG-UHFFFAOYSA-N NClO Chemical compound NClO PHXQIAWFIIMOKG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000004677 Nylon Substances 0.000 description 1
- PCNDJXKNXGMECE-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phenazine Natural products C1=CC=CC2=NC3=CC=CC=C3N=C21 PCNDJXKNXGMECE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OAICVXFJPJFONN-UHFFFAOYSA-N Phosphorus Chemical compound [P] OAICVXFJPJFONN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920001157 Poly(2-vinylnaphthalene) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001609 Poly(3,4-ethylenedioxythiophene) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920012266 Poly(ether sulfone) PES Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000004952 Polyamide Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000265 Polyparaphenylene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000004743 Polypropylene Substances 0.000 description 1
- WDVSHHCDHLJJJR-UHFFFAOYSA-N Proflavine Chemical compound C1=CC(N)=CC2=NC3=CC(N)=CC=C3C=C21 WDVSHHCDHLJJJR-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920000297 Rayon Polymers 0.000 description 1
- KJTLSVCANCCWHF-UHFFFAOYSA-N Ruthenium Chemical compound [Ru] KJTLSVCANCCWHF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BUGBHKTXTAQXES-UHFFFAOYSA-N Selenium Chemical compound [Se] BUGBHKTXTAQXES-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BQCADISMDOOEFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N Silver Chemical compound [Ag] BQCADISMDOOEFD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- KEAYESYHFKHZAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Sodium Chemical compound [Na] KEAYESYHFKHZAL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 235000002597 Solanum melongena Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- PJANXHGTPQOBST-VAWYXSNFSA-N Stilbene Natural products C=1C=CC=CC=1/C=C/C1=CC=CC=C1 PJANXHGTPQOBST-VAWYXSNFSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NINIDFKCEFEMDL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Sulfur Chemical compound [S] NINIDFKCEFEMDL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 102100028692 T-cell leukemia translocation-altered gene protein Human genes 0.000 description 1
- RTAQQCXQSZGOHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N Titanium Chemical compound [Ti] RTAQQCXQSZGOHL-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WGLPBDUCMAPZCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N Trioxochromium Chemical compound O=[Cr](=O)=O WGLPBDUCMAPZCE-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PTFCDOFLOPIGGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N Zinc dication Chemical compound [Zn+2] PTFCDOFLOPIGGS-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HYWNGEYOXQESBM-UHFFFAOYSA-N [1]benzofuro[2,3-b]pyrazine Chemical group C1=CN=C2C3=CC=CC=C3OC2=N1 HYWNGEYOXQESBM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- BJHVGSLMZTVDRA-UHFFFAOYSA-N [1]benzothiolo[2,3-b]pyrazine Chemical group C1=CN=C2C3=CC=CC=C3SC2=N1 BJHVGSLMZTVDRA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- OICJTSLHQGDCTQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N [1]benzothiolo[3,2-d]pyrimidine Chemical group N1=CN=C2C3=CC=CC=C3SC2=C1 OICJTSLHQGDCTQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QGNVPMNDLWXCRF-UHFFFAOYSA-N [Ir+3].CC(=O)OC(C)=O Chemical compound [Ir+3].CC(=O)OC(C)=O QGNVPMNDLWXCRF-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UUZNAHMBDODUEY-UHFFFAOYSA-K [Ir+3].CC=1N(C(NN1)(C(=O)[O-])C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1.CC=1N(C(NN1)(C(=O)[O-])C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1.CC=1N(C(NN1)(C(=O)[O-])C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1 Chemical compound [Ir+3].CC=1N(C(NN1)(C(=O)[O-])C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1.CC=1N(C(NN1)(C(=O)[O-])C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1.CC=1N(C(NN1)(C(=O)[O-])C1=CC=CC=C1)C1=CC=CC=C1 UUZNAHMBDODUEY-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- OEEBMHFZRDUQFW-UHFFFAOYSA-L [Pt](Cl)Cl.C(C)C1=C(C=2C=C3C(=C(C(=CC=4C(=C(C(=CC5=C(C(=C(N5)C=C1N2)CC)CC)N4)CC)CC)N3)CC)CC)CC Chemical compound [Pt](Cl)Cl.C(C)C1=C(C=2C=C3C(=C(C(=CC=4C(=C(C(=CC5=C(C(=C(N5)C=C1N2)CC)CC)N4)CC)CC)N3)CC)CC)CC OEEBMHFZRDUQFW-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- FYNZMQVSXQQRNQ-UHFFFAOYSA-J [Sn](F)(F)(F)F.C(C)C1=C(C=2C=C3C(=C(C(=CC=4C(=C(C(=CC5=C(C(=C(N5)C=C1N2)CC)CC)N4)CC)CC)N3)CC)CC)CC Chemical compound [Sn](F)(F)(F)F.C(C)C1=C(C=2C=C3C(=C(C(=CC=4C(=C(C(=CC5=C(C(=C(N5)C=C1N2)CC)CC)N4)CC)CC)N3)CC)CC)CC FYNZMQVSXQQRNQ-UHFFFAOYSA-J 0.000 description 1
- SUFKFXIFMLKZTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N [Tb+3].N1=CC=CC2=CC=C3C=CC=NC3=C12 Chemical compound [Tb+3].N1=CC=CC2=CC=C3C=CC=NC3=C12 SUFKFXIFMLKZTD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000001251 acridines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000000641 acridinyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC2=NC3=CC=CC=C3C=C12)* 0.000 description 1
- 150000001338 aliphatic hydrocarbons Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910000272 alkali metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910052784 alkaline earth metal Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910000287 alkaline earth metal oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000001342 alkaline earth metals Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229920000109 alkoxy-substituted poly(p-phenylene vinylene) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000005407 aluminoborosilicate glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005576 amination reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000001450 anions Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- FABWRHLTUXLPCY-UHFFFAOYSA-N anthracen-2-yl(trimethyl)silane Chemical compound C1=CC=CC2=CC3=CC([Si](C)(C)C)=CC=C3C=C21 FABWRHLTUXLPCY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229940058303 antinematodal benzimidazole derivative Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 229940027998 antiseptic and disinfectant acridine derivative Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000013459 approach Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003125 aqueous solvent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004760 aramid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052786 argon Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229920003235 aromatic polyamide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229910052785 arsenic Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- RQNWIZPPADIBDY-UHFFFAOYSA-N arsenic atom Chemical compound [As] RQNWIZPPADIBDY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N atomic oxygen Chemical compound [O] QVGXLLKOCUKJST-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002238 attenuated effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910052788 barium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- DSAJWYNOEDNPEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N barium atom Chemical compound [Ba] DSAJWYNOEDNPEQ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- HFACYLZERDEVSX-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzidine Chemical class C1=CC(N)=CC=C1C1=CC=C(N)C=C1 HFACYLZERDEVSX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000001556 benzimidazoles Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- RWCCWEUUXYIKHB-UHFFFAOYSA-N benzophenone Chemical compound C=1C=CC=CC=1C(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1 RWCCWEUUXYIKHB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000012965 benzophenone Substances 0.000 description 1
- MUALRAIOVNYAIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N binap Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1P(C=1C(=C2C=CC=CC2=CC=1)C=1C2=CC=CC=C2C=CC=1P(C=1C=CC=CC=1)C=1C=CC=CC=1)C1=CC=CC=C1 MUALRAIOVNYAIW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000005540 biological transmission Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000000319 biphenyl-4-yl group Chemical group [H]C1=C([H])C([H])=C([H])C([H])=C1C1=C([H])C([H])=C([*])C([H])=C1[H] 0.000 description 1
- 229910052797 bismuth Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- JCXGWMGPZLAOME-UHFFFAOYSA-N bismuth atom Chemical compound [Bi] JCXGWMGPZLAOME-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000009835 boiling Methods 0.000 description 1
- UORVGPXVDQYIDP-BJUDXGSMSA-N borane Chemical compound [10BH3] UORVGPXVDQYIDP-BJUDXGSMSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910000085 borane Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910052796 boron Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000005388 borosilicate glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000005587 bubbling Effects 0.000 description 1
- WUKWITHWXAAZEY-UHFFFAOYSA-L calcium difluoride Chemical compound [F-].[F-].[Ca+2] WUKWITHWXAAZEY-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- BRPQOXSCLDDYGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N calcium oxide Chemical compound [O-2].[Ca+2] BRPQOXSCLDDYGP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000000292 calcium oxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- ODINCKMPIJJUCX-UHFFFAOYSA-N calcium oxide Inorganic materials [Ca]=O ODINCKMPIJJUCX-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000004364 calculation method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000009120 camo Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 125000000609 carbazolyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC=2C3=CC=CC=C3NC12)* 0.000 description 1
- 239000003575 carbonaceous material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003763 carbonization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000001768 cations Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000001913 cellulose Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920002678 cellulose Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 235000005607 chanvre indien Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 229910000423 chromium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011248 coating agent Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000000295 complement effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940125773 compound 10 Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 150000001934 cyclohexanes Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- HHNHBFLGXIUXCM-GFCCVEGCSA-N cyclohexylbenzene Chemical compound [CH]1CCCC[C@@H]1C1=CC=CC=C1 HHNHBFLGXIUXCM-GFCCVEGCSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000001419 dependent effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 238000001514 detection method Methods 0.000 description 1
- WDIIYWASEVHBBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N di(propan-2-yl)phosphane Chemical compound CC(C)PC(C)C WDIIYWASEVHBBT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000005331 diazinyl group Chemical group N1=NC(=CC=C1)* 0.000 description 1
- 150000004826 dibenzofurans Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229940117389 dichlorobenzene Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 235000014113 dietary fatty acids Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000000539 dimer Substances 0.000 description 1
- MHKKFFHWMKEBDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N dimethyl 2,5-dioxocyclohexane-1,4-dicarboxylate Chemical compound COC(=O)C1CC(=O)C(C(=O)OC)CC1=O MHKKFFHWMKEBDW-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000006073 displacement reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229920001971 elastomer Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000010893 electron trap Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000007613 environmental effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- YQGOJNYOYNNSMM-UHFFFAOYSA-N eosin Chemical compound [Na+].OC(=O)C1=CC=CC=C1C1=C2C=C(Br)C(=O)C(Br)=C2OC2=C(Br)C(O)=C(Br)C=C21 YQGOJNYOYNNSMM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000003822 epoxy resin Substances 0.000 description 1
- UYAHIZSMUZPPFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N erbium Chemical compound [Er] UYAHIZSMUZPPFV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000008020 evaporation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000004744 fabric Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000194 fatty acid Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229930195729 fatty acid Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 239000002657 fibrous material Substances 0.000 description 1
- 230000005669 field effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000000945 filler Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000007850 fluorescent dye Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000011737 fluorine Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052731 fluorine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000004773 frontier orbital Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910003472 fullerene Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910052733 gallium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 230000009477 glass transition Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910021389 graphene Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000007646 gravure printing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 150000004795 grignard reagents Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000004820 halides Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000008282 halocarbons Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000011487 hemp Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000005842 heteroatom Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 125000000623 heterocyclic group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000005457 ice water Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000010191 image analysis Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000003384 imaging method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000001041 indolyl group Chemical group 0.000 description 1
- 239000011261 inert gas Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000002484 inorganic compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910010272 inorganic material Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011630 iodine Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052740 iodine Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 150000002503 iridium Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- CECAIMUJVYQLKA-UHFFFAOYSA-N iridium 1-phenylisoquinoline Chemical compound [Ir].C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NC=CC2=CC=CC=C12.C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NC=CC2=CC=CC=C12.C1=CC=CC=C1C1=NC=CC2=CC=CC=C12 CECAIMUJVYQLKA-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- AOZVYCYMTUWJHJ-UHFFFAOYSA-K iridium(3+) pyridine-2-carboxylate Chemical compound [Ir+3].[O-]C(=O)C1=CC=CC=N1.[O-]C(=O)C1=CC=CC=N1.[O-]C(=O)C1=CC=CC=N1 AOZVYCYMTUWJHJ-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 125000004491 isohexyl group Chemical group C(CCC(C)C)* 0.000 description 1
- 238000002955 isolation Methods 0.000 description 1
- 125000001972 isopentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- ZLVXBBHTMQJRSX-VMGNSXQWSA-N jdtic Chemical compound C1([C@]2(C)CCN(C[C@@H]2C)C[C@H](C(C)C)NC(=O)[C@@H]2NCC3=CC(O)=CC=C3C2)=CC=CC(O)=C1 ZLVXBBHTMQJRSX-VMGNSXQWSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000002576 ketones Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000010985 leather Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000007527 lewis bases Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000004973 liquid crystal related substance Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000395 magnesium oxide Substances 0.000 description 1
- CPLXHLVBOLITMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N magnesium oxide Inorganic materials [Mg]=O CPLXHLVBOLITMK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- AXZKOIWUVFPNLO-UHFFFAOYSA-N magnesium;oxygen(2-) Chemical compound [O-2].[Mg+2] AXZKOIWUVFPNLO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000005389 magnetism Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229940098779 methanesulfonic acid Drugs 0.000 description 1
- OJURWUUOVGOHJZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N methyl 2-[(2-acetyloxyphenyl)methyl-[2-[(2-acetyloxyphenyl)methyl-(2-methoxy-2-oxoethyl)amino]ethyl]amino]acetate Chemical compound C=1C=CC=C(OC(C)=O)C=1CN(CC(=O)OC)CCN(CC(=O)OC)CC1=CC=CC=C1OC(C)=O OJURWUUOVGOHJZ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000011259 mixed solution Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910052750 molybdenum Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011733 molybdenum Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000000178 monomer Substances 0.000 description 1
- CMLCVSPDRZVSRT-UHFFFAOYSA-N n,9-diphenyl-n-(9,9'-spirobi[fluorene]-2-yl)carbazol-3-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C=2C(=CC=CC=2)C23C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C43)C2=C1 CMLCVSPDRZVSRT-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WOYDRSOIBHFMGB-UHFFFAOYSA-N n,9-diphenyl-n-(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)carbazol-3-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3=CC=CC=C3N(C=3C=CC=CC=3)C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(N(C=2C=CC=CC=2)C=2C3=CC=CC=2)C3=C1 WOYDRSOIBHFMGB-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MSCLVLGBAGCXEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N n-phenyl-n-[4-(9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl)phenyl]-9,9'-spirobi[fluorene]-2-amine Chemical compound C1=CC=CC=C1N(C=1C=C2C3(C4=CC=CC=C4C4=CC=CC=C43)C3=CC=CC=C3C2=CC=1)C1=CC=C(C=2C=C3C4=CC=CC=C4N(C=4C=CC=CC=4)C3=CC=2)C=C1 MSCLVLGBAGCXEC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000004123 n-propyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 239000002121 nanofiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002105 nanoparticle Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000002073 nanorod Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000001971 neopentyl group Chemical group [H]C([*])([H])C(C([H])([H])[H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 229910000484 niobium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- URLJKFSTXLNXLG-UHFFFAOYSA-N niobium(5+);oxygen(2-) Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[Nb+5].[Nb+5] URLJKFSTXLNXLG-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000002825 nitriles Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000004433 nitrogen atom Chemical group N* 0.000 description 1
- 125000002868 norbornyl group Chemical group C12(CCC(CC1)C2)* 0.000 description 1
- 229920001778 nylon Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000005457 optimization Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000006053 organic reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 239000003960 organic solvent Substances 0.000 description 1
- SYQBFIAQOQZEGI-UHFFFAOYSA-N osmium atom Chemical compound [Os] SYQBFIAQOQZEGI-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- WCPAKWJPBJAGKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxadiazole Chemical group C1=CON=N1 WCPAKWJPBJAGKN-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- MPQXHAGKBWFSNV-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxidophosphanium Chemical group [PH3]=O MPQXHAGKBWFSNV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- DYIZHKNUQPHNJY-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxorhenium Chemical compound [Re]=O DYIZHKNUQPHNJY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229910052760 oxygen Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000001301 oxygen Substances 0.000 description 1
- BPUBBGLMJRNUCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N oxygen(2-);tantalum(5+) Chemical compound [O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[O-2].[Ta+5].[Ta+5] BPUBBGLMJRNUCC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- NRNFFDZCBYOZJY-UHFFFAOYSA-N p-quinodimethane Chemical class C=C1C=CC(=C)C=C1 NRNFFDZCBYOZJY-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000002941 palladium compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- PENAXHPKEVTBLF-UHFFFAOYSA-L palladium(2+);prop-1-ene;dichloride Chemical compound [Pd+]Cl.[Pd+]Cl.[CH2-]C=C.[CH2-]C=C PENAXHPKEVTBLF-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- PIBWKRNGBLPSSY-UHFFFAOYSA-L palladium(II) chloride Chemical compound Cl[Pd]Cl PIBWKRNGBLPSSY-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 239000002245 particle Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000005192 partition Methods 0.000 description 1
- JZRYQZJSTWVBBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N pentaporphyrin i Chemical compound N1C(C=C2NC(=CC3=NC(=C4)C=C3)C=C2)=CC=C1C=C1C=CC4=N1 JZRYQZJSTWVBBD-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 230000002093 peripheral effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 125000001791 phenazinyl group Chemical group C1(=CC=CC2=NC3=CC=CC=C3N=C12)* 0.000 description 1
- 229950000688 phenothiazine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- BZBAYMUKLAYQEO-UHFFFAOYSA-N phenylborane Chemical compound BC1=CC=CC=C1 BZBAYMUKLAYQEO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 150000004986 phenylenediamines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000005359 phenylpyridines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910052698 phosphorus Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011574 phosphorus Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000000103 photoluminescence spectrum Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000704 physical effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 150000003057 platinum Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- HRGDZIGMBDGFTC-UHFFFAOYSA-N platinum(2+) Chemical compound [Pt+2] HRGDZIGMBDGFTC-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 229920000172 poly(styrenesulfonic acid) Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001281 polyalkylene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002647 polyamide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000767 polyaniline Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920001230 polyarylate Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000004417 polycarbonate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000515 polycarbonate Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920000647 polyepoxide Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000011112 polyethylene naphthalate Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920001155 polypropylene Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 229920002635 polyurethane Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000004814 polyurethane Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000004800 polyvinyl chloride Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920000915 polyvinyl chloride Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 238000005381 potential energy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000003825 pressing Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229960000286 proflavine Drugs 0.000 description 1
- 238000004549 pulsed laser deposition Methods 0.000 description 1
- VLRICFVOGGIMKK-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyrazol-1-yloxyboronic acid Chemical compound OB(O)ON1C=CC=N1 VLRICFVOGGIMKK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- PBMFSQRYOILNGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyridazine Chemical group C1=CC=NN=C1 PBMFSQRYOILNGV-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- UMJSCPRVCHMLSP-UHFFFAOYSA-N pyridine Natural products COC1=CC=CN=C1 UMJSCPRVCHMLSP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000002943 quinolinyl group Chemical group N1=C(C=CC2=CC=CC=C12)* 0.000 description 1
- 125000001567 quinoxalinyl group Chemical class N1=C(C=NC2=CC=CC=C12)* 0.000 description 1
- 230000005855 radiation Effects 0.000 description 1
- 150000002909 rare earth metal compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 239000002964 rayon Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000011541 reaction mixture Substances 0.000 description 1
- WPPDXAHGCGPUPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N red 2 Chemical group C1=CC=CC=C1C(C1=CC=CC=C11)=C(C=2C=3C4=CC=C5C6=CC=C7C8=C(C=9C=CC=CC=9)C9=CC=CC=C9C(C=9C=CC=CC=9)=C8C8=CC=C(C6=C87)C(C=35)=CC=2)C4=C1C1=CC=CC=C1 WPPDXAHGCGPUPK-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000012827 research and development Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000004044 response Effects 0.000 description 1
- 229910003449 rhenium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000007363 ring formation reaction Methods 0.000 description 1
- 230000000630 rising effect Effects 0.000 description 1
- 239000005060 rubber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910001925 ruthenium oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- WOCIAKWEIIZHES-UHFFFAOYSA-N ruthenium(iv) oxide Chemical compound O=[Ru]=O WOCIAKWEIIZHES-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000003548 sec-pentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C([H])(*)C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 229910052711 selenium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 238000000926 separation method Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052709 silver Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000004332 silver Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000005361 soda-lime glass Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000030 sodium bicarbonate Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 235000017557 sodium bicarbonate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- PUZPDOWCWNUUKD-UHFFFAOYSA-M sodium fluoride Chemical compound [F-].[Na+] PUZPDOWCWNUUKD-UHFFFAOYSA-M 0.000 description 1
- 239000012312 sodium hydride Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910000104 sodium hydride Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- AKHNMLFCWUSKQB-UHFFFAOYSA-L sodium thiosulfate Chemical compound [Na+].[Na+].[O-]S([O-])(=O)=S AKHNMLFCWUSKQB-UHFFFAOYSA-L 0.000 description 1
- 235000019345 sodium thiosulphate Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 238000004528 spin coating Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000004544 sputter deposition Methods 0.000 description 1
- 235000021286 stilbenes Nutrition 0.000 description 1
- 239000004575 stone Substances 0.000 description 1
- 238000003860 storage Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000005728 strengthening Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229910052717 sulfur Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000011593 sulfur Substances 0.000 description 1
- 239000003115 supporting electrolyte Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229920002994 synthetic fiber Polymers 0.000 description 1
- 239000012209 synthetic fiber Substances 0.000 description 1
- 229910001936 tantalum oxide Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 229910052714 tellurium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- PORWMNRCUJJQNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N tellurium atom Chemical compound [Te] PORWMNRCUJJQNO-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 125000001981 tert-butyldimethylsilyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])[Si]([H])(C([H])([H])[H])[*]C(C([H])([H])[H])(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000001973 tert-pentyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])C([H])([H])C(*)(C([H])([H])[H])C([H])([H])[H] 0.000 description 1
- 125000003698 tetramethyl group Chemical group [H]C([H])([H])* 0.000 description 1
- 238000002411 thermogravimetry Methods 0.000 description 1
- 229930192474 thiophene Natural products 0.000 description 1
- 150000003606 tin compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 229910052719 titanium Inorganic materials 0.000 description 1
- 239000010936 titanium Substances 0.000 description 1
- 150000003623 transition metal compounds Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 150000003918 triazines Chemical class 0.000 description 1
- 125000002306 tributylsilyl group Chemical group C(CCC)[Si](CCCC)(CCCC)* 0.000 description 1
- QGJSAGBHFTXOTM-UHFFFAOYSA-K trifluoroerbium Chemical compound F[Er](F)F QGJSAGBHFTXOTM-UHFFFAOYSA-K 0.000 description 1
- 125000002023 trifluoromethyl group Chemical group FC(F)(F)* 0.000 description 1
- UORVGPXVDQYIDP-UHFFFAOYSA-N trihydridoboron Substances B UORVGPXVDQYIDP-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 238000000870 ultraviolet spectroscopy Methods 0.000 description 1
- 238000001771 vacuum deposition Methods 0.000 description 1
- PXXNTAGJWPJAGM-UHFFFAOYSA-N vertaline Natural products C1C2C=3C=C(OC)C(OC)=CC=3OC(C=C3)=CC=C3CCC(=O)OC1CC1N2CCCC1 PXXNTAGJWPJAGM-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 239000002023 wood Substances 0.000 description 1
- 125000001834 xanthenyl group Chemical group C1=CC=CC=2OC3=CC=CC=C3C(C12)* 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K85/00—Organic materials used in the body or electrodes of devices covered by this subclass
- H10K85/60—Organic compounds having low molecular weight
- H10K85/631—Amine compounds having at least two aryl rest on at least one amine-nitrogen atom, e.g. triphenylamine
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K85/00—Organic materials used in the body or electrodes of devices covered by this subclass
- H10K85/60—Organic compounds having low molecular weight
- H10K85/631—Amine compounds having at least two aryl rest on at least one amine-nitrogen atom, e.g. triphenylamine
- H10K85/633—Amine compounds having at least two aryl rest on at least one amine-nitrogen atom, e.g. triphenylamine comprising polycyclic condensed aromatic hydrocarbons as substituents on the nitrogen atom
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07C—ACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07C211/00—Compounds containing amino groups bound to a carbon skeleton
- C07C211/43—Compounds containing amino groups bound to a carbon skeleton having amino groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings of the carbon skeleton
- C07C211/57—Compounds containing amino groups bound to a carbon skeleton having amino groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings of the carbon skeleton having amino groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings being part of condensed ring systems of the carbon skeleton
- C07C211/61—Compounds containing amino groups bound to a carbon skeleton having amino groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings of the carbon skeleton having amino groups bound to carbon atoms of six-membered aromatic rings being part of condensed ring systems of the carbon skeleton with at least one of the condensed ring systems formed by three or more rings
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D471/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
- C07D471/02—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
- C07D471/04—Ortho-condensed systems
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07F—ACYCLIC, CARBOCYCLIC OR HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS CONTAINING ELEMENTS OTHER THAN CARBON, HYDROGEN, HALOGEN, OXYGEN, NITROGEN, SULFUR, SELENIUM OR TELLURIUM
- C07F7/00—Compounds containing elements of Groups 4 or 14 of the Periodic Table
- C07F7/02—Silicon compounds
- C07F7/08—Compounds having one or more C—Si linkages
- C07F7/0803—Compounds with Si-C or Si-Si linkages
- C07F7/0805—Compounds with Si-C or Si-Si linkages comprising only Si, C or H atoms
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07F—ACYCLIC, CARBOCYCLIC OR HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS CONTAINING ELEMENTS OTHER THAN CARBON, HYDROGEN, HALOGEN, OXYGEN, NITROGEN, SULFUR, SELENIUM OR TELLURIUM
- C07F7/00—Compounds containing elements of Groups 4 or 14 of the Periodic Table
- C07F7/02—Silicon compounds
- C07F7/08—Compounds having one or more C—Si linkages
- C07F7/0803—Compounds with Si-C or Si-Si linkages
- C07F7/081—Compounds with Si-C or Si-Si linkages comprising at least one atom selected from the elements N, O, halogen, S, Se or Te
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07F—ACYCLIC, CARBOCYCLIC OR HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS CONTAINING ELEMENTS OTHER THAN CARBON, HYDROGEN, HALOGEN, OXYGEN, NITROGEN, SULFUR, SELENIUM OR TELLURIUM
- C07F7/00—Compounds containing elements of Groups 4 or 14 of the Periodic Table
- C07F7/02—Silicon compounds
- C07F7/08—Compounds having one or more C—Si linkages
- C07F7/10—Compounds having one or more C—Si linkages containing nitrogen having a Si-N linkage
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C09—DYES; PAINTS; POLISHES; NATURAL RESINS; ADHESIVES; COMPOSITIONS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; APPLICATIONS OF MATERIALS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- C09K—MATERIALS FOR MISCELLANEOUS APPLICATIONS, NOT PROVIDED FOR ELSEWHERE
- C09K11/00—Luminescent, e.g. electroluminescent, chemiluminescent materials
- C09K11/06—Luminescent, e.g. electroluminescent, chemiluminescent materials containing organic luminescent materials
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G02—OPTICS
- G02B—OPTICAL ELEMENTS, SYSTEMS OR APPARATUS
- G02B5/00—Optical elements other than lenses
- G02B5/20—Filters
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H05—ELECTRIC TECHNIQUES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H05B—ELECTRIC HEATING; ELECTRIC LIGHT SOURCES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; CIRCUIT ARRANGEMENTS FOR ELECTRIC LIGHT SOURCES, IN GENERAL
- H05B33/00—Electroluminescent light sources
- H05B33/12—Light sources with substantially two-dimensional radiating surfaces
- H05B33/20—Light sources with substantially two-dimensional radiating surfaces characterised by the chemical or physical composition or the arrangement of the material in which the electroluminescent material is embedded
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K50/00—Organic light-emitting devices
- H10K50/10—OLEDs or polymer light-emitting diodes [PLED]
- H10K50/11—OLEDs or polymer light-emitting diodes [PLED] characterised by the electroluminescent [EL] layers
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K59/00—Integrated devices, or assemblies of multiple devices, comprising at least one organic light-emitting element covered by group H10K50/00
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K85/00—Organic materials used in the body or electrodes of devices covered by this subclass
- H10K85/40—Organosilicon compounds, e.g. TIPS pentacene
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K85/00—Organic materials used in the body or electrodes of devices covered by this subclass
- H10K85/60—Organic compounds having low molecular weight
- H10K85/649—Aromatic compounds comprising a hetero atom
- H10K85/657—Polycyclic condensed heteroaromatic hydrocarbons
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K85/00—Organic materials used in the body or electrodes of devices covered by this subclass
- H10K85/791—Starburst compounds
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07C—ACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07C2601/00—Systems containing only non-condensed rings
- C07C2601/12—Systems containing only non-condensed rings with a six-membered ring
- C07C2601/14—The ring being saturated
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07C—ACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07C2603/00—Systems containing at least three condensed rings
- C07C2603/02—Ortho- or ortho- and peri-condensed systems
- C07C2603/04—Ortho- or ortho- and peri-condensed systems containing three rings
- C07C2603/22—Ortho- or ortho- and peri-condensed systems containing three rings containing only six-membered rings
- C07C2603/24—Anthracenes; Hydrogenated anthracenes
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C09—DYES; PAINTS; POLISHES; NATURAL RESINS; ADHESIVES; COMPOSITIONS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; APPLICATIONS OF MATERIALS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- C09K—MATERIALS FOR MISCELLANEOUS APPLICATIONS, NOT PROVIDED FOR ELSEWHERE
- C09K2211/00—Chemical nature of organic luminescent or tenebrescent compounds
- C09K2211/10—Non-macromolecular compounds
- C09K2211/1003—Carbocyclic compounds
- C09K2211/1007—Non-condensed systems
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C09—DYES; PAINTS; POLISHES; NATURAL RESINS; ADHESIVES; COMPOSITIONS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; APPLICATIONS OF MATERIALS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- C09K—MATERIALS FOR MISCELLANEOUS APPLICATIONS, NOT PROVIDED FOR ELSEWHERE
- C09K2211/00—Chemical nature of organic luminescent or tenebrescent compounds
- C09K2211/10—Non-macromolecular compounds
- C09K2211/1003—Carbocyclic compounds
- C09K2211/1011—Condensed systems
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C09—DYES; PAINTS; POLISHES; NATURAL RESINS; ADHESIVES; COMPOSITIONS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR; APPLICATIONS OF MATERIALS NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- C09K—MATERIALS FOR MISCELLANEOUS APPLICATIONS, NOT PROVIDED FOR ELSEWHERE
- C09K2211/00—Chemical nature of organic luminescent or tenebrescent compounds
- C09K2211/10—Non-macromolecular compounds
- C09K2211/1003—Carbocyclic compounds
- C09K2211/1014—Carbocyclic compounds bridged by heteroatoms, e.g. N, P, Si or B
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K2101/00—Properties of the organic materials covered by group H10K85/00
- H10K2101/10—Triplet emission
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K2101/00—Properties of the organic materials covered by group H10K85/00
- H10K2101/20—Delayed fluorescence emission
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K2101/00—Properties of the organic materials covered by group H10K85/00
- H10K2101/27—Combination of fluorescent and phosphorescent emission
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K59/00—Integrated devices, or assemblies of multiple devices, comprising at least one organic light-emitting element covered by group H10K50/00
- H10K59/10—OLED displays
- H10K59/12—Active-matrix OLED [AMOLED] displays
- H10K59/121—Active-matrix OLED [AMOLED] displays characterised by the geometry or disposition of pixel elements
- H10K59/1213—Active-matrix OLED [AMOLED] displays characterised by the geometry or disposition of pixel elements the pixel elements being TFTs
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H10—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES; ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES NOT OTHERWISE PROVIDED FOR
- H10K—ORGANIC ELECTRIC SOLID-STATE DEVICES
- H10K85/00—Organic materials used in the body or electrodes of devices covered by this subclass
- H10K85/60—Organic compounds having low molecular weight
- H10K85/615—Polycyclic condensed aromatic hydrocarbons, e.g. anthracene
-
- Y—GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y02—TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
- Y02P—CLIMATE CHANGE MITIGATION TECHNOLOGIES IN THE PRODUCTION OR PROCESSING OF GOODS
- Y02P20/00—Technologies relating to chemical industry
- Y02P20/50—Improvements relating to the production of bulk chemicals
- Y02P20/55—Design of synthesis routes, e.g. reducing the use of auxiliary or protecting groups
Definitions
- One embodiment of the present invention relates to a light-emitting element, an organic compound, or a display device, an electronic device, and a lighting device each having the light-emitting element.
- one embodiment of the present invention is not limited to the above technical field.
- the technical field of one embodiment of the invention disclosed in this specification and the like relates to an object, a method, or a manufacturing method.
- one embodiment of the present invention relates to a process, a machine, a manufacture, or a composition (composition of matter). Therefore, the technical field of one embodiment of the present invention disclosed in this specification more specifically includes a semiconductor device, a display device, a liquid crystal display device, a light-emitting device, a lighting device, a power storage device, a memory device, a driving method thereof, Alternatively, the production method thereof can be given as an example.
- the basic structure of these light-emitting elements is a structure in which a layer containing a light-emitting substance (EL layer) is sandwiched between a pair of electrodes. Light emission from a light-emitting substance can be obtained by applying a voltage between the electrodes of this element.
- EL layer a layer containing a light-emitting substance
- a display device using the light-emitting element has advantages such as excellent visibility, no need for a backlight, and low power consumption. Furthermore, it has advantages such as being thin and light and capable of high response speed.
- a light-emitting element for example, an organic EL element
- an organic compound for example, an organic EL element
- an EL layer including the light-emitting organic compound is provided between a pair of electrodes
- a voltage is applied between the pair of electrodes.
- electrons from the cathode and holes from the anode are injected into the light-emitting EL layer, and a current flows.
- the injected electrons and holes are recombined, the light-emitting organic compound is in an excited state, and light emission can be obtained from the excited light-emitting organic compound.
- the types of excited states formed by an organic compound include a singlet excited state (S * ) and a triplet excited state (T * ).
- the emission from the singlet excited state is fluorescence, and the emission from the triplet excited state is It is called phosphorescence.
- light-emitting elements using phosphorescent materials in particular, light-emitting elements that emit blue light have not yet been put into practical use because it is difficult to develop a stable compound having a high triplet excitation energy level. Therefore, a light emitting element using a more stable fluorescent material has been developed, and a method for increasing the light emission efficiency of the light emitting element (fluorescent light emitting element) using the fluorescent material is being searched for.
- thermally activated delayed fluorescence (TADF) materials are known as materials capable of converting part or all of triplet excited state energy into luminescence. .
- TADF thermally activated delayed fluorescence
- a singlet excited state is efficiently generated from a triplet excited state but also a singlet excited state in a thermally activated delayed fluorescent material. It is important that light emission is efficiently obtained from the term excited state, that is, that the fluorescence quantum yield is high. However, it is difficult to design a light-emitting material that satisfies these two simultaneously.
- a fluorescent material that is a guest material after converting triplet excitons of the host material into singlet excitons And a method of transferring singlet excitation energy to.
- the process in which the triplet excitation energy of the host material described above is converted into singlet excitation energy competes with the process in which the triplet excitation energy is deactivated. For this reason, the triplet excitation energy of the host material may not be sufficiently converted to singlet excitation energy.
- the lowest triplet excitation energy level (T 1 level) of the fluorescent material is included.
- T 1 level triplet excitation energy level
- This deactivation path can be suppressed by reducing the concentration of the guest material, but at the same time, the energy transfer rate from the host material to the singlet excited state of the guest material is also slowed down, which is caused by deteriorated substances and impurities. Quenching easily occurs. For this reason, the luminance of the light emitting device is likely to decrease, leading to a decrease in reliability.
- the triplet excitation energy in the light emitting layer can be efficiently converted into singlet excitation energy, and the triplet excitation energy is converted into a fluorescent light emitting material. It is preferable to transfer energy efficiently as singlet excitation energy. Therefore, there is a demand for the development of a method and a material that efficiently generate a singlet excited state of a guest material from a triplet excited state of a host material, further improve the light emission efficiency of the light emitting element, and improve the reliability.
- the triplet excitation energy of the host material is suppressed from moving to the T 1 level of the guest material,
- the object is to efficiently convert the term excitation energy into the singlet excitation energy of the guest material, increase the fluorescence emission efficiency of the light emitting device, and further improve the reliability.
- Another object of one embodiment of the present invention is to provide a light-emitting element with reduced power consumption. Another object of one embodiment of the present invention is to provide a novel light-emitting element. Another object of one embodiment of the present invention is to provide a novel light-emitting device. Another object of one embodiment of the present invention is to provide a novel display device. Another object is to provide a novel organic compound.
- one embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element having a light-emitting layer between a pair of electrodes, and the light-emitting layer includes a first material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy to light emission, and singlet excitation energy.
- a second material having a function of converting luminescence into luminescence has a luminophore and five or more protecting groups, and the luminophore is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring,
- the at least one protecting group is each independently an alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, or a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms.
- 1 is a light-emitting element that can emit light from the second material.
- At least four of the five or more protecting groups are each independently an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and 3 carbon atoms. It is preferably any one of twelve or less trialkylsilyl groups.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element having a light-emitting layer between a pair of electrodes, and the light-emitting layer includes a first material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission, and a singlet.
- a second material having a function of converting excitation energy into luminescence has a luminophore and at least four protecting groups, and the luminophore is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring;
- the four protecting groups are not directly bonded to the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring, and each of the four protecting groups is independently an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted carbon group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element having a light-emitting layer between a pair of electrodes, and the light-emitting layer includes a first material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission, and a singlet.
- a second material having a function of converting excitation energy into luminescence has a luminophore and two or more diarylamino groups, and the luminophore is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring;
- the fused aromatic ring or the fused heteroaromatic ring is bonded to two or more diarylamino groups, and the aryl groups in the two or more diarylamino groups each independently have at least one protecting group, Independently, having any one of an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms;
- Material of Et emission is obtained is a light-emitting element.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element having a light-emitting layer between a pair of electrodes, and the light-emitting layer includes a first material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission, and a singlet.
- a second material having a function of converting excitation energy into luminescence has a luminophore and two or more diarylamino groups, and the luminophore is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring;
- the fused aromatic ring or the fused heteroaromatic ring is bonded to two or more diarylamino groups, and the aryl groups in the two or more diarylamino groups each independently have at least two protective groups, Independently, it has any one of a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms, Second Light emission can be obtained from the material, a light-emitting element.
- the diarylamino group is preferably a diphenylamino group.
- the alkyl group is preferably a branched alkyl group.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element having a light-emitting layer between a pair of electrodes, and the light-emitting layer includes a first material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission, and a singlet.
- a second material having a function of converting excitation energy into light emission has a luminophore and a plurality of protecting groups; the luminophore is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring; At least one of the atoms constituting the protecting group is located immediately above one surface of the condensed aromatic ring or condensed heteroaromatic ring, and at least one of the atoms constituting the plurality of protecting groups is a condensed aromatic ring or condensed It is a light emitting element which is located immediately above the other surface of the heteroaromatic ring and can emit light from the second material.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element having a light-emitting layer between a pair of electrodes, and the light-emitting layer includes a first material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission, and a singlet.
- a second material having a function of converting excitation energy into luminescence has a luminophore and two or more diphenylamino groups, and the luminophore is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring;
- the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring is bonded to two or more diphenylamino groups, and the phenyl groups in the two or more diphenylamino groups each independently have a protecting group at the 3-position and the 5-position,
- Each independently has any one of an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms.
- the second material Et emission is obtained is a light-emitting element.
- the alkyl group is preferably a branched alkyl group.
- the branched alkyl group preferably has a quaternary carbon.
- the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring preferably contains any one of naphthalene, anthracene, fluorene, chrysene, triphenylene, pyrene, tetracene, perylene, coumarin, quinacridone, and naphthobisbenzofuran.
- the first material preferably includes a first organic compound and a second organic compound, and the first organic compound and the second organic compound preferably form an exciplex. More preferably, the first organic compound exhibits phosphorescence.
- the first material exhibits phosphorescence.
- the emission spectrum of the first material preferably overlaps with the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the second material.
- the concentration of the second material in the light-emitting layer is preferably 2 wt% or more and 30 wt% or less.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is an organic compound represented by General Formula (G1) or (G2) below.
- A represents a substituted or unsubstituted condensed aromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms or a substituted or unsubstituted condensed heteroaromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms
- Ar 1 to Ar 6 each independently represents a substituted or unsubstituted aromatic hydrocarbon group having 6 to 13 carbon atoms
- X 1 to X 12 each independently represents an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms
- substituted or unsubstituted carbon represents any one of a cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms
- R 1 to R 10 are each independently hydrogen, an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms
- It represents any one of a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms.
- the organic compound is preferably an organic compound represented by the following general formula (G3) or (G4).
- A represents a substituted or unsubstituted condensed aromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms or a substituted or unsubstituted condensed heteroaromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms
- X 1 to X 12 each independently represents any one of an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms
- R 1 , R 3 , R 6 and R 8 are each independently hydrogen, an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and 3 to 12 carbon atoms.
- the organic compound is preferably an organic compound represented by General Formula (G5) below.
- X 1 to X 8 are each independently an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and 3 to 12 carbon atoms.
- R 11 to R 18 each independently represent hydrogen, an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, carbon, It represents any one of a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms and a substituted or unsubstituted aryl group having 6 to 25 carbon atoms.
- the alkyl group is preferably a branched alkyl group.
- the branched alkyl preferably has a quaternary carbon.
- the organic compound has the following structural formulas (102) to (104), (221), (222), (225), (229), (250), (254), (257), ( It is more preferable that it is an organic compound represented by any one of 261) and (264).
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a light-emitting element using any one or more of the above organic compounds.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a display device including the light-emitting element having any of the above structures and at least one of a color filter and a transistor.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is an electronic device including the display device and at least one of a housing and a touch sensor.
- Another embodiment of the present invention is a lighting device including the light-emitting element having any of the above structures and at least one of a housing and a touch sensor.
- One embodiment of the present invention includes not only a light-emitting device including a light-emitting element but also an electronic device including the light-emitting device. Therefore, a light-emitting device in this specification refers to an image display device or a light source (including a lighting device).
- a display module in which a connector such as an FPC (Flexible Printed Circuit) or TCP (Tape Carrier Package) is attached to the light emitting device a display module in which a printed wiring board is provided at the end of TCP, or a COG (Chip On) in the light emitting element.
- a display module in which an IC (integrated circuit) is directly mounted by a glass method may also include a light emitting (display) device.
- a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be provided.
- a light-emitting element with high reliability can be provided.
- a light-emitting element with reduced power consumption can be provided.
- a novel light-emitting element can be provided.
- a novel light-emitting device can be provided.
- a novel display device can be provided.
- a novel organic compound can be provided.
- FIGS. 3A and 3B are a structural formula and a ball stick diagram of a guest material used in a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- 4A and 4B are a schematic cross-sectional view of a light-emitting layer of a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention and a diagram illustrating a correlation between energy levels.
- 4A and 4B are a schematic cross-sectional view of a light-emitting layer of a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention and a diagram illustrating a correlation between energy levels.
- 4A and 4B are a schematic cross-sectional view of a light-emitting layer of a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention and a diagram illustrating a correlation between energy levels.
- FIG. 9 is a schematic cross-sectional view of a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- 4A and 4B are a top view and cross-sectional schematic views illustrating a display device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 10 is a schematic cross-sectional view illustrating a display device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 10 is a schematic cross-sectional view illustrating a display device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 10 is a perspective view illustrating a display module of one embodiment of the present invention.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electronic device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 14 is a perspective view illustrating a display device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 10 illustrates a lighting device of one embodiment of the present invention.
- the figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- concentration based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example The figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example The figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example The figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- the figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example The figure explaining the reliability measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- concentration based on an Example.
- FIG. 6 illustrates external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of a light-emitting element according to a reference example.
- FIG. 14 illustrates an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to a reference example.
- the figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a comparative light-emitting element according to an example.
- 10A and 10B illustrate a reliability measurement result of a comparative light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- concentration based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example The figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example. The figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example. The figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example. The figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example. The figure explaining the light emission lifetime measurement result of the light emitting element based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the relationship between light emission of an energy donor and absorption of a guest material based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the relationship between light emission of an energy donor and absorption of a guest material based on an Example The figure explaining the relationship between light emission of an energy donor and absorption of a guest material based on an Example.
- the figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the NMR chart of the compound based on an Example. The figure explaining the absorption and emission spectrum of a compound based on an Example. 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example. 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example. The figure explaining the relationship between external quantum efficiency and guest material density
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristic of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- 6A and 6B illustrate an electroluminescence spectrum of a light-emitting element according to an example.
- the ordinal numbers attached as the first and second are used for convenience, and may not indicate the process order or the stacking order. Therefore, for example, the description can be made by appropriately replacing “first” with “second” or “third”.
- the ordinal numbers described in this specification and the like may not match the ordinal numbers used to specify one embodiment of the present invention.
- film and “layer” can be interchanged.
- conductive layer may be changed to the term “conductive film”.
- insulating film may be changed to the term “insulating layer” in some cases.
- a singlet excited state is a singlet state having excitation energy.
- the S1 level is the lowest singlet excitation energy level, and is the lowest singlet excited state (S1 state) excitation energy level.
- the triplet excited state (T * ) is a triplet state having excitation energy.
- the T1 level is the lowest triplet excitation energy level, and is the lowest triplet excited state (T1 state) excitation energy level. Note that in this specification and the like, even when expressed simply as a singlet excited state and a singlet excited energy level, the S1 state and the S1 level may be represented. Further, even when expressed as a triplet excited state and a triplet excited energy level, the T1 state and the T1 level may be expressed in some cases.
- a fluorescent material is a compound that emits light in the visible light region when relaxing from a singlet excited state to a ground state.
- a phosphorescent material is a compound that emits light in the visible light region at room temperature when relaxing from a triplet excited state to a ground state.
- a phosphorescent material is one of compounds that can convert triplet excitation energy into visible light.
- room temperature refers to a temperature in the range of 0 ° C. to 40 ° C.
- the blue wavelength region is not less than 400 nm and less than 490 nm, and the blue light emission has at least one emission spectrum peak in the wavelength region.
- the green wavelength region is not less than 490 nm and less than 580 nm, and the green light emission has at least one emission spectrum peak in the wavelength region.
- the red wavelength region is from 580 nm to 680 nm, and the red light emission has at least one emission spectrum peak in the wavelength region.
- FIG. 1A is a schematic cross-sectional view of a light-emitting element 150 of one embodiment of the present invention.
- the light-emitting element 150 includes a pair of electrodes (the electrode 101 and the electrode 102) and the EL layer 100 provided between the pair of electrodes.
- the EL layer 100 includes at least a light emitting layer 130.
- the EL layer 100 illustrated in FIG. 1A includes functional layers such as a hole injection layer 111, a hole transport layer 112, an electron transport layer 118, and an electron injection layer 119.
- the electrode 101 is used as an anode and the electrode 102 is used as a cathode, but the structure of the light-emitting element 150 is not limited thereto. That is, the electrode 101 may be a cathode, the electrode 102 may be an anode, and the layers stacked between the electrodes may be reversed. That is, from the anode side, the hole injection layer 111, the hole transport layer 112, the light emitting layer 130, the electron transport layer 118, and the electron injection layer 119 may be stacked.
- the structure of the EL layer 100 is not limited to the structure shown in FIG. 1A, and is selected from the hole injection layer 111, the hole transport layer 112, the electron transport layer 118, and the electron injection layer 119. What is necessary is just to set it as the structure which has at least one.
- the EL layer 100 reduces a hole or electron injection barrier, improves a hole or electron transport property, inhibits a hole or electron transport property, or suppresses a quenching phenomenon caused by an electrode. It is good also as a structure which has a functional layer which has the function of being able to do.
- each functional layer may be a single layer or a structure in which a plurality of layers are stacked.
- the light-emitting element 150 of one embodiment of the present invention when a voltage is applied between the pair of electrodes (the electrode 101 and the electrode 102), electrons from the cathode and holes from the anode are applied to the EL layer 100, respectively. It is injected and current flows.
- excitons generated by recombination of carriers (electrons and holes)
- the ratio of singlet excitons to triplet excitons (hereinafter, exciton generation probability) is 1: 3 due to statistical probability. That is, the rate at which singlet excitons are generated is 25%, and the rate at which triplet excitons are generated is 75%, so that the triplet excitons contribute to light emission improves the light emitting efficiency of the light emitting element. It is important to make it happen. Therefore, a material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission is preferably used for the light-emitting layer 130.
- a compound capable of emitting phosphorescence (hereinafter, also referred to as a phosphorescent material) can be given.
- a phosphorescent material refers to a compound that exhibits phosphorescence and does not exhibit fluorescence in any temperature range from low temperature (for example, 77 K) to room temperature (that is, from 77 K to 313 K).
- the phosphorescent material preferably includes a metal element having a large spin-orbit interaction, and specifically, a transition metal element is preferable.
- a platinum group element ruthenium (Ru), rhodium (Rh), palladium (Pd), It is preferable to have osmium (Os), iridium (Ir), or platinum (Pt)), and by having iridium among them, the transition probability related to the direct transition between the singlet ground state and the triplet excited state is increased. Can be preferable.
- a TADF material is a material in which the difference between the S1 level and the T1 level is small and energy can be converted from triplet excitation energy to singlet excitation energy by inverse intersystem crossing. Therefore, the triplet excitation energy can be up-converted to singlet excitation energy with a slight thermal energy (reciprocal crossing), and a singlet excited state can be efficiently generated.
- an exciplex (also referred to as an exciplex, exciplex, or exciplex) that forms an excited state with two kinds of substances has a very small difference between the S1 level and the T1 level, and triplet excitation energy is converted to singlet excitation energy. It functions as a TADF material that can be converted into
- a phosphorescence spectrum observed at a low temperature may be used.
- a tangent line is drawn at the bottom of the short wavelength side of the fluorescence spectrum at room temperature or low temperature
- the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolated line is set to the S1 level
- a tangent line is drawn at the bottom of the short wavelength side of the phosphorescence spectrum.
- the difference between S1 and T1 is preferably 0.2 eV or less.
- a nanostructure of a transition metal compound having a perovskite structure can be given. Particularly preferred are nanostructures of metal halide perovskites. As the nanostructure, nanoparticles and nanorods are preferable.
- FIG. 1B is a schematic cross-sectional view illustrating the light-emitting layer 130 of the light-emitting element which is one embodiment of the present invention.
- the light-emitting layer 130 includes the compound 131 and the compound 132.
- the compound 131 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission
- the compound 132 has a function of converting singlet excitation energy into light emission. Since the fluorescent material has high stability, it is preferable to use a fluorescent material as the compound 132 in order to obtain a highly reliable light-emitting element.
- the compound 131 since the compound 131 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission, it is preferable that carrier recombination occurs in the compound 131 in order to obtain a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency. Therefore, it is preferable that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy of excitons generated by recombination of carriers in the compound 131 eventually transfer to the singlet excited state of the compound 132 and the compound 132 emits light.
- the compound 131 in the light emitting layer 130, the compound 131 is an energy donor, and the compound 132 is an energy acceptor.
- the light emitting layer 130 is a fluorescent light emitting layer using the compound 131 as a host material and the compound 132 as a guest material. That is, in FIG. 1C, the host material functions as an energy donor and the guest material functions as an energy acceptor.
- the light-emitting layer 130 can obtain light emitted from the compound 132 which is a guest material.
- FIG. 1C illustrates an example of the correlation between energy levels in the light-emitting layer in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- a case where a TADF material is used for the compound 131 is shown.
- FIG. 1C illustrates the correlation between the energy levels of the compound 131 and the compound 132 in the light-emitting layer 130.
- symbol in FIG.1 (C) are as follows.
- the compound 131 has TADF properties. Therefore, the compound 131 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into singlet excitation energy by up-conversion (FIG. 1C, route A 1 ). Singlet excitation energy of the compound 131 can be quickly transferred to the compound 132. (FIG. 1 (C) Route A 2 ). It preferred this time, if it is S C1 ⁇ S G.
- a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the hem of the fluorescence spectrum of compound 131, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and S C1, the energy of the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132 and S G when the, preferably a S C1 ⁇ S G.
- the triplet excitation energy generated in the compound 131 is transferred to the S1 level of the compound 132 which is the guest material through the route A 1 and the route A 2 , and the compound 132 emits light. Can be increased.
- route A 2 compound 131 energy donor, compounds 132 to function as an energy acceptor.
- the compound 131 and the compound 132 are mixed. Therefore, a process in which the triplet excitation energy of the compound 131 is converted into the triplet excitation energy of the compound 132 in competition with the route A 1 and the route A 2 (FIG. 1C, route A 3 ) may occur. Since the compound 132 is a fluorescent material, the triplet excitation energy of the compound 132 does not contribute to light emission. That is, the light-emitting efficiency of the light emitting element energy transfer route A 3 occurs is lowered. In practice, the energy transfer from T C1 to TG (route A 3 ) is not direct, but once transfers to a triplet excited state higher than TG of compound 132, and then becomes TG by internal conversion. There may be a route, but the process is omitted in the figure. The undesired thermal deactivation process in this specification, that is, the deactivation process to TG , is all the same.
- a Forster mechanism dipole-dipole interaction
- a Dexter mechanism electron exchange interaction
- energy transfer route A 3 is a Dexter mechanism is dominant.
- the Dexter mechanism occurs significantly when the distance between the compound 131 as an energy donor and the compound 132 as an energy acceptor is 1 nm or less. Therefore, in order to suppress the route A 3, the distance of the host material and a guest material, i.e. be kept away the distance of the energy donor and energy acceptor is important.
- the energy transfer from the singlet excitation energy level (S C1 ) of the compound 131 to the triplet excitation energy level (T G ) of the compound 132 is changed from the singlet ground state to the triplet excited state in the compound 132. Since direct transition is forbidden, it is not shown because it is difficult to become the main energy transfer process.
- TG in FIG. 1C is an energy level derived from a luminophore in the energy acceptor. Therefore, in order to suppress the route A 3 and more particularly, it is important to distance the distance luminophore with the energy donor and energy acceptor.
- concentration of the energy acceptor in the mixed film of these compounds can be exemplified.
- the concentration of the energy acceptor in the mixed film is lowered, not only the energy transfer based on the Dexter mechanism from the energy donor to the energy acceptor but also the energy transfer based on the Forster mechanism is suppressed. In this case, since the route A 2 is based on the Förster mechanism, problem and decline in reliability of the light-emitting efficiency of the light emitting element is generated.
- the present inventors have found that the decrease in the luminous efficiency can be suppressed by using a fluorescent material having a protective group for increasing the distance from the energy donor as an energy acceptor.
- FIG. 2A shows a case where a fluorescent material which does not have a protective group, which is a general fluorescent material, is dispersed as a guest material in a host material
- FIG. 2B shows a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- distributing the fluorescent material which has a protective group used for to a host material as a guest material is shown.
- the host material may be read as an energy donor, and the guest material as an energy acceptor.
- the protecting group has a function of increasing the distance between the luminophore and the host material.
- the guest material 301 includes a luminophore 310.
- the guest material 301 has a function as an energy acceptor.
- the guest material 302 includes a luminophore 310 and a protective group 320.
- the guest material 301 and the guest material 302 are surrounded by the host material 330.
- energy transfer from the host material 330 to the guest material 301 is performed by the Forster mechanism (route A in FIGS. 2A and 2B). 4 ) and energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism (route A 5 in FIGS. 2A and 2B) can occur.
- the triplet excitation energy When the triplet excitation energy is transferred from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism and the triplet excited state of the guest material is generated, the triplet excitation energy is nonradiatively deactivated when the guest material is a fluorescent material. Therefore, it contributes to a decrease in luminous efficiency.
- the guest material 302 has a protective group 320. Therefore, the distance between the luminophore 310 and the host material 330 can be increased. Thus, energy transfer (route A 5 ) by the Dexter mechanism can be suppressed.
- the guest material 302 in order for the guest material 302 to emit light, since the Dexter mechanism is suppressed, the guest material 302 needs to receive energy from the host material 330 by the Forster mechanism. That is, it is preferable to efficiently use the energy transfer by the Forster mechanism while suppressing the energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism. It is known that the energy transfer by the Forster mechanism is also affected by the distance between the host material and the guest material. In general, when the distance between the host material 330 and the guest material 302 is 1 nm or less, the Dexter mechanism is dominant, and when the distance is 1 nm or more and 10 nm or less, the Forster mechanism is dominant.
- energy transfer hardly occurs when the distance between the host material 330 and the guest material 302 is 10 nm or more.
- the distance between the host material 330 and the guest material 302 may be read as the distance between the host material 330 and the luminophore 310.
- the protecting group 320 extends from the luminophore 310 to a range of 1 nm to 10 nm. More preferably, it is 1 nm or more and 5 nm or less. With this configuration, energy transfer by the Forster mechanism can be efficiently used while suppressing energy transfer from the host material 330 to the guest material 302 by the Dexter mechanism. Therefore, a light-emitting element having high light emission efficiency can be manufactured.
- the energy transfer by the Forster mechanism can be efficiently used while suppressing the energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism, so that the concentration of the guest material that is an energy acceptor can be increased.
- an inherently contradictory phenomenon of increasing the energy transfer speed by the Forster mechanism while suppressing the energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be made possible.
- the excitation lifetime of the energy acceptor in the light emitting layer is shortened, so that the reliability of the light emitting element can be improved.
- the concentration of the guest material is preferably 2 wt% or more and 30 wt% or less, more preferably 5 wt% or more and 20 wt% or less, and further preferably 5 wt% or more and 15 wt% or less with respect to the host material.
- the concentration of the guest material is preferably 2 wt% or more and 30 wt% or less, more preferably 5 wt% or more and 20 wt% or less, and further preferably 5 wt% or more and 15 wt% or less with respect to the host material.
- the above concentration is a concentration in the light emitting layer when a material that mainly emits light is a guest material and a material other than the guest material is a host material.
- the effect of the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention is not limited to the effect of improving reliability by simply using a highly stable fluorescent material.
- the energy transfer as described above always competes with the quenching process due to the influence of deteriorated substances and impurities.
- the quenching rate constant of the quenching process increases with time, the light emitting ratio of the light emitting element decreases. That is, the luminance of the light emitting element is deteriorated.
- the energy transfer rate by the Förster mechanism can be increased as compared with the conventional light-emitting element while suppressing the energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism. Can be reduced and the life of the device can be extended.
- a luminophore refers to an atomic group (skeleton) that causes light emission in a fluorescent material.
- the luminophore generally has a ⁇ bond and preferably contains an aromatic ring, and preferably has a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring.
- the luminophore can be regarded as an atomic group (skeleton) including an aromatic ring having a transition dipole vector on a ring plane.
- a skeleton having the lowest S1 level among the plurality of condensed aromatic rings or condensed heteroaromatic rings is used as the fluorescent material.
- a skeleton having an absorption edge on the longest wavelength side may be considered as a luminophore of the fluorescent material.
- the luminescent group of the fluorescent material can be predicted from the shape of the emission spectrum of each of the plurality of condensed aromatic rings or condensed heteroaromatic rings.
- Examples of the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring include a phenanthrene skeleton, a stilbene skeleton, an acridone skeleton, a phenoxazine skeleton, and a phenothiazine skeleton.
- a fluorescent material having a naphthalene skeleton, anthracene skeleton, fluorene skeleton, chrysene skeleton, triphenylene skeleton, tetracene skeleton, pyrene skeleton, perylene skeleton, coumarin skeleton, quinacridone skeleton, or naphthobisbenzofuran skeleton is preferable because of high fluorescence quantum yield.
- the substituent used as a protecting group needs to have a triplet excitation energy level higher than the T1 level of the luminophore and the host material. Therefore, it is preferable to use a saturated hydrocarbon group. This is because a substituent having no ⁇ bond has a high triplet excitation energy level. A substituent having no ⁇ bond has a low function of transporting carriers (electrons or holes). Therefore, the saturated hydrocarbon group can increase the distance between the luminophore and the host material with little influence on the excited state or carrier transport property of the host material.
- the frontier orbital ⁇ HOMO High Occupied Molecular Orbital, the highest occupied orbital
- LUMO Large Unoccupied Molecular Orbital, also referred to as the lowest orbit
- the luminophore often has a frontier orbit.
- the energy donor and energy acceptor HOMO overlap and the LUMO overlap are important for energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism.
- the distance between the frontier orbit of the host material that is the energy donor and the frontier orbit of the guest material that is the energy acceptor can be increased, and energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be reduced. Can be suppressed.
- the protecting group include alkyl groups having 1 to 10 carbon atoms.
- a bulky substituent is preferable. Therefore, an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms can be suitably used.
- the alkyl group is preferably a bulky branched alkyl group. Further, it is particularly preferable that the substituent has a quaternary carbon because it becomes a bulky substituent.
- FIG. 2B shows a state in which the luminophore and the protecting group are directly bonded, but it is more preferable that the protecting group is not directly bonded to the luminophore.
- the protective group may be bonded to the luminophore via a divalent or higher substituent such as an arylene group or an amino group.
- the protective group is bonded to the luminophore via the substituent, the distance between the luminophore and the host material can be effectively increased. Therefore, when the luminophore and the protecting group are not directly bonded, energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be effectively suppressed by having four or more protecting groups for one luminophore.
- the divalent or higher valent substituent connecting the luminophore and the protecting group is preferably a substituent having a ⁇ -conjugated system. By setting it as this structure, physical properties, such as the luminescent color of a guest material, a HOMO level, and a glass transition point, can be adjusted.
- the protective group is preferably arranged on the outermost side when the molecular structure is viewed centering on the luminophore.
- 1 shows a structure of [diyl] -N, N′-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) amine (abbreviation: 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth).
- 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth the anthracene ring is a luminophore and the tertiary butyl (tBu) group acts as a protecting group.
- FIG. 3B shows a display of the 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth ball model. Note that FIG. 3B illustrates a state when 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth is viewed from the direction of the arrow in FIG. 3A (the horizontal direction with respect to the anthracene ring surface).
- the shaded portion in FIG. 3B represents a portion directly above the anthracene ring surface that is a luminophore, and it can be seen that the region directly above the tBu group that is a protective group overlaps with the portion directly above. For example, in FIG.
- the atom indicated by the arrow (a) is a carbon atom of the tBu group overlapping with the shaded portion
- the atom indicated by the arrow (b) is the atom of the tBu group overlapping with the shaded portion. It is a hydrogen atom. That is, in 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth, an atom constituting a protective group is located immediately above one of the luminophore faces, and an atom constituting the protective group is located immediately above the other face.
- the distance between the anthracene ring and the host material can be increased in both the planar direction and the vertical direction of the anthracene ring that is the luminophore, Energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be suppressed.
- Dexter mechanism for energy transfer by Dexter mechanism, for example, when the transition related to energy transfer is between HOMO and LUMO, the overlap of HOMO of host material and guest material and the overlap of LUMO of host material and guest material are important. is there.
- Dexter mechanism occurs significantly when HOMO and LUMO of both materials overlap. Therefore, in order to suppress the Dexter mechanism, it is important to suppress the overlap of HOMO and LUMO of both materials. That is, it is important to increase the distance between the skeleton related to the excited state and the host material.
- the luminophore often has both HOMO and LUMO.
- the HOMO and LUMO of the guest material extend above and below the surface of the luminophore (in 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth, above and below the anthracene ring), the upper and lower surfaces of the luminophore are covered with protective groups. This is important in the molecular structure.
- a condensed aromatic ring or condensed heteroaromatic ring that functions as a luminophore such as a pyrene ring or an anthracene ring has a transition dipole vector on the ring plane. Therefore, in FIG. 3B, 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth preferably has a region where a protective group tBu group overlaps immediately above the surface where the transition dipole vector exists, that is, immediately above the surface of the anthracene ring. Specifically, at least one of the atoms constituting a plurality of protecting groups (tBu group in FIGS. 3A and 3B) is a condensed aromatic ring or a condensed heteroaromatic ring (FIGS. 3A and 3B).
- a protecting group such as a tBu group is preferably disposed so as to cover a luminophore such as an anthracene ring.
- FIG. 4C illustrates an example of energy level correlation in the light-emitting layer 130 of the light-emitting element 150 of one embodiment of the present invention.
- a light-emitting layer 130 illustrated in FIG. 4A includes the compound 131, the compound 132, and the compound 133.
- the compound 132 is preferably a fluorescent material.
- the compound 131 and the compound 133 are a combination that forms an exciplex.
- the combination of the compound 131 and the compound 133 may be any combination that can form an exciplex, but one is a compound having a function of transporting holes (hole transportability) and the other is an electron.
- a compound having a function of transporting (electron transportability) is more preferable. In this case, it becomes easy to form a donor-acceptor type exciplex and the exciplex can be efficiently formed.
- the combination of the compound 131 and the compound 133 is a combination of a compound having a hole transporting property and a compound having an electron transporting property
- the carrier balance can be easily controlled by having this configuration, the carrier recombination region can be easily controlled.
- one of the compounds 131 and 133 has one HOMO level higher than the other HOMO level, and one LUMO level higher than the other LUMO level. It is preferable. Note that the HOMO level of the compound 131 may be equivalent to the HOMO level of the compound 133, or the LUMO level of the compound 131 may be equivalent to the LUMO level of the compound 133.
- the LUMO level and HOMO level of a compound can be derived from the electrochemical properties (reduction potential and oxidation potential) of the compound measured by cyclic voltammetry (CV) measurement.
- the HOMO level of the compound 131 is higher than the HOMO level of the compound 133 as shown in the energy band diagram in FIG.
- the LUMO level of the compound 131 is preferably higher than the LUMO level of the compound 133.
- Such correlation of energy levels is preferable because holes and electrons, which are carriers injected from the pair of electrodes (electrode 101 and electrode 102), are easily injected into the compound 131 and the compound 133, respectively. is there.
- Comp (131) represents the compound 131
- Comp (133) represents the compound 133
- ⁇ E C1 represents the energy difference between the LUMO level and the HOMO level of the compound 131
- ⁇ E C3 represents the energy difference between the LUMO level and the HOMO level of the compound 132
- Delta] E E represents the energy difference between the LUMO level and the HOMO level of the compound 131 compound 133, a notation and sign.
- the exciplex formed by the compound 131 and the compound 133 is an exciplex having the HOMO molecular orbital in the compound 131 and the LUMO molecular orbital in the compound 133.
- the excitation energy of the exciplex generally corresponds to the energy difference ( ⁇ E E ) between the LUMO level of the compound 133 and the HOMO level of the compound 131, and the energy difference between the LUMO level of the compound 131 and the HOMO level. It becomes smaller than ( ⁇ E C1 ) and the energy difference ( ⁇ E C3 ) between the LUMO level and the HOMO level of the compound 133. Therefore, by forming an exciplex with the compound 131 and the compound 133, an excited state can be formed with lower excitation energy. Moreover, since it has lower excitation energy, the exciplex can form a stable excited state.
- FIG. 4C shows the correlation of energy levels among the compound 131, the compound 132, and the compound 133 in the light-emitting layer 130.
- symbol in FIG.4 (C) are as follows.
- the compound 131 included in the light-emitting layer 130 and the compound 133 form an exciplex.
- the S1 level (S E ) of the exciplex and the T1 level (T E ) of the exciplex are energy levels adjacent to each other (see route A 6 in FIG. 4C).
- the excitation energy level (S E and T E ) of the exciplex is lower than the S1 level (S C1 and S C3 ) of each substance (compound 131 and compound 133) forming the exciplex, the excitation energy level is lower. Thus, an excited state can be formed. As a result, the driving voltage of the light emitting element 150 can be reduced.
- the exciplex Since the S1 level (S E ) and the T1 level (T E ) of the exciplex are energy levels adjacent to each other, they easily cross between the reverse terms and have TADF properties. Therefore, the exciplex has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into singlet excitation energy by up-conversion (FIG. 4C, route A 7 ). Singlet excitation energy of the exciplex can be quickly transferred to the compound 132. (FIG. 4 (C) Route A 8 ). At this time, it is preferable that S E ⁇ S G. In Route A 8, exciplex is energy donor, compounds 132 to function as an energy acceptor.
- a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the hem of the fluorescence spectrum of the exciplex, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and S E, the energy of the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132 and S G In this case, it is preferable that S E ⁇ S G.
- compounds 131 and both T1 level position of compound 133 i.e. T C1 and T C3 is preferably not less than T E.
- the emission peak wavelength on the shortest wavelength side of the phosphorescence spectra of the compound 131 and the compound 133 is not more than the maximum emission peak wavelength of the exciplex.
- a tangent is drawn at the short wavelength side of the hem of the fluorescence spectrum of the exciplex, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and S E, respectively drawing a tangent at the short wavelength side of the hem of the phosphorescence spectrum of Compound 131 and Compound 133
- the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation line is defined as T C1 and T C3 of each compound, it is preferable that S E -T C1 ⁇ 0.2 eV and S E -T C3 ⁇ 0.2 eV .
- the triplet excitation energy generated in the light emitting layer 130 passes through the energy transfer (route A 8 ) from the S1 level of the route A 6 and the exciplex to the S1 level of the exciplex (route A 8 ), so that the guest material emits light. be able to. Therefore, by using a combination of materials that form an exciplex for the light-emitting layer 130, the light emission efficiency of the fluorescent light-emitting element can be increased.
- a guest material having a protective group in the luminophore is used for the compound 132.
- the route A 6 to A 8 described above may be referred to as ExSET (Exciplex-Single Energy Transfer) or ExEF (Exciplex-Enhanced Fluorescence) in this specification and the like.
- ExSET Exciplex-Single Energy Transfer
- ExEF Exciplex-Enhanced Fluorescence
- a compound having a heavy atom is used as one compound forming an exciplex. Therefore, the intersystem crossing between the singlet state and the triplet state is promoted. Therefore, an exciplex capable of transitioning from a triplet excited state to a singlet ground state (that is, capable of exhibiting phosphorescence) can be formed.
- the triplet excitation energy level (T E ) of the exciplex is an energy donor level, and thus T E is a singlet excitation energy level of the compound 132 that is a light-emitting material. It is preferable that it is (S G ) or more.
- a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the skirt of the emission spectrum of the exciplex with heavy atoms, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and T E, the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132
- the energy is S G
- the triplet excitation energy of the generated exciplex is changed from the triplet excitation energy level (T E ) of the exciplex to the singlet excitation energy level (S G ) of the compound 132. ) To transfer energy.
- the S1 level (S E ) and the T1 level (T E ) of the exciplex are energy levels adjacent to each other, it is difficult to clearly distinguish between fluorescence and phosphorescence in the emission spectrum. There is. In that case, it may be possible to distinguish fluorescence or phosphorescence depending on the emission lifetime.
- the phosphorescent material used in the above structure preferably contains heavy atoms such as Ir, Pt, Os, Ru, and Pd.
- the quantum yield may be high or low. That is, the energy transfer from the triplet excitation energy level of the exciplex to the singlet excitation energy level of the guest material may be an allowable transition.
- the energy transfer from an exciplex composed of a phosphorescent material as described above or from the phosphorescent material to the guest material is performed from the triplet excitation energy level of the energy donor to the singlet excitation energy level of the guest material (energy acceptor). This is preferable because energy transfer to is an allowable transition.
- the triplet excitation energy of the exciplex can be transferred to the S1 level (S G ) of the guest material by the process of route A 8 without going through the process of route A 7 in FIG. That is, triplet and singlet excitation energies can be transferred to the S1 level of the guest material only in the process of route A 6 and route A 8 .
- exciplex is energy donor, compounds 132 to function as an energy acceptor.
- a guest material having a protective group in the luminophore is used for the compound 132.
- the compound 133 Since the compound 133 is a TADF material, the compound 133 in which an exciplex is not formed has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into singlet excitation energy by up-conversion (FIG. 4D, route A 10 ). Singlet excitation energy of the compound 133 can be quickly transferred to the compound 132. (FIG. 4 (D) Route A 11 ). It preferred this time, if it is S C3 ⁇ S G.
- the route A 6 to A 8 in FIG. There is a route that moves and a route that moves to the compound 132 via route A 10 and route A 11 in FIG. Since there are a plurality of paths through which triplet excitation energy moves to the fluorescent material, the light emission efficiency can be further increased.
- Route A 8 exciplex is energy donor, compounds 132 to function as an energy acceptor.
- route A 11 compound 133 is an energy donor and compound 132 functions as an energy acceptor.
- the exciplex and the compound 133 are energy donors, and the compound 132 functions as an energy acceptor.
- FIG. 5A illustrates the case where four kinds of materials are used for the light-emitting layer 130.
- the light-emitting layer 130 includes a compound 131, a compound 132, a compound 133, and a compound 134.
- the compound 133 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission.
- the compound 133 is a phosphorescent material is described.
- the compound 132 is a guest material that exhibits fluorescence.
- the compound 131 is an organic compound that forms an exciplex with the compound 134.
- FIG. 5B shows the correlation of energy levels of the compound 131, the compound 132, the compound 133, and the compound 134 in the light-emitting layer 130. Note that the notations and symbols in FIG. 5B are as follows, and the other notations and symbols are the same as those shown in FIG. 4B.
- S C4 S1 level of Compound 134
- T C4 T1 level of Compound 134
- the compound 131 and the compound 134 included in the light-emitting layer 130 form an exciplex.
- the S1 level (S E ) of the exciplex and the T1 level (T E ) of the exciplex are energy levels adjacent to each other (see Route A 12 in FIG. 5B).
- the excitation energy level (S E and T E ) of the exciplex is lower than the S1 level (S C1 and S C4 ) of each substance (compound 131 and compound 134) forming the exciplex, the excitation energy level is lower. Thus, an excited state can be formed. As a result, the driving voltage of the light emitting element 150 can be reduced.
- a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the hem of the phosphorescence spectrum of compound 133, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and T C3, the energy of the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132 and S G when the, preferably a T C3 ⁇ S G.
- compound 133 energy donor, compound 132 serves as an energy acceptor.
- the combination of the compound 131 and the compound 134 may be a combination capable of forming an exciplex, but one is a compound having a hole transporting property and the other is a compound having an electron transporting property. More preferably.
- one of the compound 131 and the compound 134 has one HOMO level higher than the other HOMO level, and one LUMO level higher than the other LUMO level. Is preferred.
- the correlation between the energy levels of the compound 131 and the compound 134 is not limited to FIG. That is, the singlet excitation energy level (S C1 ) of the compound 131 may be higher or lower than the singlet excitation energy level (S C4 ) of the compound 134. In addition, the triplet excitation energy level (T C1 ) of the compound 131 may be higher or lower than the triplet excitation energy level (T C4 ) of the compound 134.
- the compound 131 preferably has a ⁇ -electron deficient skeleton. With this structure, the LUMO level of the compound 131 becomes low, which is suitable for formation of an exciplex.
- the compound 131 preferably has a ⁇ -electron excess skeleton. With this structure, the HOMO level of the compound 131 is increased, which is suitable for formation of an exciplex.
- a guest material having a protective group in the luminophore is used for the compound 132.
- the deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed. Therefore, a fluorescent light emitting element with high luminous efficiency can be obtained.
- the concentration of the compound 133 that is an energy donor can be increased. As a result, an inherently contradictory phenomenon of increasing the energy transfer speed by the Forster mechanism while suppressing the energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be made possible.
- the concentration is preferably 2 wt% or more and 50 wt% or less, more preferably 5 wt% or more and 30 wt% or less, and further preferably 5 wt% or more and 20 wt% or less with respect to the host material. % Or less. With this configuration, the energy transfer rate by the Forster mechanism can be increased, so that a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be obtained.
- this configuration example is a configuration in which a fluorescent material having a protective group is mixed in a light emitting layer that can use ExTET.
- FIG. 5C shows the case where four kinds of materials are used for the light emitting layer 130.
- the light-emitting layer 130 includes the compound 131, the compound 132, the compound 133, and the compound 134.
- the compound 133 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission.
- the compound 132 is a guest material that exhibits fluorescence.
- the compound 131 is an organic compound that forms an exciplex with the compound 134.
- the compound 134 since the compound 134 is a TADF material, the compound 134 that does not form an exciplex has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into singlet excitation energy by up-conversion (FIG. 5C, route A 16 ). The singlet excitation energy of the compound 134 can be quickly transferred to the compound 132. (FIG. 5 (C) Route A 17 ). It preferred this time, if it is S C4 ⁇ S G.
- a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the hem of the fluorescence spectrum of compound 134, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and S C4, the energy of the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132 and S G when the, preferably a S C4 ⁇ S G.
- the route A 12 to A 14 in FIG. There is a route that moves and a route that moves to the compound 132 via route A 16 and route A 17 in FIG. Since there are a plurality of paths through which triplet excitation energy moves to the fluorescent material, the light emission efficiency can be further increased.
- compound 133 energy donor compound 132 serves as an energy acceptor.
- compound 134 functions as an energy donor and compound 132 functions as an energy acceptor.
- FIG. 6B illustrates an example of the energy level correlation in the light-emitting layer 130 of the light-emitting element 150 of one embodiment of the present invention.
- the light-emitting layer 130 illustrated in FIG. 6A includes the compound 131, the compound 132, and the compound 133.
- the compound 132 is a fluorescent material having a protecting group.
- the compound 133 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission. In this structural example, the case where the compound 133 is a phosphorescent material is described.
- singlet excitons and triplet excitons are generated mainly by recombination of carriers in the compound 131 included in the light-emitting layer 130.
- the compound 133 is a phosphorescent material
- both singlet and triplet excitation energies generated in the compound 131 are transferred to the T C3 level of the compound 133 by selecting a material having a relationship of T C3 ⁇ T C1. (FIG. 6B, route A 18 ). Note that some carriers can be recombined with the compound 133.
- the phosphorescent material used in the above structure preferably contains heavy atoms such as Ir, Pt, Os, Ru, and Pd.
- the phosphorescent material acts as an energy donor, so that the quantum yield may be high or low.
- energy transfer from the triplet excitation energy level of the energy donor to the singlet excitation energy level of the guest material (energy acceptor) is an allowable transition, which is preferable. Therefore, the triplet excitation energy of the compound 133 can be transferred to the S1 level (S G ) of the guest material through the process of route A 19 .
- compound 133 functions as an energy donor and compound 132 functions as an energy acceptor.
- it is T C3 ⁇ S G
- the excitation energy of the compound 133 is moved to the singlet excited state of the compound 132 which is effectively a guest material.
- a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the hem of the phosphorescence spectrum of compound 133, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and T C3, the energy of the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132 and S G when the, preferably a T C3 ⁇ S G.
- a guest material having a protective group in the luminophore is used for the compound 132.
- the deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed. Therefore, a fluorescent light emitting element with high luminous efficiency can be obtained.
- FIG. 6C illustrates an example of energy level correlation in the light-emitting layer 130 of the light-emitting element 150 of one embodiment of the present invention.
- a light-emitting layer 130 illustrated in FIG. 6C includes a compound 131, a compound 132, and a compound 133.
- the compound 132 is a fluorescent material having a protecting group.
- the compound 133 has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission. In this structural example, the case where the compound 133 is a compound having TADF properties will be described.
- singlet excitons and triplet excitons are generated mainly by recombination of carriers in the compound 131 included in the light-emitting layer 130.
- both the singlet excitation energy and the triplet excitation energy generated in the compound 131 are transferred to the S C3 and T C3 levels of the compound 133. It can move (FIG. 6 (C) route A 21 ). Note that some carriers can be recombined with the compound 133.
- the compound 134 since the compound 134 is a TADF material, it has a function of converting triplet excitation energy into singlet excitation energy by up-conversion (FIG. 6C, route A 22 ). Further, singlet excitation energy of the compound 133 can be quickly transferred to the compound 132. (FIG. 6 (C) Route A 23 ). It preferred this moment, if it is S C3 ⁇ S G. Specifically, a tangent is drawn to the short wavelength side of the hem of the fluorescence spectrum of compound 133, the energy of the wavelength of the extrapolation and S C3, the energy of the wavelength of the absorption edge of the absorption spectrum of the compound 132 and S G when the, preferably a S C3 ⁇ S G. Through the processes of route A 21 to route A 23, the triplet excitation energy in the light emitting layer 130 can be converted into the fluorescence emission of the compound 132. In Route A 23, compound 133 energy donor, compound 132 serves as an energy acceptor.
- a guest material having a protective group in the luminophore is used for the compound 132.
- the deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed. Therefore, a fluorescent light emitting element with high luminous efficiency can be obtained.
- the energy donor is the first material and the energy acceptor is the second material
- the emission colors of the first material and the second material are close, f ′ h ( Since the overlap of ⁇ ) and ⁇ g ( ⁇ ) becomes small ( ⁇ g ( ⁇ ) exists on the longer wavelength side than the emission spectrum of the second material), kh * ⁇ g becomes small.
- the concentration of energy donors in the light-emitting layer can be increased as described above, the value of R in Formula (1) can be increased, and kh * ⁇ The decrease in g can be suppressed.
- a fluorescent material having an emission color close to an energy donor can be used as the light-emitting material. Note that the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can be used even if the emission colors of the energy donor and the energy acceptor are different.
- Equation (2) h is a Planck constant, K is a constant having an energy dimension, ⁇ represents a frequency, and f ′ h ( ⁇ ) is normalized of the first material.
- Emission spectrum fluorescence spectrum when discussing energy transfer from singlet excited state, phosphorescence spectrum when discussing energy transfer from triplet excited state
- ⁇ ′ g ( ⁇ ) is the second material's
- a normalized absorption spectrum is represented, L represents an effective molecular radius, and R represents an intermolecular distance between the first material and the second material.
- Equation (3) the energy transfer efficiency phi ET from the first material to the second material is represented by Equation (3).
- k r represents the rate constant of the emission process of the first material (fluorescence when discussing energy transfer from a singlet excited state, phosphorescence when discussing energy transfer from a triplet excited state), and k n is It represents the rate constant of the non-luminescent process (thermal deactivation or intersystem crossing) of the second material, and ⁇ represents the measured lifetime of the first material in the excited state.
- the second material has a high molar extinction coefficient. This means that the emission spectrum of the first material and the absorption band appearing on the longest wavelength side of the second material overlap. Since the direct transition from the singlet ground state to the triplet excited state in the second material is forbidden, the molar extinction coefficient related to the triplet excited state in the second material is a negligible amount. Therefore, the energy transfer process from the excited state of the first material to the triplet excited state to the second material by the Forster mechanism can be ignored, and only the energy transfer process to the singlet excited state of the second material. Consider it.
- the energy transfer speed by the Forster mechanism is inversely proportional to the sixth power of the intermolecular distance R between the first material and the second material according to Equation (1).
- the intermolecular distance is preferably 1 nm or more and 10 nm or less. Therefore, since the above-mentioned protecting group is required not to be too bulky, the number of carbon atoms constituting the protecting group is preferably 3 or more and 10 or less.
- the emission spectrum of the first material (the fluorescence spectrum when discussing energy transfer from the singlet excited state, the energy from the triplet excited state) It can be seen that it is better that the overlap between the absorption spectrum of the second material (absorption corresponding to the transition from the singlet ground state to the singlet excited state) is larger when discussing the movement. Therefore, optimization of the energy transfer efficiency is realized by overlapping the emission spectrum of the first material and the absorption band appearing on the longest wavelength side of the second material.
- the energy transfer efficiency phi ET in Dexter mechanism is found to be dependent on tau. Since the Dexter mechanism is an energy transfer process based on electron exchange, the triplet excitation of the first material is similar to the energy transfer from the singlet excited state of the first material to the singlet excited state of the second material. Energy transfer from the state to the triplet excited state of the second material also occurs.
- the second material is a fluorescent material
- the energy transfer efficiency of the second material to the triplet excited state is low. That is, the energy transfer efficiency based on the Dexter mechanism from the first material to the second material is preferably low, and the energy transfer efficiency based on the Forster mechanism from the first material to the second material is preferably high. .
- the energy transfer efficiency in the Forster mechanism does not depend on the lifetime ⁇ of the excited state of the first material.
- the energy transfer efficiency in the Dexter mechanism depends on the excitation lifetime ⁇ of the first material.
- the excitation lifetime ⁇ of the first material is preferably short.
- an exciplex, a phosphorescent material, or a TADF material is used as the first material.
- These materials have a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission. Since the energy transfer efficiency of the Forster mechanism depends on the emission quantum yield of the energy donor, the first material that can convert the triplet excited state into light emission, such as a phosphorescent material, an exciplex, or a TADF material, Excitation energy can be transferred to the second material by the Forster mechanism.
- the reverse intersystem crossing from the triplet excited state to the singlet excited state of the first material is promoted, and triplet excitation of the first material is performed.
- the excitation lifetime ⁇ of the state can be shortened.
- the transition from the triplet excited state to the singlet ground state of the first material a phosphorescent material or an exciplex using the phosphorescent material
- the excitation lifetime ⁇ of the triplet excited state of the first material Can be shortened.
- the energy transfer efficiency in the Dexter mechanism from the triplet excited state of the first material to the triplet excited state of the fluorescent material (second material) can be reduced.
- a fluorescent material having a protective group is used as the second material. Therefore, the intermolecular distance between the first material and the second material can be increased. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, a material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission is used for the first material, and a fluorescent material having a protective group is used for the second material, whereby Dexter is used. Energy transfer efficiency by the mechanism can be reduced. As a result, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitation energy in the light-emitting layer 130 can be suppressed, and a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be provided.
- ⁇ Luminescent layer Each material that can be used for the light-emitting layer 130 is described below.
- an energy acceptor having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission and an energy donor having a luminophore and a protective group are used.
- Examples of the material having a function of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission include TADF materials, exciplexes, and phosphorescent materials.
- Examples of the luminophore possessed by the compound 132 that functions as an energy acceptor include a phenanthrene skeleton, a stilbene skeleton, an acridone skeleton, a phenoxazine skeleton, and a phenothiazine skeleton.
- a fluorescent material having a naphthalene skeleton, anthracene skeleton, fluorene skeleton, chrysene skeleton, triphenylene skeleton, tetracene skeleton, pyrene skeleton, perylene skeleton, coumarin skeleton, quinacridone skeleton, or naphthobisbenzofuran skeleton is preferable because of high fluorescence quantum yield.
- the protecting group is an alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, a cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms. Is preferred.
- alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms examples include a methyl group, an ethyl group, a propyl group, a pentyl group, and a hexyl group, and a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms described below is particularly preferable.
- the alkyl group is not limited to these.
- Examples of the cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms include a cyclopropyl group, a cyclobutyl group, a cyclohexyl group, a norbornyl group, an adamantyl group, and the like.
- the cycloalkyl group is not limited to these.
- the substituent includes a methyl group, an ethyl group, a propyl group, an isopropyl group, a butyl group, an isobutyl group, a sec-butyl group, a tert-butyl group, a pentyl group, and a hexyl group.
- An alkyl group having 1 to 7 carbon atoms such as a cyclopentyl group, a cyclohexyl group, a cycloheptyl group, an 8,9,10-trinorbornanyl group, or a cycloalkyl group having 5 to 7 carbon atoms, ,
- An aryl group having 6 to 12 carbon atoms such as a phenyl group, a naphthyl group, and a biphenyl group.
- Examples of the branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms include isopropyl group, sec-butyl group, isobutyl group, tert-butyl group, isopentyl group, sec-pentyl group, tert-pentyl group, neopentyl group, isohexyl group, 3 -Methylpentyl group, 2-methylpentyl group, 2-ethylbutyl group, 1,2-dimethylbutyl group, 2,3-dimethylbutyl group and the like can be mentioned.
- the branched chain alkyl group is not limited to these.
- trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 12 carbon atoms examples include a trimethylsilyl group, a triethylsilyl group, and a tert-butyldimethylsilyl group.
- the trialkylsilyl group is not limited to these.
- the molecular structure of the energy acceptor is preferably a structure in which a luminophore and two or more diarylamino groups are bonded, and each of the aryl groups of the diarylamino group has at least one protective group. More preferably, at least two protecting groups are attached to each of the aryl groups. This is because the larger the number of protecting groups, the greater the effect of suppressing energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism when the guest material is used for the light emitting layer.
- the diarylamino group is preferably a diphenylamino group in order to suppress an increase in molecular weight and maintain sublimation.
- the luminophore and the diarylamino group preferably have a structure having a bond at the nitrogen atom of the diarylamino group.
- diarylamino groups with the luminophore, a fluorescent material with a high quantum yield can be obtained while adjusting the emission color.
- the diarylamino group is preferably bonded at a symmetrical position with respect to the luminophore. By setting it as this structure, it can be set as the fluorescent material which has a high quantum yield.
- the protective group may be introduced via the aryl group of the diarylamino group, instead of directly introducing the protective group into the luminophore.
- the protective group can be disposed so as to cover the luminophore, and the distance between the host material and the luminophore can be increased from any direction.
- the protective group is not directly bonded to the luminophore, it is preferable to introduce four or more protective groups for one luminophore.
- At least one of the atoms constituting the plurality of protecting groups is located immediately above one surface of the luminophore, that is, the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring, and the plurality of protecting groups
- a structure in which at least one of the atoms constituting is located immediately above the other surface of the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring is preferable.
- Specific examples of the method include the following configurations.
- the condensed aromatic ring or condensed heteroaromatic ring which is a luminophore is bonded to two or more diphenylamino groups, and the phenyl groups in the two or more diphenylamino groups are independently protected at the 3-position and 5-position, respectively.
- the protecting group at the 3rd or 5th position on the phenyl group is directly above the condensed aromatic ring or condensed heteroaromatic ring as the luminophore. It can take a three-dimensional configuration. As a result, the upper and lower surfaces of the condensed aromatic ring or the condensed heteroaromatic ring can be efficiently covered, and energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be suppressed.
- an organic compound represented by the following general formula (G1) or (G2) can be preferably used as the energy acceptor material as described above.
- A represents a substituted or unsubstituted condensed aromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms or a substituted or unsubstituted condensed heteroaromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms
- Ar 1 to Ar 6 independently represents a substituted or unsubstituted aromatic hydrocarbon group having 6 to 13 carbon atoms
- X 1 to X 12 each independently represents a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, substituted or unsubstituted.
- Examples of the aromatic hydrocarbon group having 6 to 13 carbon atoms include a phenyl group, a biphenyl group, a naphthyl group, and a fluorenyl group.
- the aromatic hydrocarbon group is not limited to these.
- the aromatic hydrocarbon group has a substituent, the substituent includes a methyl group, an ethyl group, a propyl group, an isopropyl group, a butyl group, an isobutyl group, a sec-butyl group, a tert-butyl group, and a pentyl group.
- An alkyl group having 1 to 7 carbon atoms such as a hexyl group, or a cycloalkyl group having 5 to 7 carbon atoms such as a cyclopentyl group, a cyclohexyl group, a cycloheptyl group, or an 8,9,10-trinorbornanyl group.
- an aryl group having 6 to 12 carbon atoms such as a phenyl group, a naphthyl group, and a biphenyl group.
- a substituted or unsubstituted condensed aromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms or a substituted or unsubstituted condensed heteroaromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms represents the above-described luminophore and uses the above-described skeleton. be able to.
- X 1 to X 12 each represent a protecting group.
- the protective group is bonded to the quinacridone skeleton that is a luminophore via an aromatic hydrocarbon group.
- a protective group can be disposed so as to cover the luminophore, so that energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be suppressed.
- an organic compound represented by the following general formula (G3) or (G4) can be preferably used.
- A represents a substituted or unsubstituted condensed aromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms or a substituted or unsubstituted condensed heteroaromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms, X 1 to X 12.
- R 1 , R 3 , R 6 and R 8 are each independently hydrogen, an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and 3 to 12 carbon atoms. Represents any one of the trialkylsilyl groups.
- the protecting group is bonded to the luminophore via a phenylene group.
- a protective group can be disposed so as to cover the luminophore, so that energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism can be suppressed.
- the two protective groups are It is preferable that it is bonded at the meta position to the phenylene group.
- the organic compound represented by the general formula (G3) As an example of the organic compound represented by the general formula (G3), the above-described 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth can be given. That is, in one embodiment of the present invention, the general formula ((G3) is a particularly preferable example.
- an organic compound represented by the following general formula (G5) can be preferably used as the energy acceptor material.
- X 1 to X 8 each independently represent a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, a substituted or unsubstituted cycloalkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, or 3 to 10 carbon atoms.
- R 11 to R 18 each independently represents hydrogen, a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, or a substituted or unsubstituted cyclohexane having 3 to 10 carbon atoms. It represents any one of an alkyl group, a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a substituted or unsubstituted aryl group having 6 to 25 carbon atoms.
- Examples of the aryl group having 6 to 25 carbon atoms include a phenyl group, a naphthyl group, a biphenyl group, a fluorenyl group, and a spirofluorenyl group. Note that the aryl group having 6 to 25 carbon atoms is not limited thereto. Note that when the aryl group has a substituent, examples of the substituent include the above-described alkyl group having 1 to 10 carbon atoms, a branched alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms, and a substituted or unsubstituted carbon number of 3 Examples thereof include a cycloalkyl group having 10 or less and a trialkylsilyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms.
- an anthracene compound has a high luminescence quantum yield and a small luminophore area, the upper and lower sides of the anthracene surface can be efficiently covered with a protective group.
- the organic compound represented by the general formula (G5) 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth described above can be given.
- Examples of the compounds represented by general formulas (G1) to (G5) are shown below in structural formulas (102) to (105) and (200) to (284). Note that the compounds listed in the general formulas (G1) to (G5) are not limited to these.
- compounds represented by structural formulas (102) to (105) and (200) to (284) can be favorably used for the guest material of the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention. The guest material is not limited to these.
- Examples of materials that can be preferably used for the guest material of the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention are shown in structural formulas (100) and (101).
- the guest material is not limited to these.
- the compound 133 functions as an energy donor, for example, a TADF material can be used.
- the energy difference between the S1 level and the T1 level of the compound 133 is preferably small. Specifically, the energy difference is greater than 0 eV and equal to or less than 0.2 eV.
- the compound 133 When the compound 133 is a TADF material, the compound 133 preferably has a skeleton having a hole transporting property and a skeleton having an electron transporting property.
- the compound 133 preferably has a ⁇ -electron rich skeleton or an aromatic amine skeleton and a ⁇ -electron deficient skeleton. By doing so, it becomes easy to form a donor-acceptor type excited state in the molecule.
- a structure in which a ⁇ -electron rich skeleton or an aromatic amine skeleton and a ⁇ -electron deficient skeleton are directly bonded By strengthening both the donor property and the acceptor property in the molecule, it is possible to reduce the overlap between the region where the molecular orbital in HOMO of the compound 133 is distributed and the region where the molecular orbital is distributed in LUMO. The energy difference between the singlet excitation energy level and the triplet excitation energy level can be reduced. In addition, the triplet excitation energy level of the compound 133 can be maintained at high energy.
- the TADF material is composed of one kind of material, for example, the following materials can be used.
- metal-containing porphyrins including magnesium (Mg), zinc (Zn), cadmium (Cd), tin (Sn), platinum (Pt), indium (In), palladium (Pd), and the like can be given.
- metal-containing porphyrin include a protoporphyrin-tin fluoride complex (SnF 2 (Proto IX)), a mesoporphyrin-tin fluoride complex (SnF 2 (Meso IX)), and a hematoporphyrin-tin fluoride complex (SnF).
- a heterocyclic compound having one or both of a ⁇ -electron rich skeleton and a ⁇ -electron deficient skeleton can also be used.
- 2- (biphenyl-4-yl) -4,6-bis (12-phenylindolo [2,3-a] carbazol-11-yl) -1,3,5-triazine abbreviation: PIC-TRZ
- 2- ⁇ 4- [3- (N-phenyl-9H-carbazol-3-yl) -9H-carbazol-9-yl] phenyl ⁇ -4,6-diphenyl-1,3,5- Triazine abbreviation: PCCzPTzn
- 2- [4- (10H-phenoxazin-10-yl) phenyl] -4,6-diphenyl-1,3,5-triazine abbreviation: PXZ-TRZ
- the heterocyclic compound has a ⁇ -electron rich heteroaromatic ring and a ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic ring, it is preferable because of its high electron transporting property and hole transporting property.
- a pyridine skeleton, a diazine skeleton (pyrimidine skeleton, pyrazine skeleton, pyridazine skeleton), and a triazine skeleton are preferable because they are stable and have high reliability.
- a benzofuropyrimidine skeleton, a benzothienopyrimidine skeleton, a benzofuropyrazine skeleton, and a benzothienopyrazine skeleton are preferable because they have high acceptor properties and good reliability.
- skeletons having a ⁇ -electron rich heteroaromatic ring an acridine skeleton, a phenoxazine skeleton, a phenothiazine skeleton, a furan skeleton, a thiophene skeleton, and a pyrrole skeleton are stable and reliable. It is preferable to have.
- the furan skeleton is preferably a dibenzofuran skeleton
- the thiophene skeleton is preferably a dibenzothiophene skeleton.
- the pyrrole skeleton is particularly preferably an indole skeleton, a carbazole skeleton, a bicarbazole skeleton, or a 3- (9-phenyl-9H-carbazol-3-yl) -9H-carbazole skeleton.
- a substance in which a ⁇ -electron rich heteroaromatic ring and a ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic ring are directly bonded has both a donor property of a ⁇ -electron rich heteroaromatic ring and an acceptor property of a ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic ring, This is particularly preferable because the difference between the level of the singlet excited state and the level of the triplet excited state becomes small.
- an aromatic ring to which an electron withdrawing group such as a cyano group is bonded may be used.
- An aromatic amine skeleton, a phenazine skeleton, or the like can be used as the ⁇ -electron rich skeleton.
- a ⁇ -electron deficient skeleton a xanthene skeleton, a thioxanthene dioxide skeleton, an oxadiazole skeleton, a triazole skeleton, an imidazole skeleton, an anthraquinone skeleton, a boron-containing skeleton such as phenylborane or borane, a nitrile such as benzonitrile or cyanobenzene
- An aromatic ring or heteroaromatic ring having a group or a cyano group, a carbonyl skeleton such as benzophenone, a phosphine oxide skeleton, a sulfone skeleton, or the like can be used.
- a ⁇ -electron deficient skeleton and a ⁇ -electron rich skeleton can be used instead of at least one of the ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic ring and the ⁇ -electron rich heteroaromatic ring.
- the combination of the compound 131 and the compound 133 or the compound 131 and the compound 134 is preferably a combination that forms an exciplex with each other, but is not particularly limited. . It is preferable that one has a function of transporting electrons and the other has a function of transporting holes. Further, it is preferable that one has a ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic ring and the other has a ⁇ -electron rich heteroaromatic ring.
- Examples of the compound 131 include zinc and aluminum metal complexes, oxadiazole derivatives, triazole derivatives, benzimidazole derivatives, quinoxaline derivatives, dibenzoquinoxaline derivatives, dibenzothiophene derivatives, dibenzofuran derivatives, pyrimidine derivatives, triazine derivatives, pyridine derivatives, bipyridines. Derivatives and phenanthroline derivatives. Other examples include aromatic amines and carbazole derivatives.
- the following hole transport materials and electron transport materials can be used.
- the hole transporting material a material having a hole transporting property higher than that of electrons can be used, and a material having a hole mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or more is preferable.
- aromatic amines, carbazole derivatives, aromatic hydrocarbons, stilbene derivatives, and the like can be used.
- the hole transporting material may be a polymer compound.
- aromatic amine compounds include N, N′-di (p-tolyl) -N, N′-diphenyl-p-phenylenediamine (abbreviation: DTDPPA), 4, 4′-bis [N- (4-diphenylaminophenyl) -N-phenylamino] biphenyl (abbreviation: DPAB), N, N′-bis ⁇ 4- [bis (3-methylphenyl) amino] phenyl ⁇ -N , N′-diphenyl- (1,1′-biphenyl) -4,4′-diamine (abbreviation: DNTPD), 1,3,5-tris [N- (4-diphenylaminophenyl) -N-phenylamino] Benzene (abbreviation: DPA3B) and the like can be given.
- DTDPPA N′-di (p-tolyl) -N, N′-diphenyl-p-phenylenediamine
- PCzDPA1 3- [N- (4-diphenylaminophenyl) -N-phenylamino] -9-phenylcarbazole
- PCzDPA2 3,6-bis [N- ( 4-diphenylaminophenyl) -N-phenylamino] -9-phenylcarbazole
- PCzTPN2 3,6-bis [N- (4-diphenylaminophenyl) -N- (1-naphthyl) amino] -9 -Phenylcarbazole
- PCzTPN2 3- [N- (9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl) -N-phenylamino] -9-phenylcarbazole
- PCzPCA1 3,6-bis [N- ( 9-phenylcarbazol-3-yl) -N-phenylamino] -9-phenylcarbazole
- PCzPCA1 3,6-bis [N- ( 9-phenylc
- CBP 4,4′-di (N-carbazolyl) biphenyl
- TCPB 1,3,5-tris [4- (N-carbazolyl) phenyl] benzene
- CzPA 9- [4- (10-phenyl-9-anthryl) phenyl] -9H-carbazole
- CzPA 1,4-bis [4- (N-carbazolyl) phenyl] -2,3,5, 6-tetraphenylbenzene or the like
- aromatic hydrocarbon examples include 2-tert-butyl-9,10-di (2-naphthyl) anthracene (abbreviation: t-BuDNA), 2-tert-butyl-9,10-di (1- Naphthyl) anthracene, 9,10-bis (3,5-diphenylphenyl) anthracene (abbreviation: DPPA), 2-tert-butyl-9,10-bis (4-phenylphenyl) anthracene (abbreviation: t-BuDBA), 9,10-di (2-naphthyl) anthracene (abbreviation: DNA), 9,10-diphenylanthracene (abbreviation: DPAnth), 2-tert-butylanthracene (abbreviation: t-BuAnth), 9,10-bis (4) -Methyl-1-naphthyl) anthracene (abbreviation: DM
- pentacene, coronene, and the like can also be used.
- an aromatic hydrocarbon having a hole mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or more and having 14 to 42 carbon atoms.
- the aromatic hydrocarbon may have a vinyl skeleton.
- the aromatic hydrocarbon having a vinyl group for example, 4,4′-bis (2,2-diphenylvinyl) biphenyl (abbreviation: DPVBi), 9,10-bis [4- (2,2- Diphenylvinyl) phenyl] anthracene (abbreviation: DPVPA) and the like.
- poly (N-vinylcarbazole) (abbreviation: PVK), poly (4-vinyltriphenylamine) (abbreviation: PVTPA), poly [N- (4- ⁇ N ′-[4- (4-diphenylamino)] Phenyl] phenyl-N′-phenylamino ⁇ phenyl) methacrylamide] (abbreviation: PTPDMA), poly [N, N′-bis (4-butylphenyl) -N, N′-bis (phenyl) benzidine] (abbreviation: Polymer compounds such as Poly-TPD can also be used.
- NPB or ⁇ -NPD 4,4′-bis [N- (1-naphthyl) -N-phenylamino] biphenyl
- NPB or ⁇ -NPD N, N′— Bis (3-methylphenyl) -N, N′-diphenyl- [1,1′-biphenyl] -4,4′-diamine
- TPD 4,4 ′, 4 ′′ -tris (carbazole-9) -Yl) triphenylamine
- TCTA 4,4 ′, 4 ′′ -tris [N- (1-naphthyl) -N-phenylamino] triphenylamine
- 1′-TNATA 4, 4 ′, 4 ′′ -tris (N, N-diphenylamino) triphenylamine
- TDATA 4,4 ′, 4 ′′
- PCPN 3- [4- (1-naphthyl) -phenyl] -9-phenyl-9H-carbazole
- PCPPn 3- [4- (9-phenanthryl) -phenyl] -9-phenyl-9H-carbazole
- PCCP 3,3′-bis (9-phenyl-9H-carbazole)
- mCP 1,3-bis (N-carbazolyl) benzene
- CzTP 3,6-bis ( 3,5-diphenylphenyl) -9-phenylcarbazole
- CzTP 3,6-bis ( 3,5-diphenylphenyl) -9-phenylcarbazole
- the electron transporting material a material having a higher electron transporting property than holes can be used, and a material having an electron mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or more is preferable.
- a material that easily receives electrons a material having an electron transport property
- a ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic compound such as a nitrogen-containing heteroaromatic compound, a metal complex, or the like can be used.
- tris (8-quinolinolato) aluminum (III) (abbreviation: Alq)
- tris (4-methyl-8-quinolinolato) aluminum (abbreviation: Almq 3 )
- bis (10-hydroxybenzo [h] quinolinato) Beryllium (II) (abbreviation: BeBq 2 )
- bis (2-methyl-8-quinolinolato) (4-phenylphenolato) aluminum (III) abbreviation: BAlq
- bis (8-quinolinolato) zinc (II) (abbreviation) : Znq) and the like
- metal complexes having a quinoline skeleton or a benzoquinoline skeleton for example, tris (8-quinolinolato) aluminum (abbreviation: Alq)
- tris (4-methyl-8-quinolinolato) aluminum (abbreviation: Almq 3 )
- bis [2- (2-benzoxazolyl) phenolato] zinc (II) (abbreviation: ZnPBO), bis [2- (2-benzothiazolyl) phenolato] zinc (II) (abbreviation: ZnBTZ), etc.
- ZnPBO bis [2- (2-benzoxazolyl) phenolato] zinc
- ZnBTZ bis [2- (2-benzothiazolyl) phenolato] zinc
- a metal complex having an oxazole-based or thiazole-based ligand can also be used.
- poly (2,5-pyridinediyl) (abbreviation: PPy), poly [(9,9-dihexylfluorene-2,7-diyl) -co- (pyridine-3,5-diyl)] (abbreviation: PF -Py), poly [(9,9-dioctylfluorene-2,7-diyl) -co- (2,2′-bipyridine-6,6′-diyl)] (abbreviation: PF-BPy) Molecular compounds can also be used.
- the substances mentioned here are mainly substances having an electron mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or higher. Note that other than the above substances, any substance that has a property of transporting more electrons than holes may be used.
- the compound 133 or the compound 134 a material capable of forming an exciplex with the compound 131 is preferable. Specifically, the hole transporting material and the electron transporting material described above can be used. In this case, the emission peak of the exciplex formed by the compound 131 and the compound 133 or the compound 131 and the compound 134 overlaps with the absorption band on the longest wavelength side (low energy side) of the compound 132 (fluorescent material). It is preferable to select the compound 131 and the compound 133 or the compound 131 and the compound 134 and the compound 132 (fluorescent material). Thereby, it can be set as the light emitting element which luminous efficiency improved greatly.
- a phosphorescent material can be used as the compound 133.
- the phosphorescent material include iridium, rhodium, or platinum-based organometallic complexes, or metal complexes.
- the platinum complex and organic iridium complex which have a porphyrin ligand are mentioned,
- organic iridium complexes, such as an iridium type ortho metal complex are preferable among these.
- orthometalated ligands include 4H-triazole ligands, 1H-triazole ligands, imidazole ligands, pyridine ligands, pyrimidine ligands, pyrazine ligands, and isoquinoline ligands.
- the compound 133 (phosphorescent material) has an absorption band of a triplet MLCT (Metal to Ligand Charge Transfer) transition.
- MLCT Metal to Ligand Charge Transfer
- the phosphorescent material When forming an exciplex, the phosphorescent material does not need to emit light at room temperature, and it is sufficient if it can emit light at room temperature when the exciplex is formed.
- Ir (ppz) 3 can be used as the phosphorescent material.
- organometallic iridium complexes having a nitrogen-containing five-membered heterocyclic skeleton such as a 4H-triazole skeleton, a 1H-triazole skeleton, and an imidazole skeleton have high triplet excitation energy, and have high reliability and luminous efficiency. It is particularly preferred because of its superiority.
- Examples of a substance having an emission peak in green or yellow include tris (4-methyl-6-phenylpyrimidinato) iridium (III) (abbreviation: Ir (mppm) 3 ), tris (4-t-butyl). -6-phenylpyrimidinato) iridium (III) (abbreviation: Ir (tBupppm) 3 ), (acetylacetonato) bis (6-methyl-4-phenylpyrimidinato) iridium (III) (abbreviation: Ir (mppm) ) 2 (acac)), (acetylacetonato) bis (6-tert-butyl-4-phenylpyrimidinato) iridium (III) (abbreviation: Ir (tBupppm) 2 (acac)), (acetylacetonato) bis [4- (2-norbornyl) -6-phenylpyrimidinato] iridium (III) (abbrevi
- organometallic iridium complexes having a pyrimidine skeleton are particularly preferable because they are remarkably excellent in reliability and luminous efficiency.
- An organometallic iridium complex having a pyrazine skeleton can emit red light with good chromaticity.
- examples of the material that can be used as the energy donor described above include metal halide perovskites.
- the metal halide perovskites can be represented by any one of the following general formulas (g1) to (g3).
- M represents a divalent metal ion
- X represents a halogen ion
- a divalent cation such as lead or tin is used as the divalent metal ion.
- anions such as chlorine, bromine, iodine, and fluorine are used as the halogen ions.
- N represents an integer of 1 to 10, and in the general formula (g2) or the general formula (g3), when n is larger than 10, the property is a metal halogen represented by the general formula (g1). It is close to the chemical perovskites.
- LA represents an ammonium ion represented by R 30 —NH 3 + .
- R 30 is any one of an alkyl group having 2 to 20 carbon atoms, an aryl group and a heteroaryl group, or an alkyl group having 2 to 20 carbon atoms and an aryl group. Or a group consisting of a combination of a heteroaryl group, an alkylene group having 1 to 12 carbon atoms, a vinylene group, an arylene group having 6 to 13 carbon atoms and a heteroarylene group. In the latter case, an alkylene group, an arylene group and a heteroarylene group A plurality of groups may be connected, and a plurality of groups of the same type may be used.
- the total number of alkylene groups, vinylene groups, arylene groups, and heteroarylene groups is 35 or less.
- SA represents a monovalent metal ion or R 31 —NH 3 +
- R 31 represents an ammonium ion having an alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms.
- PA represents NH 3 + —R 32 —NH 3 + or NH 3 + —R 33 —R 34 —R 35 —NH 3 + , or a part or all of a branched polyethyleneimine having an ammonium cation, The valence of the part is +2.
- the charges in the general formula are almost balanced.
- the charges of the metal halide perovskites are not strictly balanced in all parts of the material according to the above formula, and it is sufficient that the neutrality of the whole material is generally maintained. There may be cases where other ions such as free ammonium ions, free halogen ions, and impurity ions are present locally in the material, and these may neutralize the charge. Further, there are cases where neutrality is not maintained locally even at the surface of particles or films, grain boundaries of crystals, etc., and neutrality is not necessarily maintained at all locations.
- (LA) in the above formula (g2) includes, for example, substances represented by the following general formulas (a-1) to (a-11) and general formulas (b-1) to (b-6). Can be used.
- (PA) in the general formula (g3) is typically a substance having any one of the following general formulas (c-1), (c-2), and (d) and a branch having an ammonium cation. It represents a part or all of polyethyleneimine and has a +2 valence charge. These polymers may neutralize the charge over a plurality of unit cells, and may also neutralize the charge of one unit cell by one charge of two different polymer molecules.
- R 20 represents an alkyl group having 2 to 18 carbon atoms
- R 21 , R 22 and R 23 represent hydrogen or an alkyl group having 1 to 18 carbon atoms
- R 24 represents the following structural formula and general formula formula (R 24 -1) to represent the (R 24 -14).
- R 25 and R 26 each independently represent hydrogen or an alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms.
- X has a combination of monomer units A and B represented by any one of the above (d-1) to (d-6), and a structure in which u is included in A and v is included in B Represents. The order of arrangement of A and B is not limited.
- M and l are each independently an integer of 0 to 12, and t is an integer of 1 to 18.
- U is an integer from 0 to 17, v is an integer from 1 to 18, and u + v is an integer from 1 to 18.
- metal halide perovskites having the composition of (SA) MX 3 represented by the general formula (g1), a regular octahedral structure in which a metal atom M is arranged at the center and halogen atoms are arranged at six vertices is provided. A skeleton is formed by sharing halogen atoms at each apex in a three-dimensional arrangement.
- This octahedral structure unit having a halogen atom at each vertex is called a perovskite unit.
- a zero-dimensional structure in which this perovskite unit exists in isolation a linear structure connected one-dimensionally via a halogen atom at the apex, a two-dimensionally connected sheet-like structure, a three-dimensionally connected structure
- a complex two-dimensional structure formed by stacking a plurality of sheet-like structures in which perovskite units are two-dimensionally connected.
- perovskite units are two-dimensionally connected.
- metal halide perovskites As a general term for all structures having these perovskite units, they are defined and used as metal halide perovskites.
- the light emitting layer 130 can also be comprised with two or more layers.
- a substance having a hole-transport property is used as the host material of the first light-emitting layer
- a substance having an electron transporting property is used as a host material of the second light emitting layer.
- the light emitting layer 130 may include a material (compound 135) other than the compound 131, the compound 132, the compound 133, and the compound 134.
- a material compound 135 other than the compound 131, the compound 132, the compound 133, and the compound 134.
- one of the HOMO levels of the compound 131 and the compound 133 (or the compound 134) is preferable, and the other LUMO level preferably has the lowest LUMO level among the materials in the light-emitting layer 130.
- the HOMO level of the compound 131 is higher than the HOMO level of the compound 133 and the HOMO level of the compound 135. It is preferable that the LUMO level of the compound 133 is lower than the LUMO level of the compound 131 and the LUMO level of the compound 135. In this case, the LUMO level of the compound 135 may be higher or lower than the LUMO level of the compound 131. Further, the HOMO level of the compound 135 may be higher or lower than the HOMO level of the compound 133.
- the material (compound 135) that can be used for the light-emitting layer 130 is not particularly limited, and examples thereof include tris (8-quinolinolato) aluminum (III) (abbreviation: Alq) and tris (4-methyl-8-quinolinolato).
- Aluminum (III) (abbreviation: Almq 3 ), bis (10-hydroxybenzo [h] quinolinato) beryllium (II) (abbreviation: BeBq 2 ), bis (2-methyl-8-quinolinolato) (4-phenylphenolato) ) Aluminum (III) (abbreviation: BAlq), bis (8-quinolinolato) zinc (II) (abbreviation: Znq), bis [2- (2-benzoxazolyl) phenolato] zinc (II) (abbreviation: ZnPBO) , Metal complexes such as bis [2- (2-benzothiazolyl) phenolato] zinc (II) (abbreviation: ZnBTZ), 2- (4 -Biphenylyl) -5- (4-tert-butylphenyl) -1,3,4-oxadiazole (abbreviation: PBD), 1,3-bis [5- (p-tert-butylphenyl)
- condensed polycyclic aromatic compounds such as anthracene derivatives, phenanthrene derivatives, pyrene derivatives, chrysene derivatives, and dibenzo [g, p] chrysene derivatives can be given.
- the electrode 101 and the electrode 102 have a function of injecting holes and electrons into the light-emitting layer 130.
- the electrode 101 and the electrode 102 can be formed using a metal, an alloy, a conductive compound, a mixture or a stacked body thereof.
- Typical examples of the metal include aluminum (Al), transition metals such as silver (Ag), tungsten, chromium, molybdenum, copper, and titanium, alkali metals such as lithium (Li) and cesium, calcium, magnesium (Mg Group 2 metals such as) can be used.
- a rare earth metal such as ytterbium (Yb) may be used as the transition metal.
- an alloy containing the above metal can be used, and examples thereof include MgAg and AlLi.
- the conductive compound include indium tin oxide (Indium Tin Oxide, hereinafter referred to as ITO), indium tin oxide containing silicon or silicon oxide (abbreviation: ITSO), indium zinc oxide (Indium Zinc Oxide), tungsten, and zinc. And metal oxides such as indium oxide containing bismuth.
- ITO Indium Tin Oxide
- ITSO indium tin oxide containing silicon or silicon oxide
- ITSO indium zinc oxide
- tungsten tungsten
- metal oxides such as indium oxide containing bismuth.
- An inorganic carbon-based material such as graphene may be used as the conductive compound.
- one or both of the electrode 101 and the electrode 102 may be formed by stacking a plurality of these materials.
- the conductive material having a function of transmitting light has a visible light transmittance of 40% to 100%, preferably 60% to 100%, and a resistivity of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 2 ⁇ ⁇ cm.
- the electrode from which light is extracted may be formed of a conductive material having a function of transmitting light and a function of reflecting light.
- the conductive material examples include a conductive material having a visible light reflectance of 20% to 80%, preferably 40% to 70%, and a resistivity of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 2 ⁇ ⁇ cm or less. Can be mentioned.
- the electrode 101 and the electrode 102 have a thickness that can transmit visible light (for example, a thickness of 1 nm to 10 nm). One or both may be formed.
- an electrode having a function of transmitting light may be formed using a material having a function of transmitting visible light and having conductivity, and is represented by, for example, ITO as described above.
- an oxide semiconductor layer or an organic conductor layer containing an organic substance is included.
- the organic conductor layer containing an organic material include a layer containing a composite material obtained by mixing an organic compound and an electron donor (donor), and a composite material obtained by mixing an organic compound and an electron acceptor (acceptor). And the like.
- the resistivity of the transparent conductive layer is preferably 1 ⁇ 10 5 ⁇ ⁇ cm or less, and more preferably 1 ⁇ 10 4 ⁇ ⁇ cm or less.
- the electrode 101 and the electrode 102 may be formed by sputtering, vapor deposition, printing, coating, MBE (Molecular Beam Epitaxy), CVD, pulsed laser deposition, ALD (Atomic Layer Deposition), or the like. It can be used as appropriate.
- the hole injection layer 111 has a function of promoting hole injection by reducing a hole injection barrier from one of the pair of electrodes (the electrode 101 or the electrode 102).
- a transition metal oxide, a phthalocyanine derivative, or an aromatic Formed by a group amine examples include molybdenum oxide, vanadium oxide, ruthenium oxide, tungsten oxide, and manganese oxide.
- the phthalocyanine derivative examples include phthalocyanine and metal phthalocyanine.
- aromatic amines include benzidine derivatives and phenylenediamine derivatives.
- High molecular compounds such as polythiophene and polyaniline can also be used.
- self-doped polythiophene poly (ethylenedioxythiophene) / poly (styrenesulfonic acid) is a typical example.
- a layer including a composite material of a hole-transporting material and a material that exhibits an electron-accepting property can be used.
- a stack of a layer containing a material showing an electron accepting property and a layer containing a hole transporting material may be used. Charges can be transferred between these materials in a steady state or in the presence of an electric field.
- the material exhibiting electron acceptability include organic acceptors such as quinodimethane derivatives, chloranil derivatives, and hexaazatriphenylene derivatives.
- a compound in which an electron withdrawing group is bonded to a condensed aromatic ring having a plurality of heteroatoms such as HAT-CN is preferable because it is thermally stable.
- Radialene derivatives having an electron-withdrawing group are preferable because of their very high electron-accepting properties.
- ⁇ , ⁇ ′, ⁇ ′′ 1,2,3-cyclopropanetriylidenetris [4-cyano-2,3,5,6-tetrafluorobenzeneacetonitrile], ⁇ , ⁇ ′, ⁇ ′′ -1,2,3-cyclopropanetriylidenetris [2,6-dichloro-3,5-difluoro-4- (trifluoromethyl) benzeneacetonitrile], ⁇ , ⁇ ′, ⁇ ′′ -1,2,3-cyclopropanetriylidentris [2,3,4 , 5,6-pentafluorobenzeneacetonitrile] and the like.
- Transition metal oxides such as Group 4 to Group 8 metal oxides can also be used. Specifically, vanadium oxide, niobium oxide, tantalum oxide, chromium oxide, molybdenum oxide, tungsten oxide, manganese oxide, rhenium oxide, and the like. Among these, molybdenum oxide is preferable because it is stable in the air, has a low hygroscopic property, and is easy to handle.
- the hole transporting material a material having a hole transporting property higher than that of electrons can be used, and a material having a hole mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or more is preferable.
- the aromatic amines and carbazole derivatives mentioned as the hole transporting material that can be used for the light-emitting layer 130 can be used.
- aromatic hydrocarbons and stilbene derivatives can be used.
- the hole transporting material may be a polymer compound.
- aromatic hydrocarbon examples include 2-tert-butyl-9,10-di (2-naphthyl) anthracene (abbreviation: t-BuDNA), 2-tert-butyl-9,10-di (1-naphthyl).
- pentacene, coronene, and the like can also be used.
- an aromatic hydrocarbon having a hole mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or higher and having 14 to 42 carbon atoms.
- the aromatic hydrocarbon may have a vinyl skeleton.
- the aromatic hydrocarbon having a vinyl group for example, 4,4′-bis (2,2-diphenylvinyl) biphenyl (abbreviation: DPVBi), 9,10-bis [4- (2,2- Diphenylvinyl) phenyl] anthracene (abbreviation: DPVPA) and the like.
- poly (N-vinylcarbazole) (abbreviation: PVK), poly (4-vinyltriphenylamine) (abbreviation: PVTPA), poly [N- (4- ⁇ N ′-[4- (4-diphenylamino)] Phenyl] phenyl-N′-phenylamino ⁇ phenyl) methacrylamide] (abbreviation: PTPDMA), poly [N, N′-bis (4-butylphenyl) -N, N′-bis (phenyl) benzidine] (abbreviation: Polymer compounds such as Poly-TPD can also be used.
- the hole transport layer 112 is a layer including a hole transport material, and the materials exemplified as the material of the hole injection layer 111 can be used. Since the hole transport layer 112 has a function of transporting holes injected into the hole injection layer 111 to the light emitting layer 130, the hole transport layer 112 may have a HOMO level that is the same as or close to the HOMO level of the hole injection layer 111. preferable.
- the materials exemplified as the material of the hole injection layer 111 can be used.
- a substance having a hole mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or higher is preferable.
- any substance other than these may be used as long as it has a property of transporting more holes than electrons.
- the layer containing a substance having a high hole-transport property is not limited to a single layer, and two or more layers containing the above substances may be stacked.
- the electron transport layer 118 has a function of transporting electrons injected from the other of the pair of electrodes (the electrode 101 or the electrode 102) through the electron injection layer 119 to the light emitting layer 130.
- the electron transporting material a material having a higher electron transporting property than holes can be used, and a material having an electron mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or more is preferable.
- a compound that easily receives electrons (a material having an electron transporting property)
- a ⁇ -electron deficient heteroaromatic such as a nitrogen-containing heteroaromatic compound, a metal complex, or the like can be used.
- a metal complex having a quinoline ligand, a benzoquinoline ligand, an oxazole ligand, or a thiazole ligand which can be used for the light-emitting layer 130 can be given.
- oxadiazole derivatives, triazole derivatives, phenanthroline derivatives, pyridine derivatives, bipyridine derivatives, pyrimidine derivatives, and the like can be given.
- a substance having an electron mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or higher is preferable. Note that other than the above substances, any substance that has a property of transporting more electrons than holes may be used for the electron-transport layer.
- the electron-transporting layer 118 is not limited to a single layer, and two or more layers including the above substances may be stacked.
- a layer for controlling the movement of electron carriers may be provided between the electron transport layer 118 and the light emitting layer 130.
- the layer that controls the movement of electron carriers is a layer in which a small amount of a substance having a high electron trapping property is added to the material having a high electron transport property as described above, and the carrier balance is adjusted by suppressing the movement of electron carriers. It becomes possible to do. Such a configuration is very effective in suppressing problems that occur when electrons penetrate through the light emitting layer (for example, a reduction in device lifetime).
- the electron injection layer 119 has a function of promoting electron injection by reducing an electron injection barrier from the electrode 102.
- a Group 1 metal, a Group 2 metal, or an oxide, halide, carbonate, or the like thereof is used. Can be used.
- a composite material of the electron transporting material described above and a material exhibiting an electron donating property can be used. Examples of the material exhibiting electron donating properties include Group 1 metals, Group 2 metals, and oxides thereof.
- alkali metals such as lithium fluoride (LiF), sodium fluoride (NaF), cesium fluoride (CsF), calcium fluoride (CaF 2 ), lithium oxide (LiO x ), etc., alkaline earth Similar metals, or compounds thereof can be used.
- a rare earth metal compound such as erbium fluoride (ErF 3 ) can be used.
- electride may be used for the electron injection layer 119. Examples of the electride include a substance obtained by adding a high concentration of electrons to a mixed oxide of calcium and aluminum.
- a substance that can be used for the electron-transport layer 118 may be used for the electron-injection layer 119.
- a composite material obtained by mixing an organic compound and an electron donor (donor) may be used for the electron injection layer 119.
- Such a composite material is excellent in electron injecting property and electron transporting property because electrons are generated in the organic compound by the electron donor.
- the organic compound is preferably a material excellent in transporting the generated electrons.
- a substance (metal complex, heteroaromatic compound, or the like) constituting the electron transport layer 118 described above is used.
- the electron donor may be any substance that exhibits an electron donating property to the organic compound.
- alkali metals, alkaline earth metals, and rare earth metals are preferable, and lithium, cesium, magnesium, calcium, erbium, ytterbium, and the like can be given.
- Alkali metal oxides and alkaline earth metal oxides are preferable, and lithium oxide, calcium oxide, barium oxide, and the like can be given.
- a Lewis base such as magnesium oxide can also be used.
- an organic compound such as tetrathiafulvalene (abbreviation: TTF) can be used.
- the light emitting layer, the hole injection layer, the hole transport layer, the electron transport layer, and the electron injection layer described above are, respectively, an evaporation method (including a vacuum evaporation method), an inkjet method, a coating method, a nozzle printing method, It can be formed by a method such as gravure printing.
- the light emitting layer, the hole injection layer, the hole transport layer, the electron transport layer, and the electron injection layer described above include, in addition to the materials described above, inorganic compounds or polymer compounds such as quantum dots (oligomers, dendrimers, A polymer or the like) may be used.
- quantum dots colloidal quantum dots, alloy type quantum dots, core / shell type quantum dots, core type quantum dots, or the like may be used.
- cadmium (Cd) selenium (Se), zinc (Zn), sulfur (S), phosphorus (P), indium (In), tellurium (Te), lead (Pb), gallium (Ga), arsenic (As ), Quantum dots having elements such as aluminum (Al), and the like may be used.
- liquid medium used in the wet process examples include ketones such as methyl ethyl ketone and cyclohexanone, fatty acid esters such as ethyl acetate, halogenated hydrocarbons such as dichlorobenzene, and aromatic carbonization such as toluene, xylene, mesitylene, and cyclohexyl benzene. Hydrogen, aliphatic hydrocarbons such as cyclohexane, decalin, and dodecane, and organic solvents such as dimethylformamide (DMF) and dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO) can be used.
- ketones such as methyl ethyl ketone and cyclohexanone
- fatty acid esters such as ethyl acetate
- halogenated hydrocarbons such as dichlorobenzene
- aromatic carbonization such as toluene, xylene, mesitylene, and cyclohexyl benzene.
- poly [2-methoxy-5- (2-ethylhexyloxy) -1,4-phenylenevinylene] (abbreviation: MEH-PPV)
- poly (2 , 5-dioctyl-1,4-phenylenevinylene) polyphenylenevinylene (PPV) derivatives
- poly (9,9-di-n-octylfluorenyl-2,7-diyl) abbreviation: PF8
- poly [ (9,9-di-n-octylfluorenyl-2,7-diyl) -alt- (benzo [2,1,3] thiadiazole-4,8-diyl)] (abbreviation: F8BT)
- a light emitting compound may be doped and used in the light emitting layer.
- the light-emitting compound the light-emitting compounds listed above can be used.
- the light-emitting element according to one embodiment of the present invention may be manufactured over a substrate formed of glass, plastic, or the like. As the order of manufacturing on the substrate, the layers may be sequentially stacked from the electrode 101 side or may be sequentially stacked from the electrode 102 side.
- the substrate over which the light-emitting element according to one embodiment of the present invention can be formed glass, quartz, plastic, or the like can be used, for example.
- a flexible substrate may be used.
- the flexible substrate is a substrate that can be bent (flexible), and examples thereof include a plastic substrate made of polycarbonate or polyarylate.
- a film, an inorganic vapor deposition film, etc. can also be used.
- other materials may be used as long as they function as a support in the manufacturing process of the light-emitting element and the optical element. Or what is necessary is just to have a function which protects a light emitting element and an optical element.
- a light-emitting element can be formed using various substrates.
- substrate is not specifically limited.
- the substrate include a semiconductor substrate (for example, a single crystal substrate or a silicon substrate), an SOI substrate, a glass substrate, a quartz substrate, a plastic substrate, a metal substrate, a stainless steel substrate, a substrate having stainless steel foil, and a tungsten substrate.
- the glass substrate include barium borosilicate glass, aluminoborosilicate glass, and soda lime glass.
- Examples of a flexible substrate, a laminated film, a base film and the like include the following.
- plastics represented by polyethylene terephthalate (PET), polyethylene naphthalate (PEN), polyethersulfone (PES), and polytetrafluoroethylene (PTFE).
- PET polyethylene terephthalate
- PEN polyethylene naphthalate
- PES polyethersulfone
- PTFE polytetrafluoroethylene
- Another example is a resin such as acrylic.
- examples include polypropylene, polyester, polyvinyl fluoride, and polyvinyl chloride.
- polyamide, polyimide, aramid, epoxy, an inorganic vapor deposition film, papers, and the like are examples of the like.
- a flexible substrate may be used as the substrate, and the light emitting element may be formed directly on the flexible substrate.
- a separation layer may be provided between the substrate and the light-emitting element.
- the release layer can be used to separate a part from the substrate after the light emitting element is partially or wholly formed thereon, and to transfer the light emitting element to another substrate. At that time, the light-emitting element can be transferred to a substrate having poor heat resistance or a flexible substrate.
- a structure of a laminated structure of an inorganic film of a tungsten film and a silicon oxide film or a structure in which a resin film such as polyimide is formed over a substrate can be used for the above-described release layer.
- a light emitting element may be formed using a certain substrate, and then the light emitting element may be transferred to another substrate, and the light emitting element may be disposed on another substrate.
- a substrate to which the light emitting element is transferred in addition to the above-described substrate, a cellophane substrate, a stone substrate, a wood substrate, a cloth substrate (natural fiber (silk, cotton, hemp), synthetic fiber (nylon, polyurethane, polyester) or There are recycled fibers (including acetate, cupra, rayon, recycled polyester), leather substrates, rubber substrates, and the like.
- a light-emitting element that is not easily broken, a light-emitting element with high heat resistance, a light-emitting element that is reduced in weight, or a light-emitting element that is thinned can be obtained.
- a field effect transistor may be formed on the above-described substrate, and the light-emitting element 150 may be formed on an electrode electrically connected to the FET. Accordingly, an active matrix display device in which driving of the light emitting element is controlled by the FET can be manufactured.
- the organic compound represented by the general formula (G1) can be synthesized by a synthesis method to which various reactions are applied. For example, it can be synthesized by the synthesis schemes (S-1) and (S-2) shown below.
- a diamine compound (compound 4) is obtained by coupling compound 1, arylamine (compound 2) and arylamine (compound 3).
- the organic compound represented by the general formula (G1) is obtained by coupling the diamine compound (compound 4), the aryl halide (compound 5), and the aryl halide (compound 6). Can do.
- A represents a substituted or unsubstituted condensed aromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms or a substituted or unsubstituted condensed heteroaromatic ring having 10 to 30 carbon atoms.
- Ar 1 to Ar 4 each independently represents a substituted or unsubstituted aromatic hydrocarbon group having 6 to 13 carbon atoms
- X 1 to X 8 each independently represents an alkyl group having 3 to 10 carbon atoms.
- condensed aromatic ring or condensed heteroaromatic ring examples include chrysene, phenanthrene, stilbene, acridone, phenoxazine, and phenothiazine. Particularly preferred are anthracene, pyrene, coumarin, quinacridone, perylene, tetracene, and naphthobisbenzofuran.
- X 10 to X 13 represent a halogen group or a triflate group, Iodine or bromine or chlorine is preferred.
- palladium compounds such as bis (dibenzylideneacetone) palladium (0) and palladium (II) acetate, tri (tert-butyl) phosphine, tri (n-hexyl) phosphine, tricyclohexylphosphine, di (1- A ligand such as adamantyl) -n-butylphosphine and 2-dicyclohexylphosphino-2 ′, 6′-dimethoxy-1,1′-biphenyl can be used.
- an organic base such as sodium tert-butoxide
- an inorganic base such as potassium carbonate, cesium carbonate, or sodium carbonate can be used.
- toluene, xylene, mesitylene, benzene, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, etc. can be used as a solvent.
- reagents that can be used in the reaction are not limited to these reagents.
- reaction performed in the above synthesis schemes (S-1) and (S-2) is not limited to the Buchwald-Hartwig reaction, but the Ueda-Kosugi-Still coupling reaction using an organic tin compound, the Grignard reagent A coupling reaction using copper, an Ullmann reaction using copper, or a copper compound can be used.
- the first method is composed of the following synthesis schemes (S-3) to (S-8).
- an amine compound (Compound 9) is obtained by a condensation reaction of an aniline compound (Compound 7) and a 1,4-cyclohexadiene-1,4-dicarboxylic acid compound (Compound 8).
- This step is shown in Scheme (S-3).
- two aniline compounds having the same substituent (compound 7) are condensed in one step and an amino group having the same substituent is introduced, two equivalents of the aniline compound (compound 7) are added. It is preferable to carry out the reaction. In that case, the target product can be obtained even if the carbonyl group of compound 8 has no reaction selectivity.
- a 1,4-cyclohexadiene compound (Compound 11) can be obtained by subjecting an amine compound (Compound 9) and an aniline derivative (Compound 10) to a condensation reaction.
- the step of obtaining compound 11 is shown in scheme (S-4).
- a quinacridone compound (compound 13) can be obtained by condensing the terephthalic acid compound (compound 12) with an acid.
- the step of obtaining compound 13 is shown in scheme (S-6).
- a quinacridone compound (Compound 15) can be obtained by coupling a quinacridone compound (Compound 13) and an aryl halide (Compound 14).
- the step of obtaining compound 15 is shown in scheme (S-7).
- two aryl halides having the same substituent (compound 8) can be coupled in one step, and when introducing an amino group having the same substituent, two equivalents of the aryl halide (compound It is preferable to carry out the same reaction by adding 14). In this case, the target product can be obtained even if the amino group of compound 14 has no reaction selectivity.
- the organic compound represented by the general formula (G2) can be obtained by coupling the quinacridone compound (Compound 15) and the aryl halide (Compound 16). This step is shown in Scheme (S-8).
- the second method is composed of synthesis schemes (S-3) to (S-5) and the following (S-9), (S-10), and (S-11).
- the description of (S-3) to (S-5) is as described above.
- a diamine compound (Compound 17) can be obtained by coupling a terephthalic acid compound (Compound 12) and an aryl halide (Compound 14).
- the step of obtaining compound 17 is shown in scheme (S-9).
- two halogenated aryl molecules having the same substituent can be coupled in one step.
- 2 equivalents of the aryl halide (compound 14) are added. It is preferable to carry out the same reaction. In that case, the desired product can be obtained even if the amino group of compound 12 has no reaction selectivity.
- a diamine compound (compound 18) can be obtained by coupling a diamine compound (compound 17) and an aryl halide (compound 16).
- the step of obtaining compound 18 is shown in scheme (S-10).
- Al 1 represents an alkyl group such as a methyl group.
- Y 1 and Y 2 represent a chlorine, bromine, iodine, or triflate group.
- the Ullmann reaction is preferably performed because the reaction can proceed at a high temperature and the target compound can be obtained in a relatively high yield.
- the reagent that can be used in the reaction include copper or a copper compound
- the base include inorganic bases such as potassium carbonate and sodium hydride.
- usable solvents are 2,2,6,6-tetramethyl-3,5-heptanedione, 1,3-dimethyl-3,4,5,6-tetrahydro-2 (1H) pyrimidinone. (DMPU), toluene, xylene, benzene and the like.
- the target product can be obtained in a shorter time and with a higher yield when the reaction temperature is 100 ° C. or higher. Therefore, 2,2,6,6-tetramethyl-3,5-heptanedione having a high boiling point, DMPU Xylene is preferably used. Moreover, since the reaction temperature is more preferably higher than 150 ° C., DMPU is more preferably used. Reagents that can be used in the reaction are not limited to the above reagents.
- an organic base such as sodium tert-butoxide, an inorganic base such as potassium carbonate, cesium carbonate, or sodium carbonate can be used.
- an inorganic base such as potassium carbonate, cesium carbonate, or sodium carbonate
- toluene, xylene, benzene, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, or the like can be used as a solvent.
- Reagents that can be used in the reaction are not limited to the above reagents.
- the method for synthesizing the organic compound represented by the general formula (G2) of the present invention is not limited to the synthesis schemes (S-1) to (S-11).
- R 1 to R 10 substituted on the quinacridone skeleton include n-propyl group, isopropyl group, n-butyl group, isobutyl group, tert-butyl group, cyclopropyl group, cyclobutyl group, cyclopentyl group, cyclohexyl Group, trimethylsilyl group, triethylsilyl group, tributylsilyl group and the like.
- Ar 5 substituted with X 9 and X 10 and Ar 6 substituted with X 11 and X 12 include 2-isopropylphenyl group, 2-butylphenyl group, 2-isobutylphenyl group, 2-tert- Butylphenyl group, 2-isopropylphenyl group, 2-butylphenyl group, 3-propylphenyl group, 3-isobutylphenyl group, 3-tert-butylphenyl group, 4-propylphenyl group, 4-isopropylphenyl group, 4- Butylphenyl group, 4-isobutylphenyl group, 4-tert-butylphenyl group, 3,5-dipropylphenyl group, 3,5-di-isopropylphenyl group, 3,5-dibutylphenyl group, 3,5-di -Isobutylphenyl group, (3,5-di-tert-butyl) phenyl group, 1,3-iso
- Embodiment 3 a light-emitting element having a structure different from that of the light-emitting element described in Embodiment 1 will be described below with reference to FIGS. Note that in FIG. 7, portions having the same functions as those illustrated in FIG. 1A have similar hatch patterns, and the symbols may be omitted. Moreover, the same code
- FIG. 7 is a schematic cross-sectional view of the light emitting element 250.
- the light-emitting element 150 illustrated in FIG. 1A preferably includes one light-emitting unit
- the light-emitting element 250 preferably includes a plurality of light-emitting units. Note that in the light-emitting element 250, the electrode 101 functions as an anode and the electrode 102 functions as a cathode, but the structure of the light-emitting element 250 may be reversed.
- the light emitting unit 106 and the light emitting unit 108 are stacked, and a charge generation layer 115 is provided between the light emitting unit 106 and the light emitting unit 108.
- the light emitting unit 106 and the light emitting unit 108 may have the same configuration or different configurations.
- a structure similar to that of the EL layer 100 is preferably used for the light-emitting unit 108.
- the light emitting element 250 includes the light emitting layer 120 and the light emitting layer 170.
- the light emitting unit 106 includes a hole injection layer 111, a hole transport layer 112, an electron transport layer 113, and an electron injection layer 114.
- the light emitting unit 108 includes a hole injection layer 116, a hole transport layer 117, an electron transport layer 118, and an electron injection layer 119.
- the light-emitting element 250 only needs to include the compound according to one embodiment of the present invention in any layer of the light-emitting unit 106 and the light-emitting unit 108. Note that the light-emitting layer 120 or the light-emitting layer 170 is preferable as the layer containing the compound.
- the charge generation layer 115 has a configuration in which an acceptor substance that is an electron acceptor is added to a hole transport material, but a donor substance that is an electron donor is added to the electron transport material. May be. Moreover, both these structures may be laminated
- the charge generation layer 115 includes a composite material of an organic compound and an acceptor substance
- a composite material that can be used for the hole-injection layer 111 described in Embodiment 1 may be used as the composite material.
- the organic compound various compounds such as an aromatic amine compound, a carbazole compound, an aromatic hydrocarbon, and a high molecular compound (oligomer, dendrimer, polymer, etc.) can be used.
- an organic compound having a hole mobility of 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 6 cm 2 / Vs or higher is preferably used. Note that other than these substances, any substance that has a property of transporting more holes than electrons may be used.
- the charge generation layer 115 can also serve as a hole injection layer or a hole transport layer of the light emission unit.
- the unit may not be provided with a hole injection layer or a hole transport layer.
- the charge generation layer 115 can also serve as an electron injection layer or an electron transport layer of the light emission unit. May have a configuration in which an electron injection layer or an electron transport layer is not provided.
- the charge generation layer 115 may be formed as a stacked structure in which a layer including a composite material of an organic compound and an acceptor substance and a layer formed using another material are combined.
- a layer including a composite material of an organic compound and an acceptor substance may be formed in combination with a layer including one compound selected from electron donating substances and a compound having a high electron transporting property.
- a layer including a composite material of an organic compound and an acceptor substance may be combined with a layer including a transparent conductive film.
- the charge generation layer 115 sandwiched between the light-emitting unit 106 and the light-emitting unit 108 injects electrons into one light-emitting unit and applies holes to the other light-emitting unit when voltage is applied to the electrode 101 and the electrode 102. As long as it injects. For example, in FIG. 7, when a voltage is applied so that the potential of the electrode 101 is higher than the potential of the electrode 102, the charge generation layer 115 injects electrons into the light emitting unit 106 and holes into the light emitting unit 108. Inject.
- the charge generation layer 115 preferably has a property of transmitting visible light (specifically, the transmittance of visible light to the charge generation layer 115 is 40% or more) from the viewpoint of light extraction efficiency.
- the charge generation layer 115 functions even when it has lower conductivity than the pair of electrodes (the electrode 101 and the electrode 102).
- the present invention can be similarly applied to a light emitting element in which three or more light emitting units are stacked.
- a plurality of light-emitting units are partitioned between a pair of electrodes by a charge generation layer, thereby enabling high-intensity light emission while maintaining a low current density, and a longer-life light-emitting element Can be realized.
- a light-emitting element with low power consumption can be realized.
- the light emission colors exhibited by the guest materials used for the light-emitting unit 106 and the light-emitting unit 108 may be the same as or different from each other.
- the light-emitting element 250 is preferably a light-emitting element that exhibits high emission luminance with a small current value.
- the light emitting element 250 is preferably a light emitting element that exhibits multicolor light emission.
- the light emission spectrum exhibited by the light-emitting element 250 is light in which light emission having different emission peaks is synthesized. Therefore, the emission spectrum has at least two maximum values.
- White light emission can be obtained by making the lights of the light emitting layer 120 and the light emitting layer 170 have complementary colors.
- the structure of the light-emitting layer 130 described in Embodiment 1 is preferably used for one or both of the light-emitting layer 120 and the light-emitting layer 170. With this configuration, a light-emitting element with favorable light emission efficiency and reliability can be obtained.
- the guest material contained in the light emitting layer 130 is a fluorescent material. Therefore, by using the structure of the light-emitting layer 130 described in Embodiment 1 for one or both of the light-emitting layer 120 and the light-emitting layer 170, a light-emitting element having high efficiency and high reliability can be obtained.
- the emission colors exhibited by the guest materials used in the respective light-emitting units may be the same or different from each other.
- the light emission colors exhibited by the plurality of light emitting units can achieve high light emission luminance with a smaller current value than other colors.
- Such a configuration can be suitably used for adjusting the emission color.
- it is suitable when using guest materials that have different luminous efficiencies and exhibit different luminescent colors.
- the emission intensity of light emission and phosphorescence can be adjusted. That is, the intensity of the emitted color can be adjusted by the number of light emitting units.
- a light emitting device having two fluorescent light emitting units and one phosphorescent light emitting unit
- a light emitting device containing two light emitting units containing a blue fluorescent material and one light emitting unit containing a yellow phosphorescent material blue A light emitting element having two layers of light emitting units including a fluorescent material and one layer of light emitting units including a red phosphorescent material and a green phosphorescent material, or two layers of light emitting units including a blue fluorescent material, a red phosphorescent material, and a yellow phosphorescent material
- a light-emitting element having one layer of a light-emitting unit containing a green phosphorescent material is preferable because white light emission can be efficiently obtained.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can be combined with a phosphorescent light-emitting unit as appropriate.
- the phosphorescent light emitting unit described above exhibits a light emission color other than blue.
- the structure of the light emitting layer 130 described in Embodiment Mode 1 can be used.
- the light emitting units other than blue have a fluorescent material.
- a light emitting element including two layers of light emitting units including a blue fluorescent material and one layer of light emitting units including a yellow fluorescent material, two layers of light emitting units including a blue fluorescent material, a red fluorescent material, and a green fluorescent material
- Light-emitting element having one layer of light-emitting unit containing a fluorescent material, or light-emitting element having two layers of light-emitting units containing a blue fluorescent material and one layer of light-emitting unit containing a red fluorescent material, a yellow fluorescent material and a green fluorescent material Can be considered.
- the light-emitting layer 130 described in Embodiment 1 is used for red, green, and yellow light-emitting units.
- a configuration using this configuration is also conceivable. This configuration is preferable because white light emission can be efficiently obtained.
- the following materials can be used for the light emitting layer of the blue fluorescent light emitting unit.
- the relationship between the T1 level of the host material and the T1 level of the guest material contained in the light-emitting layer of the blue fluorescent light-emitting unit is such that the T1 level of the host material is less than the T1 level of the guest material.
- TTA triplet-triplet annihilation
- the structure of the light emitting layer 130 shown in Embodiment Mode 1 may be used for the blue fluorescent light emitting unit.
- At least one of the light emitting layer 120 or the light emitting layer 170 may be further divided into layers, and a different light emitting material may be included in each of the divided layers. That is, at least one of the light-emitting layer 120 or the light-emitting layer 170 may be formed of two or more layers. For example, when a light emitting layer is formed by sequentially stacking a first light emitting layer and a second light emitting layer from the hole transport layer side, a material having a hole transport property is used as a host material of the first light emitting layer. There is a configuration in which a material having an electron transporting property is used as the host material of the light emitting layer 2.
- the light emitting materials included in the first light emitting layer and the second light emitting layer may be the same material or different materials, and may be different materials that have the function of emitting light of the same color.
- a material having a function of emitting light of a color may be used.
- white light emission having high color rendering properties composed of three primary colors or four or more light emission colors can be obtained.
- the hole-transporting material, the electron-transporting material, and the phosphorescent material described in Embodiment 1 can be used in appropriate combination for the light-emitting layer of the phosphorescent light-emitting unit described in Embodiment 3.
- a pyrene derivative for example, a perylene derivative, or the like can be used.
- the following materials can be used.
- N, N′-diphenyl-N, N′-bis [4- (9-phenyl-9H-fluoren-9-yl) phenyl] pyrene-1,6-diamine abbreviation: 1,6FLPAPrn
- N, N′-bis (3-methylphenyl) -N, N′-bis [3- (9-phenyl-9H-fluoren-9-yl) phenyl] pyrene-1,6-diamine abbreviation: 1, 6mMemFLPAPrn
- N, N'-bis [4- (9-phenyl-9H-fluoren-9-yl) phenyl] -N, N'-bis (4-tert-butylphenyl) -pyrene-1,6-diamine Abbreviation: 1,6tBu-FLPAPrn
- Examples of the host material include condensed polycyclic aromatic compounds such as anthracene derivatives, phenanthrene derivatives, pyrene derivatives, chrysene derivatives, dibenzo [g, p] chrysene derivatives, and specifically, tris (8-quinolinolato).
- condensed polycyclic aromatic compounds such as anthracene derivatives, phenanthrene derivatives, pyrene derivatives, chrysene derivatives, dibenzo [g, p] chrysene derivatives, and specifically, tris (8-quinolinolato).
- Aluminum (III) (abbreviation: Alq), Tris (4-methyl-8-quinolinolato) Aluminum (III) (abbreviation: Almq 3 ), bis (10-hydroxybenzo [h] quinolinato) beryllium (II) (abbreviation: BeBq) 2 ), bis (2-methyl-8-quinolinolato) (4-phenylphenolato) aluminum (III) (abbreviation: BAlq), bis (8-quinolinolato) zinc (II) (abbreviation: Znq), bis [2- (2-Benzoxazolyl) phenolato] zinc (II) (abbreviation: ZnPBO), bis [2- Metal complexes such as (2-benzothiazolyl) phenolato] zinc (II) (abbreviation: ZnBTZ), 2- (4-biphenylyl) -5- (4-tert-butylphenyl) -1,3,4-oxadiazole ( Abbreviation: P
- condensed polycyclic aromatic compounds such as anthracene derivatives, phenanthrene derivatives, pyrene derivatives, chrysene derivatives, and dibenzo [g, p] chrysene derivatives can be given.
- FIG. 8A is a top view illustrating the light-emitting device
- FIG. 8B is a cross-sectional view taken along lines AB and CD of FIG. 8A.
- This light-emitting device includes a drive circuit portion (source side drive circuit) 601, a pixel portion 602, and a drive circuit portion (gate side drive circuit) 603 indicated by dotted lines, for controlling light emission of the light emitting element.
- Reference numeral 604 denotes a sealing substrate
- reference numeral 625 denotes a desiccant
- reference numeral 605 denotes a sealing material
- the inside surrounded by the sealing material 605 is a space 607.
- the routing wiring 608 is a wiring for transmitting a signal input to the source side driving circuit 601 and the gate side driving circuit 603, and a video signal, a clock signal, an FPC (flexible printed circuit) 609 serving as an external input terminal, Receives start signal, reset signal, etc.
- FPC flexible printed circuit
- a printed wiring board PWB: Printed Wiring Board
- the light-emitting device in this specification includes not only a light-emitting device body but also a state in which an FPC or a PWB is attached thereto.
- a driver circuit portion and a pixel portion are formed over the element substrate 610.
- a source side driver circuit 601 that is a driver circuit portion and one pixel in the pixel portion 602 are shown.
- the source side driver circuit 601 is a CMOS circuit in which an n-channel TFT 623 and a p-channel TFT 624 are combined.
- the driving circuit may be formed of various CMOS circuits, PMOS circuits, and NMOS circuits.
- CMOS circuits complementary metal-oxide-semiconductor circuits
- PMOS circuits PMOS circuits
- NMOS circuits CMOS circuits
- a driver integrated type in which a driver circuit is formed over a substrate is shown; however, this is not necessarily required, and the driver circuit can be formed outside the substrate.
- the pixel portion 602 is formed of a pixel including a switching TFT 611, a current control TFT 612, and a first electrode 613 electrically connected to the drain thereof. Note that an insulator 614 is formed so as to cover an end portion of the first electrode 613.
- the insulator 614 can be formed using a positive photosensitive resin film.
- a surface having a curvature is formed at the upper end portion or the lower end portion of the insulator 614.
- photosensitive acrylic is used as a material for the insulator 614
- the curvature radius of the curved surface is preferably 0.2 ⁇ m or more and 0.3 ⁇ m or less.
- any of photosensitive materials such as a negative type and a positive type can be used.
- An EL layer 616 and a second electrode 617 are formed over the first electrode 613.
- a material used for the first electrode 613 functioning as an anode a material having a high work function is preferably used.
- an ITO film or an indium tin oxide film containing silicon a single layer such as an indium oxide film containing 2 wt% or more and 20 wt% or less of zinc oxide, a titanium nitride film, a chromium film, a tungsten film, a Zn film, or a Pt film
- a stack of titanium nitride and a film containing aluminum as a main component, a three-layer structure of a titanium nitride film, a film containing aluminum as a main component, and a titanium nitride film can be used. Note that with a stacked structure, resistance as a wiring is low, good ohmic contact can be obtained, and a function as an anode can be
- the EL layer 616 is formed by various methods such as an evaporation method using an evaporation mask, an inkjet method, and a spin coating method.
- the material forming the EL layer 616 may be a low molecular compound or a high molecular compound (including an oligomer and a dendrimer).
- the second electrode 617 formed over the EL layer 616 and functioning as a cathode a material having a low work function (Al, Mg, Li, Ca, or an alloy or compound thereof, MgAg, MgIn, AlLi or the like is preferably used.
- the second electrode 617 includes a thin metal film and a transparent conductive film (ITO, 2 wt% or more and 20 wt% or less).
- ITO transparent conductive film
- ZnO zinc oxide
- the light-emitting element 618 is formed by the first electrode 613, the EL layer 616, and the second electrode 617.
- the light-emitting element 618 is preferably a light-emitting element having the structure of Embodiments 1 and 2. Note that a plurality of light-emitting elements are formed in the pixel portion. However, in the light-emitting device in this embodiment, the light-emitting element having the structure described in Embodiments 1 and 2 and other structures are used. Both of the light emitting elements having the above may be included.
- the sealing substrate 604 is bonded to the element substrate 610 with the sealant 605, whereby the light-emitting element 618 is provided in the space 607 surrounded by the element substrate 610, the sealing substrate 604, and the sealant 605. Yes.
- the space 607 is filled with a filler and may be filled with an inert gas (nitrogen, argon, or the like), or may be filled with a resin or a desiccant, or both.
- an epoxy resin or glass frit is preferably used for the sealant 605. Moreover, it is desirable that these materials are materials that do not transmit moisture and oxygen as much as possible.
- a plastic substrate made of FRP (Fiber Reinforced Plastics), PVF (polyvinyl fluoride), polyester, acrylic, or the like can be used as a material used for the sealing substrate 604.
- FIG. 9 shows an example of a light-emitting device in which a light-emitting element that emits white light is formed and a colored layer (color filter) is formed as an example of the light-emitting device.
- FIG. 9A shows a substrate 1001, a base insulating film 1002, a gate insulating film 1003, gate electrodes 1006, 1007, and 1008, a first interlayer insulating film 1020, a second interlayer insulating film 1021, a peripheral portion 1042, and a pixel portion.
- a green pixel 1044G, a blue pixel 1044B, a white pixel 1044W, and the like are illustrated.
- a colored layer (a red colored layer 1034R, a green colored layer 1034G, and a blue colored layer 1034B) is provided over a transparent base material 1033. Further, a black layer (black matrix) 1035 may be further provided.
- the transparent base material 1033 provided with the coloring layer and the black layer is aligned and fixed to the substrate 1001. Note that the colored layer and the black layer are covered with an overcoat layer 1036.
- FIG. 9A there are a light emitting layer in which light is emitted outside without passing through the colored layer, and a light emitting layer in which light is emitted through the colored layer of each color and is transmitted through the colored layer. Since the light that does not pass is white, and the light that passes through the colored layer is red, blue, and green, an image can be expressed by pixels of four colors.
- FIG. 9B illustrates an example in which the red coloring layer 1034R, the green coloring layer 1034G, and the blue coloring layer 1034B are formed between the gate insulating film 1003 and the first interlayer insulating film 1020.
- the coloring layer may be provided between the substrate 1001 and the sealing substrate 1031.
- a light-emitting device having a structure in which light is extracted to the substrate 1001 side where the TFT is formed (bottom emission type) is used.
- a structure in which light is extracted from the sealing substrate 1031 side (top-emission type).
- 10A and 10B are cross-sectional views of a top emission type light-emitting device.
- a substrate that does not transmit light can be used as the substrate 1001.
- the connection electrode for connecting the TFT and the anode of the light emitting element is manufactured, it is formed in the same manner as the bottom emission type light emitting device.
- a third interlayer insulating film 1037 is formed so as to cover the electrode 1022. This insulating film may play a role of planarization.
- the third interlayer insulating film 1037 can be formed using various other materials in addition to the same material as the second interlayer insulating film 1021.
- the lower electrode 1025W, the lower electrode 1025R, the lower electrode 1025G, and the lower electrode 1025B of the light emitting element are anodes here, but may be cathodes.
- the lower electrode 1025W, the lower electrode 1025R, the lower electrode 1025G, and the lower electrode 1025B are preferably reflective electrodes.
- the second electrode 1029 preferably has a function of reflecting light and a function of transmitting light.
- a microcavity structure be applied between the second electrode 1029 and the lower electrode 1025W, the lower electrode 1025R, the lower electrode 1025G, and the lower electrode 1025B to have a function of amplifying light of a specific wavelength.
- the EL layer 1028 has a structure as described in Embodiments 1 and 3, and has an element structure in which white light emission can be obtained.
- the EL layer from which white light emission can be obtained includes a plurality of light-emitting layers and a plurality of light-emitting units. This may be realized by using, for example.
- the configuration for obtaining white light emission is not limited to these.
- sealing is performed with a sealing substrate 1031 provided with colored layers (red colored layer 1034R, green colored layer 1034G, and blue colored layer 1034B). It can be carried out.
- a black layer (black matrix) 1030 may be provided on the sealing substrate 1031 so as to be positioned between the pixels.
- the colored layer (red colored layer 1034R, green colored layer 1034G, blue colored layer 1034B) or black layer (black matrix) may be covered with an overcoat layer.
- the sealing substrate 1031 is a light-transmitting substrate.
- full color display 10A shows a configuration in which full color display is performed with three colors of red, green, and blue. As shown in FIG. 10B, full color display is performed with four colors of red, green, blue, and white. You may do. Further, the configuration for performing full color display is not limited to these. For example, full color display may be performed with four colors of red, green, blue, and yellow.
- a fluorescent material is used as a guest material. Since the fluorescent material has a sharper spectrum than the phosphorescent material, light emission with high color purity can be obtained. Therefore, a light-emitting device with high color reproducibility can be obtained by using the light-emitting element for the light-emitting device described in this embodiment.
- a highly reliable electronic device and display device having a flat surface and favorable emission efficiency can be manufactured. Further, according to one embodiment of the present invention, a highly reliable electronic device and display device having a curved surface and favorable emission efficiency can be manufactured. In addition, a light-emitting element with high color reproducibility can be obtained as described above.
- Electronic devices include, for example, television devices, desktop or notebook personal computers, monitors for computers, digital cameras, digital video cameras, digital photo frames, mobile phones, portable game consoles, personal digital assistants, audio devices Large game machines such as playback devices and pachinko machines are listed.
- a portable information terminal 900 illustrated in FIGS. 11A and 11B includes a housing 901, a housing 902, a display portion 903, a hinge portion 905, and the like.
- the housing 901 and the housing 902 are connected by a hinge portion 905.
- the portable information terminal 900 can be expanded from the folded state (FIG. 11A) as shown in FIG. Thereby, when carrying, it is excellent in portability, and when using, it is excellent in visibility by a large display area.
- the portable information terminal 900 is provided with a flexible display portion 903 across a housing 901 and a housing 902 connected by a hinge portion 905.
- a light-emitting device manufactured using one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display portion 903. Thereby, a portable information terminal having high reliability can be manufactured.
- the display unit 903 can display at least one of document information, a still image, a moving image, and the like.
- the portable information terminal 900 can be used as an electronic book terminal.
- the display unit 903 When the portable information terminal 900 is deployed, the display unit 903 is held with a large curvature radius.
- the display portion 903 is held including a curved portion with a curvature radius of 1 mm to 50 mm, preferably 5 mm to 30 mm.
- Part of the display portion 903 can display a curved surface by continuously arranging pixels from the housing 901 to the housing 902.
- the display portion 903 functions as a touch panel and can be operated with a finger or a stylus.
- the display unit 903 is preferably composed of one flexible display. Accordingly, it is possible to perform continuous display without interruption between the housing 901 and the housing 902. Note that a display may be provided in each of the housing 901 and the housing 902.
- the hinge unit 905 preferably has a lock mechanism so that the angle between the housing 901 and the housing 902 does not become larger than a predetermined angle when the portable information terminal 900 is deployed.
- the angle at which the lock is applied is 90 degrees or more and less than 180 degrees, typically 90 degrees, 120 degrees, 135 degrees, 150 degrees, or 175 degrees. be able to. Thereby, the convenience, safety
- the hinge portion 905 has a lock mechanism
- the display portion 903 can be prevented from being damaged without applying excessive force to the display portion 903. Therefore, a highly reliable portable information terminal can be realized.
- the housing 901 and the housing 902 may include a power button, an operation button, an external connection port, a speaker, a microphone, and the like.
- One of the housing 901 and the housing 902 is provided with a wireless communication module, and transmits and receives data via a computer network such as the Internet, a LAN (Local Area Network), and Wi-Fi (registered trademark). Is possible.
- a computer network such as the Internet, a LAN (Local Area Network), and Wi-Fi (registered trademark). Is possible.
- a portable information terminal 910 illustrated in FIG. 11C includes a housing 911, a display portion 912, operation buttons 913, an external connection port 914, a speaker 915, a microphone 916, a camera 917, and the like.
- a light-emitting device manufactured using one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display portion 912. Thereby, a portable information terminal can be manufactured with a high yield.
- the portable information terminal 910 includes a touch sensor in the display unit 912. All operations such as making a call or inputting characters can be performed by touching the display portion 912 with a finger or a stylus.
- the power can be turned on and off, and the type of the image displayed on the display unit 912 can be switched.
- the mail creation screen can be switched to the main menu screen.
- the orientation (portrait or landscape) of the portable information terminal 910 is determined, and the screen display orientation of the display unit 912 is determined. It can be switched automatically. The screen display orientation can also be switched by touching the display portion 912, operating the operation buttons 913, or inputting voice using the microphone 916.
- the portable information terminal 910 has one or more functions selected from, for example, a telephone, a notebook, an information browsing device, or the like. Specifically, it can be used as a smartphone.
- the portable information terminal 910 can execute various applications such as mobile phone, electronic mail, text browsing and creation, music playback, video playback, Internet communication, and games.
- a camera 920 illustrated in FIG. 11D includes a housing 921, a display portion 922, operation buttons 923, a shutter button 924, and the like.
- a removable lens 926 is attached to the camera 920.
- a light-emitting device manufactured using one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display portion 922. Thereby, a highly reliable camera can be manufactured.
- the camera 920 is configured such that the lens 926 can be removed from the housing 921 and replaced, but the lens 926 and the housing 921 may be integrated.
- the camera 920 can capture a still image or a moving image by pressing the shutter button 924.
- the display portion 922 has a function as a touch panel and can capture an image by touching the display portion 922.
- the camera 920 can be separately attached with a strobe device, a viewfinder, and the like. Alternatively, these may be incorporated in the housing 921.
- FIG. 12A is a schematic diagram illustrating an example of a cleaning robot.
- the cleaning robot 5100 includes a display 5101 disposed on the upper surface, a plurality of cameras 5102 disposed on the side surface, brushes 5103, and operation buttons 5104. Although not shown, the lower surface of the cleaning robot 5100 is provided with a tire, a suction port, and the like. In addition, the cleaning robot 5100 includes various sensors such as an infrared sensor, an ultrasonic sensor, an acceleration sensor, a piezo sensor, an optical sensor, and a gyro sensor. Moreover, the cleaning robot 5100 includes a wireless communication unit.
- the cleaning robot 5100 is self-propelled, can detect the dust 5120, and can suck the dust from the suction port provided on the lower surface.
- the cleaning robot 5100 can analyze an image captured by the camera 5102 and determine whether there is an obstacle such as a wall, furniture, or a step. In addition, when an object that is likely to be entangled with the brush 5103 such as wiring is detected by image analysis, the rotation of the brush 5103 can be stopped.
- the display 5101 can display the remaining battery level, the amount of dust sucked, and the like.
- the route on which the cleaning robot 5100 has traveled may be displayed on the display 5101.
- the display 5101 may be a touch panel, and the operation buttons 5104 may be provided on the display 5101.
- the cleaning robot 5100 can communicate with a portable electronic device 5140 such as a smartphone.
- An image captured by the camera 5102 can be displayed on the portable electronic device 5140. Therefore, the owner of the cleaning robot 5100 can know the state of the room even when away from home.
- the display on the display 5101 can be confirmed with a portable electronic device 5140 such as a smartphone.
- the light-emitting device of one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display 5101.
- a robot 2100 illustrated in FIG. 12B includes an arithmetic device 2110, an illuminance sensor 2101, a microphone 2102, an upper camera 2103, a speaker 2104, a display 2105, a lower camera 2106, an obstacle sensor 2107, and a moving mechanism 2108.
- the microphone 2102 has a function of detecting a user's speaking voice, environmental sound, and the like.
- the speaker 2104 has a function of emitting sound.
- the robot 2100 can communicate with the user using the microphone 2102 and the speaker 2104.
- the display 2105 has a function of displaying various information.
- the robot 2100 can display information desired by the user on the display 2105.
- the display 2105 may be equipped with a touch panel. Further, the display 2105 may be an information terminal that can be removed, and is installed at a fixed position of the robot 2100 to enable charging and data transfer.
- the upper camera 2103 and the lower camera 2106 have a function of imaging the surroundings of the robot 2100.
- the obstacle sensor 2107 can detect the presence or absence of an obstacle in the traveling direction when the robot 2100 moves forward using the moving mechanism 2108.
- the robot 2100 can recognize the surrounding environment using the upper camera 2103, the lower camera 2106, and the obstacle sensor 2107, and can move safely.
- the light-emitting device of one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display 2105.
- FIG. 12C illustrates an example of a goggle type display.
- the goggle type display includes, for example, a housing 5000, a display unit 5001, a speaker 5003, an LED lamp 5004, operation keys 5005 (including a power switch or an operation switch), a connection terminal 5006, and a sensor 5007 (force, displacement, position, speed). , Acceleration, angular velocity, number of revolutions, distance, light, liquid, magnetism, temperature, chemical, sound, time, hardness, electric field, current, voltage, power, radiation, flow rate, humidity, gradient, vibration, smell, or infrared
- the light-emitting device of one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display portion 5001 and the second display portion 5002.
- FIG. 13A and 13B show a foldable portable information terminal 5150.
- FIG. A foldable portable information terminal 5150 includes a housing 5151, a display region 5152, and a bent portion 5153.
- FIG. 13A shows the portable information terminal 5150 in a developed state.
- FIG. 13B illustrates the portable information terminal 5150 in a folded state. Although the portable information terminal 5150 has a large display area 5152, the portable information terminal 5150 is compact and excellent in portability when folded.
- the display region 5152 can be folded in half by a bent portion 5153.
- the bent portion 5153 includes an extendable member and a plurality of support members. When the bent portion 5153 is folded, the extendable member extends, and the bent portion 5153 has a radius of curvature of 2 mm or more, preferably 5 mm or more. It can be folded.
- the display area 5152 may be a touch panel (input / output device) equipped with a touch sensor (input device).
- the light-emitting device of one embodiment of the present invention can be used for the display region 5152.
- an electronic device or a lighting device having a light-emitting region having a curved surface can be realized.
- the light-emitting device to which the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention is applied can also be used for lighting of a car, for example, lighting can be installed on a windshield, a ceiling, or the like.
- FIG. 14 shows an example in which a light-emitting element is used as an indoor lighting device 8501.
- the light-emitting element can have a large area, a large-area lighting device can be formed.
- the lighting device 8502 in which the light-emitting region has a curved surface can be formed.
- the light-emitting element described in this embodiment is thin and has a high degree of freedom in housing design. Therefore, it is possible to form a lighting device with various designs.
- a large lighting device 8503 may be provided on the indoor wall surface.
- the lighting devices 8501, 8502, and 8503 may be provided with touch sensors to turn the power on or off.
- illuminating device 8504 provided with the function as a table by using a light emitting element for the surface side of a table.
- a lighting device having a function as furniture can be obtained by using a light-emitting element as part of other furniture.
- a lighting device and an electronic device can be obtained by using the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- applicable lighting devices and electronic devices are not limited to those described in this embodiment and can be applied to lighting devices and electronic devices in various fields.
- This compound is a guest material having a protective group that can be preferably used in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Sublimation purification of 1.5 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 315 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 4.5 Pa. After sublimation purification, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 1.3 g and a recovery rate of 89%.
- FIG. 15B is an enlarged view of the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 16 is an enlarged view of the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth, which was the target product, was obtained.
- FIG. 17 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth.
- an ultraviolet-visible spectrophotometer V550, manufactured by JASCO Corporation was used, and the spectrum measured by placing only toluene in a quartz cell was subtracted.
- the toluene solution of 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth showed absorption peaks around 468 nm, 378 nm and 359 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 523 nm (excitation wavelength 440 nm).
- a method for synthesizing -di-tert-butylphenyl) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- This compound is a guest material having a protective group that can be preferably used in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of bis (3,5-tert-butylphenyl) amine> 5.4 g (20 mmol) 1-bromo-3,5-di-tert-butylbenzene, 5.0 g (24 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butylaniline and 4.7 g (49 mmol) sodium t -Butoxide was put into a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the inside of the flask was purged with nitrogen. 100 mL of toluene was added to this mixture, and the resulting mixture was degassed under reduced pressure.
- Step 1 The synthesis scheme of Step 1 is shown in (B-1) below.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth> 0.95 g (2.5 mmol) 2-tert-butylanthracene, 2.0 g (5.1 mmol) bis (3,5-tert-butylphenyl) amine, 1.0 g (10 mmol) sodium t- Butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- 0.30 g of the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 12%.
- the synthesis scheme of Step 2 is shown in (B-2) below.
- Sublimation purification of 0.30 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 230 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 3.6 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.15 g and a recovery rate of 50%.
- FIG. 18B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 19 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 20 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the organic compound represented by the structural formula (101) of Embodiment 1, 2,6-di-tert-butyl-N, N, N ′, N′-tetrakis (4-tert-butylphenyl) ) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- This compound is a guest material having a protective group that can be preferably used in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- 1.2 g of a target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 38%.
- the synthesis scheme of Step 1 is shown in (C-1) below.
- the obtained yellow solid was purified by sublimation by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 315 ° C. for 15 hours under the condition of pressure 4.0 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.94 g and a recovery rate of 82%.
- FIG. 21B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 22 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 23 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the toluene solution of 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth showed absorption peaks in the vicinity of 462 nm, 381 nm, and 358 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 523 nm (excitation wavelength: 455 nm).
- an organic compound which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (103) of Embodiment 1, 2,6-di-tert-butyl-N, N, N ′, N′-tetrakis A method for synthesizing (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2,6tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- This compound is a guest material having a protective group that can be preferably used in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Sublimation purification of 0.45 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 275 ° C. for 15 hours under the condition of a pressure of 5.0 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.37 g and a recovery rate of 82%.
- FIGS. 24B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 25 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2,6tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 26 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2,6 tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the toluene solution of 2,6tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth showed absorption peaks in the vicinity of 461 nm, 379 nm, and 358 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 521 nm (excitation wavelength: 455 nm).
- 1,3,8,10-tetra-tert-butyl-7,14-bis (3,3, which is an organic compound of one embodiment of the present invention shown as the structural formula (104) in Embodiment 1
- a method for synthesizing 5-di-tert-butylphenyl) -5,12-dihydroquino [2,3-b] acridine-7,14-dione (abbreviation: Oct-tBuDPQd) is described.
- This compound is a guest material having a protective group that can be preferably used in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 1,4-cyclohexadiene-1,4-dicarboxylic acid, 2,5-bis ⁇ (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) amino ⁇ -dimethyl ester> 5.6 g (24 mmol) of dimethyl 1,4-cyclohexanedione-2,5-dicarboxylate and 10 g (48 mmol) of 3,5-di-tert-butylaniline were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask equipped with a reflux tube. The mixture was stirred at 170 ° C. for 2 hours.
- Step 1 The synthesis scheme of Step 1 is shown in (E-1) below.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 1,4-benzenedicarboxylic acid, 2,5-bis ⁇ (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) amino ⁇ -dimethyl ester> 12 g (20 mmol) of 1,4-cyclohexadiene-1,4-dicarboxylic acid, 2,5-bis ⁇ (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) amino ⁇ -dimethyl ester obtained in step 1; 150 mL of toluene was placed in a 300 mL three-necked flask equipped with a reflux tube. The mixture was refluxed for 15 hours while bubbling air.
- Step 3 Synthesis of 1,4-benzenedicarboxylic acid, 2,5-bis [N, N′-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) amino] -dimethyl ester> 2.
- Step 4 1,3,8,10-tetra-tert-butyl-7,14-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) -5,12-dihydroquino [2,3-b] acridine- Synthesis of 7,14-dione (abbreviation: Oct-tBuDPQd)> 4.4 g (4.8 mmol) of 1,4-benzenedicarboxylic acid, 2,5-bis [N, N′-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) amino]-obtained in Step 3 Dimethyl ester and 20 mL of methanesulfonic acid were placed in a 100 mL three-necked flask equipped with a reflux tube, and the mixture was stirred at 160 ° C.
- FIGS. 27B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 28 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that Oct-tBuDPQd was obtained.
- FIG. 29 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of Oct-tBuDPQd in dichloromethane.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- an electrochemical analyzer manufactured by BAS Co., Ltd., model number: ALS model 600A or 600C
- DMF dehydrated dimethylformamide
- tetra-n-butylammonium perchlorate supporting electrolyte
- n-Bu 4 NClO 4 tetra-n-butylammonium perchlorate
- T0836 tetra-n-butylammonium perchlorate
- a platinum electrode manufactured by BAS Co., Ltd., PTE platinum electrode
- a platinum electrode manufactured by BAS Inc., Pt counter electrode for VC-3 ( 5 cm)
- Ag / Ag + electrode manufactured by BAS Co., Ltd., RE7 non-aqueous solvent system reference electrode
- the measurement was performed at room temperature (20 to 25 ° C.). Further, the scanning speed during CV measurement was unified to 0.1 V / sec, and the oxidation potential Ea [V] and the reduction potential Ec [V] with respect to the reference electrode were measured.
- Ea was an intermediate potential of the oxidation-reduction wave
- Ec was an intermediate potential of the reduction-oxidation wave.
- the potential energy with respect to the vacuum level of the reference electrode used in this example is ⁇ 4.94 [eV]
- the HOMO level [eV] ⁇ 4.94 ⁇ Ea
- LUMO the HOMO level and the LUMO level can be obtained respectively.
- the CV measurement was repeated 100 times, and the electrical stability of the compound was examined by comparing the oxidation-reduction wave in the measurement at the 100th cycle with the oxidation-reduction wave at the first cycle.
- thermogravimetry-differential thermal analysis of Oct-tBuDPQd was performed.
- a high vacuum differential type differential thermal balance manufactured by Bruker AXS Co., Ltd., TG-DTA2410SA was used. The measurement was performed under the conditions of a temperature increase rate of 10 ° C./min and a nitrogen stream (flow rate of 2.4 mL / min) at 10 Pa.
- Thermogravimetry-Differential thermal analysis shows that Oct-tBuDPQd has a temperature (decomposition temperature) at which the weight obtained from thermogravimetry becomes -5% at the start of measurement (decomposition temperature) is 234 ° C. It was shown to sublime.
- An ITSO film having a thickness of 70 nm was formed as an electrode 101 on a glass substrate.
- the electrode area of the electrode 101 was 4 mm 2 (2 mm ⁇ 2 mm).
- DBT3P-II and MoO 3 are mixed so that the weight ratio (DBT3P-II: MoO 3 ) is 1: 0.5, and Co-evaporation was performed so that the thickness was 40 nm.
- PCCP was deposited as a hole transport layer 112 on the hole injection layer 111 so as to have a thickness of 20 nm.
- Ir (ppz) 3 is a phosphorescent material having Ir
- 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 are a combination that forms an exciplex.
- 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group.
- the value of x 1 is different for each light-emitting element, the value of x 1 in the light-emitting elements is a value shown in Table 3.
- 4,6mCzP2Pm was sequentially deposited on the light emitting layer 130 as the electron transport layer 118 so that the thickness was 20 nm and the thickness of NBPhen was 10 nm.
- LiF was deposited as an electron injection layer 119 on the electron transport layer 118 so as to have a thickness of 1 nm.
- Al aluminum
- a glass substrate for sealing is fixed to a glass substrate on which an organic material is formed using an organic EL sealing material, whereby the light-emitting elements 1 to 4 are formed. Sealed. Specifically, a sealing material is applied around the organic material formed on the glass substrate, the glass substrate and the glass substrate for sealing are bonded, and ultraviolet light having a wavelength of 365 nm is irradiated with 6 J / cm 2. And heat treatment at 80 ° C. for 1 hour. Through the above steps, the light-emitting elements 1 to 4 were obtained.
- the light-emitting elements 5 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 29 are different from the light-emitting elements 1 to 4 described above only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130, and other processes.
- the light-emitting elements 5 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 29 are different from the light-emitting elements 1 to 4 described above only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130, and other processes.
- the guest materials used for the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 have a protective group around the luminophore, but the guest materials used for the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 28 do not have a bulky substituent.
- the comparative light emitting element 29 does not use a guest material for the light emitting layer. Therefore, light emission observed from the comparative light emitting element 29 is light emission of an exciplex formed from 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 .
- FIGS. 30 to 36 The external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 29 are shown in FIGS. 30 to 36, respectively.
- FIGS. 37 to 43 show electroluminescence spectra when current is passed through the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 29 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 , respectively. . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.).
- Table 4 and Table 5 show element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 29 near 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 1 to 4 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 535 nm and a half-value width of around 67 nm.
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 5 to 8 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 522 nm and a half width of about 68 nm.
- FIG. 38 the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 5 to 8 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 522 nm and a half width of about 68 nm.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 9 to 12 show green light emission derived from 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 530 nm and a half-value width of around 65 nm. It was.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 13 to 16 show green light emission derived from 2,6 tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 521 nm and a half-value width of about 67 nm. It was.
- FIG. 40 emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 9 to 12 show green light emission derived from 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 530 nm and a half-value width of around 65 nm. It was.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 13 to 16 show green light emission derived from 2,6 tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about
- the emission spectra of the comparative light-emitting element 17 to the comparative light-emitting element 20 showed green light emission derived from TTPA having a peak wavelength of around 540 nm and a full width at half maximum of around 66 nm.
- the emission spectra of the comparative light-emitting element 21 to the comparative light-emitting element 24 showed green light emission derived from MeDPhA2A having a peak wavelength of around 530 nm and a half width of around 65 nm.
- MeDPhA2A peak wavelength of around 530 nm
- a half width of around 65 nm As shown in FIG.
- the emission spectra of the comparative light-emitting elements 25 to 28 showed green light emission derived from mMeDPhA2A having a peak wavelength of about 523 nm and a half-value width of about 68 nm. Therefore, it was found that the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting element 17 to the comparative light-emitting element 28 can emit light derived from the fluorescent material included in each element. As shown in FIG. 37, the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 29 had a peak wavelength of 531 nm and a full width at half maximum of around 88 nm.
- the light emission obtained from the comparative light-emitting element 29 is that of an exciplex formed from 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3. I understood that.
- the shape of the emission spectrum (PL spectrum) in the solution (for example, toluene solution) of the guest material contained in each material and the emission spectrum (EL spectrum) in a light emitting element may differ a little. This is because in each light-emitting element, light emission of the guest material is affected by a recombination region, an optical path length until light is extracted from the recombination region, and the like. Even in a light-emitting element using the same guest material, the shapes of emission spectra may not completely match. This is also because the effects of the recombination region and the optical path length are slightly different in each light emitting element.
- the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 28 emit light derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIGS. 30 to 36, Table 4, and Table 5.
- high luminous efficiency exceeding at least 9% of external quantum efficiency was exhibited.
- the light emission exhibited by the 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 exciplexes as energy donors and the light emission exhibited by each light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, that is, the energy acceptors
- the energy acceptors It can be seen that light emission derived from the guest material is light emission of similar colors. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, a highly efficient light-emitting element is obtained even though a guest material having a light emission color close to that of an energy donor is used. As described above, when the emission colors of the energy donor and the energy acceptor are close to each other, the rate constant of energy transfer by the Förster mechanism is reduced from Equation (1). However, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, The concentration of certain fluorescent materials can be increased. Therefore, a fluorescent material having an emission color close to that of an energy donor can be used as a guest material.
- the peak wavelength of the emission spectrum of the toluene solution of 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth was 519 nm
- the peak wavelength of the emission spectrum exhibited by the exciplex of 4,6 mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 was 531 nm.
- a combination in which the emission colors of the energy donor and the energy acceptor are close can be preferably used.
- the generation probability of singlet excitons generated by recombination of carriers (holes and electrons) injected from a pair of electrodes is 25% at the maximum, when the light extraction efficiency to the outside is 30%, fluorescence
- the external quantum efficiency of the light emitting element is 7.5% at the maximum.
- the external quantum efficiency is higher than 7.5%.
- light emission derived from energy transfer from triplet excitons, or excitation In addition to light emission derived from singlet excitons generated by recombination of carriers (holes and electrons) injected from a pair of electrodes, light emission derived from energy transfer from triplet excitons, or excitation.
- the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light-emitting elements 17 to 28 can be regarded as light-emitting elements using ExEF.
- the oxidation potential of 4,6mCzP2Pm was 0.95V, and the reduction potential was -2.06V.
- the HOMO level of 4,6mCzP2Pm calculated from CV measurement was ⁇ 5.89 eV, and the LUMO level was ⁇ 2.88 eV.
- the oxidation potential of Ir (ppz) 3 was 0.45V, and the reduction potential was ⁇ 3.17V.
- the HOMO level of Ir (ppz) 3 calculated from CV measurement was ⁇ 5.39 eV, and the LUMO level was ⁇ 1.77 eV.
- the LUMO level of 4,6mCzP2Pm is Ir (ppz) lower than 3 LUMO level
- the HOMO level of Ir (ppz) 3 is higher than the HOMO level of 4,6mCzP2Pm. Therefore, when the compound is used for the light emitting layer, electrons and holes are efficiently injected into 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 , respectively, and an exciplex is formed by 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3. be able to.
- FIG. 161 shows a relationship between an EL (light emission) spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 29 and an absorption spectrum and an emission spectrum in a toluene solution of each guest material used for the light-emitting elements 1 to 12.
- FIG. 161 shows that when the absorption spectra of the guest materials are compared, the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum overlaps with the emission spectrum.
- FIG. 44 shows the relationship between the guest material concentration and the external quantum efficiency in each guest material. 44, the light-emitting element 1 to the light-emitting element 16 of one embodiment of the present invention using a guest material having a protecting group suppress a decrease in efficiency due to an increase in concentration as compared with the comparative light-emitting element 17 to the comparative light-emitting element 28. You can see that.
- the fluorescent light-emitting element in which the fluorescent material used for the comparative light-emitting element 17 to the comparative light-emitting element 28 is used as a guest material and the material having a function capable of converting triplet excitation energy into light emission is used as a host material.
- the concentration of the guest material is increased, there is a problem that the light emission efficiency is greatly reduced.
- the external quantum efficiency is reduced by about 40% to 50%. That is, it is shown that the energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism cannot be suppressed in the comparative light emitting elements 17 to 28.
- the reduction in efficiency can be suppressed.
- the luminous efficiency can be improved by increasing the concentration.
- 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth and 2 wherein a diphenylamino group is bonded to the luminophore, the phenyl group has two protecting groups, and the two protecting groups are bonded to the 3rd and 5th positions of the phenyl group.
- the light-emitting elements 5 to 8 and the light-emitting elements 13 to 16 using 6tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth as the guest material were found to be particularly effective. It is suggested that by having a protecting group at the bonding position, the luminophore can be efficiently moved away from the host material. From the above, it is found that a light-emitting element with high guest material concentration and high emission efficiency can be obtained with the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- the measurement was performed at room temperature (300 K), an applied pulse voltage was applied in the vicinity of 3 V to 4 V so that the luminance of the light emitting element was around 1000 cd / m 2 , the applied pulse time width was 100 ⁇ sec, and the negative bias voltage was ⁇ 5 V (element The measurement was performed under the condition that the measurement time range was 20 ⁇ sec.
- the measurement results are shown in FIGS. In FIGS. 45 to 51, the measurement results are shown in FIG. 45 to FIG. 51.
- the vertical axis indicates the intensity normalized with the light emission intensity in a state where carriers are constantly injected (when the pulse voltage is ON).
- the horizontal axis represents the elapsed time from the fall of the pulse voltage.
- the light emitting elements 1 to 16 and the comparative light emitting elements 17 to 28 emit a fast fluorescent component of 0.5 ⁇ s or less and 3 ⁇ s. It was found to exhibit luminescence with a degree of delayed fluorescence component. It was also found that when a fluorescent material was added as a guest material regardless of each guest material, the higher the concentration of the fluorescent material, the faster the proportion of the fluorescent component and the lower the proportion of the delayed fluorescent component.
- the comparative light emitting element 29 emits light of an exciplex of 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 which are host materials, and can emit light having an early fluorescent component of 1 ⁇ s or less and a delayed fluorescent component of about 3 ⁇ s. I understood. From these facts, it can be seen that by adding a fluorescent material as a guest material to the light emitting layer, the ratio of the fast fluorescent component derived from the fluorescent material is increased.
- the light-emitting elements 1 to 16 using the guest material having a protective group which is a light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention as described above, even if a light-emitting element having a high concentration of a fluorescent material is used, a high external It shows quantum efficiency. That is, it can be seen that the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention shows high light emission efficiency even when the ratio of light emission derived from the fluorescent material is increased. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, energy transfer of the triplet excitation energy and deactivation of the triplet excitation energy by the Dexter mechanism from the host material to the guest material can be suppressed.
- the comparative light emitting element 17 is a comparative light emitting element having the highest external quantum efficiency among the comparative light emitting elements 17 to 20.
- the comparative light emitting element 21 and the comparative light emitting element 25 are comparative light emitting elements having the highest light emission efficiency among the comparative light emitting elements using the same guest material.
- the comparative light-emitting element has the lowest guest material concentration (1 wt%) among the comparative light-emitting elements using the same guest material.
- the light-emitting element 4 and the light-emitting element 8 are light-emitting elements having the highest guest material concentration (10 wt%) among light-emitting elements using the same guest material.
- a light-emitting element having high emission efficiency can be manufactured even when the guest material concentration is increased as described above. Therefore, the light-emitting element 4 and the light-emitting element 8 have an external quantum efficiency equal to or higher than that of the comparative light-emitting element having the highest light-emitting efficiency among the comparative light-emitting elements using the same guest material, although the guest material concentration is high. doing.
- the light-emitting element 4 and the light-emitting element 8 have better reliability than the comparative light-emitting element 17, the comparative light-emitting element 21, the comparative light-emitting element 25, and the comparative light-emitting element 29.
- the energy transfer from the energy acceptor to the guest material that is, the energy transfer related to light emission
- the energy transfer speed related to light emission it is important to increase the energy transfer speed related to light emission.
- the concentration of the guest material in the light emitting layer As described above, in the comparative light-emitting element, when the guest material concentration is increased, the light emission efficiency is greatly reduced. Therefore, it is difficult to manufacture a light-emitting element having good light emission efficiency and good reliability.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can increase energy transfer speed by the Förster mechanism while suppressing energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism, and can reduce the influence of competition with the quenching process.
- a light-emitting element having good reliability while having luminous efficiency can be obtained.
- the result of FIG. 69 shows this effect. Therefore, the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can increase the concentration of the guest material, so that a light-emitting element with favorable emission efficiency and reliability can be obtained.
- An ITSO film having a thickness of 70 nm was formed as an electrode 101 on a glass substrate.
- the electrode area of the electrode 101 was 4 mm 2 (2 mm ⁇ 2 mm).
- DBT3P-II and MoO 3 are mixed so that the weight ratio (DBT3P-II: MoO 3 ) is 1: 0.5, and Co-evaporation was performed so that the thickness was 40 nm.
- PCBBi1BP was deposited as a hole transport layer 112 on the hole injection layer 111 so as to have a thickness of 20 nm.
- mPCCzPTzn-02, PCCP, GD270 (manufactured by Jilin OLED Co., Ltd.), and 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth as a light emitting layer 130 on the hole transport layer 112 are weight ratio (mPCCzPTzn-02: PCCP: GD270: 2tBu).
- -PtBuDPhA2Anth) was 0.5: 0.5: 0.1: 0.05 and co-evaporated to a thickness of 40 nm.
- mPCCzPTzn-02 was sequentially deposited on the light emitting layer 130 as the electron transport layer 118 so that the thickness was 20 nm and the thickness of NBPhen was 10 nm.
- LiF was deposited as an electron injection layer 119 on the electron transport layer 118 so as to have a thickness of 1 nm.
- Al aluminum
- the light emitting element 30 was sealed by fixing the glass substrate for sealing in the glove box of nitrogen atmosphere to the glass substrate which formed the organic material using the sealing material for organic EL. Specifically, a sealing material is applied around the organic material formed on the glass substrate, the glass substrate and the glass substrate for sealing are bonded, and ultraviolet light having a wavelength of 365 nm is irradiated with 6 J / cm 2. And heat treatment at 80 ° C. for 1 hour. The light emitting element 30 was obtained through the above steps.
- the light-emitting element 31 to the light-emitting element 33 and the comparative light-emitting element 34 to the comparative light-emitting element 36 are different from the manufacturing method of the light-emitting element 30 described above only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130. A manufacturing method similar to that of the light-emitting element 30 was used. Since details of the element structure are as shown in Tables 6 and 7, details of the manufacturing method are omitted.
- the guest material used for the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 has a protective group around the luminophore, but the guest material used for the comparative light-emitting elements 34 to 36 does not have a bulky substituent.
- mPCCzPTzn-02 and PCCP are a combination that forms an exciplex
- GD270 is a phosphorescent material having Ir. Therefore, the light-emitting element 30 to the light-emitting element 33 and the comparative light-emitting element 34 to the comparative light-emitting element 36 are light-emitting elements that can convert triplet excitation energy into fluorescence because an exciplex or a phosphorescent material serves as an energy donor.
- the light emitting layer of each light emitting element is a light emitting layer obtained by adding a fluorescent material to a light emitting layer that can use ExTET.
- FIG. 56 shows external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 and the comparative light-emitting elements 34 to 36.
- FIG. 57 shows an electroluminescence spectrum obtained when current flows through the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 and the comparative light-emitting elements 34 to 36 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.).
- Table 8 shows element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 and the comparative light-emitting elements 34 to 36 around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 30 showed green light emission derived from 2,6tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 531 nm and a half width of 66 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the light-emitting element 31 showed green emission derived from 2,6 tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 525 nm and a half width of 69 nm.
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 32 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 533 nm and a half width of 66 nm.
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 33 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 525 nm and a half width of 66 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 34 showed green light emission derived from TTPA having a peak wavelength of 544 nm and a half width of 66 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 35 showed green emission derived from MeDPhA2A having a peak wavelength of 530 nm and a half width of 68 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 36 showed green emission derived from mMeDPhA2A having a peak wavelength of 526 nm and a half width of 72 nm.
- light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light emitting element was obtained from the light emitting elements 30 to 33 and the comparative light emitting elements 34 to 36. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex or the phosphorescent material.
- the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 show light emission derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIG. 56 and Table 8, the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 show high light emission efficiency exceeding the external quantum efficiency of 10%.
- the external quantum efficiency higher than that of the light emitting element 34 to the comparative light emitting element 36 was exhibited. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission.
- FIG. 162 shows an EL (light emission) spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 103 and an absorption spectrum and an emission spectrum in a toluene solution of each guest material used for the light emitting element 31, the light emitting element 33, the comparative light emitting element 34, and the comparative light emitting element 35. Show the relationship.
- the comparative light-emitting element 103 is a phosphorescent light-emitting element using ExTET, and the light-emitting elements 30 to 33 and the comparative light-emitting elements 34 to 36 can be regarded as elements obtained by adding a fluorescent material to the comparative light-emitting element 103. it can.
- FIG. 1 shows an EL (light emission) spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 103 and an absorption spectrum and an emission spectrum in a toluene solution of each guest material used for the light emitting element 31, the light emitting element 33, the comparative light emitting element 34, and the comparative light emitting element 35. Show the relationship.
- the light-emitting element 31, the light-emitting element 33, the comparative light-emitting element 34, and the comparative light-emitting element 35 receive the excitation energy of the above-described exciplex and emit light.
- the absorption spectrum of the guest material used for the light-emitting element 30, the light-emitting element 32, and the comparative light-emitting element 36 and the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 103 have the same relationship.
- the light emitting elements 30 to 33 have better external quantum efficiency than the comparative light emitting elements 34 to 36. Therefore, it can be said that the light emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention has favorable reliability because the light load of the light emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention is smaller than that of the comparative light emitting element.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can preferably use an exciplex or a phosphorescent material as a host material.
- the structure which added the fluorescent material to the light emitting layer which can utilize ExTET can also be used suitably.
- the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 are different from the light-emitting element 1 described above only in the guest material of the light-emitting layer 130, and the other manufacturing steps are the same as those of the light-emitting element 1.
- 4,6mCzP2Pm, Ir (ppz) 3 , and Oct-tBuDPQd are in a weight ratio (4,6mCzP2Pm: Ir (ppz) 3. : Oct-tBuDPQd) 0.8: 0.2: to be x 2, and thickness were co-deposited so as to 40 nm.
- Ir (ppz) 3 is a phosphorescent material having Ir
- 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 are a combination that forms an exciplex.
- Oct-tBuDPQd is a fluorescent material having a protecting group.
- the value of x 2 is different for each light-emitting element, the value of x 2 in the light-emitting elements is a value shown in Table 10.
- Comparative Light-Emitting Element 41 to 44 are different from the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 described above only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130, and the other processes are the same as those of the light-emitting element 1. It was a method. Details of the element structure are as shown in Table 9 and Table 10, and thus details of the manufacturing method are omitted.
- the guest materials used for the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 have protective groups around the luminophores, but the guest materials used for the comparative light-emitting elements 41 to 44 do not have protective groups.
- all the luminophores shown in this example have a quinacridone skeleton.
- FIGS. 59 and 60 show external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 and the comparative light-emitting elements 41 to 44.
- FIGS. 61 and 62 show electroluminescence spectra when current is passed through the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 and the comparative light-emitting elements 41 to 44 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 , respectively. Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.).
- Table 11 shows element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 and the comparative light-emitting elements 41 to 44 at around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the emission spectra of the light emitting elements 37 to 40 have peak wavelengths of 525 nm, 525 nm, 526 nm, and 527 nm, and half widths of 57 nm, 41 nm, 33 nm, and 31 nm, respectively. It showed green emission derived from Oct-tBuDPQd.
- the light emission spectra of the comparative light emitting elements 41 to 44 have green wavelengths derived from DPQd having peak wavelengths of 526 nm, 527 nm, 528 nm, and 529 nm, respectively, and half widths of 29 nm, 25 nm, 25 nm, and 26 nm. showed that. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element.
- the light emitting elements 37 to 40 showed light emission derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIG. 59 and Table 11, the light emitting elements 37 to 40 showed high light emission efficiency at least exceeding 10% of the external quantum efficiency.
- the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 which are light-emitting elements of one embodiment of the present invention exhibited higher external quantum efficiency than the comparative light-emitting elements 41 to 44. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission.
- both the singlet excitation energy and the triplet excitation energy of each light emitting element are transferred to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light emitting element.
- the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum of the guest material used in this example and the emission spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 29 overlap. Therefore, the excitation energy of the exciplex composed of 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 functioning as an energy donor is efficiently transferred to each guest material by the Förster mechanism.
- a light-emitting element having high emission efficiency can be obtained by one embodiment of the present invention even when the energy donor and the guest material emit light of similar colors. It has been found that the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can be favorably used even in a combination in which the half width of the emission spectrum of the guest material is smaller than the half width of the emission spectrum of the energy donor. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, a highly efficient light-emitting element having a color similar to that of the energy donor and high color purity can be obtained.
- FIG. 63 shows the relationship between the guest material concentration and the external quantum efficiency in each guest material.
- the light-emitting element 37 to the light-emitting element 40 of one embodiment of the present invention using a guest material having a protective group suppresses a decrease in efficiency due to an increase in concentration as compared to the comparative light-emitting element 41 to the comparative light-emitting element 44. You can see that.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention suppresses triplet excitation energy transfer from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism even when the concentration of the guest material is high. Since non-radiative deactivation of excitation energy can be suppressed, a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be obtained.
- the light emitting element 37 to light emitting element 40 and the comparative light emitting element 41 to comparative light emitting element 44 have an early fluorescent component of 1 ⁇ s or less and about 3 ⁇ s. It was found to exhibit luminescence with a delayed fluorescence component. It was also found that when a fluorescent material was added as a guest material regardless of each guest material, the higher the concentration of the fluorescent material, the faster the proportion of the fluorescent component and the lower the proportion of the delayed fluorescent component. From this, it can be seen that by adding a fluorescent material as a guest material to the light emitting layer, the ratio of the fast fluorescent component derived from the fluorescent material is increased.
- the light-emitting elements 37 to 40 using the guest material having a protective group which is one embodiment of the present invention have high external quantum efficiency even in a light-emitting element having a high concentration of a fluorescent material.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention shows high light emission efficiency even when the ratio of light emission derived from the fluorescent material is increased. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, energy transfer of the triplet excitation energy and deactivation of the triplet excitation energy by the Dexter mechanism from the host material to the guest material can be suppressed. This suggests that the energy transfer efficiency of the excitation energy by the Forster mechanism can be improved.
- the luminescent group of the guest material that can be used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, not only the above-described anthracene skeleton but also a quinacridone skeleton can be preferably used.
- the light-emitting element 45 is different from the light-emitting element 30 described above only in the guest material of the light-emitting layer 130, and the other manufacturing steps are the same as those of the light-emitting element 30.
- mPCCzPTzn-02, PCCP, GD270 (manufactured by Jilin OLED Co., Ltd.), and Oct-tBuDPQd are weight ratios (mPCCzPTzn-02: PCCP: GD270: Co-evaporation was performed so that Oct-tBuDPQd) was 0.5: 0.5: 0.1: 0.05 and the thickness was 40 nm.
- the comparative light-emitting element 46 is different from the method for manufacturing the light-emitting element 45 described above only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130, and the other processes are the same as those for the light-emitting element 45. Details of the element structure are as shown in Table 12, and thus details of the manufacturing method are omitted.
- the guest material used for the light-emitting element 45 has a protective group around the luminophore, but the guest material used for the comparative light-emitting element 46 does not have a protective group.
- mPCCzPTzn-02 and PCCP are a combination that forms an exciplex
- GD270 is a phosphorescent material having Ir. Therefore, the light-emitting element 45 and the comparative light-emitting element 46 are light-emitting elements that can convert triplet excitation energy into fluorescence because an exciplex or a phosphorescent material serves as an energy donor.
- the light emitting layer of each light emitting element is a light emitting layer obtained by adding a fluorescent material to a light emitting layer that can use ExTET.
- FIG. 66 shows external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting element 45 and the comparative light-emitting element 46, respectively.
- FIG. 67 shows an electroluminescence spectrum when current is passed through the light-emitting element 45 and the comparative light-emitting element 46 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.).
- Table 13 shows element characteristics of the light-emitting element 45 and the comparative light-emitting element 46 around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 45 showed green light emission derived from Oct-tBuDPQd having a peak wavelength of 525 nm and a half width of 30 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 46 showed green light emission derived from DPQd having a peak wavelength of 525 nm and a half width of 75 nm.
- light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light emitting element was obtained from the light emitting element 45 and the comparative light emitting element 46. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex or the phosphorescent material.
- the light emitting element 45 showed light emission derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIG. 66 and Table 13, it showed high light emission efficiency exceeding the external quantum efficiency of 10%. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission. Therefore, it was found that triplet excitation energy transfer from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism and nonradiative deactivation of the triplet excitation energy can be suppressed by using the guest material having a protecting group for the light emitting layer. .
- the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum of the guest material used in this example overlaps with the emission spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 103. Therefore, the energy of GD270 functioning as an energy donor is efficiently transferred to each guest material by the Forster mechanism.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention can preferably use an exciplex or a phosphorescent material as a host material.
- the structure which added the fluorescent material to the light emitting layer which can utilize ExTET can also be used suitably.
- an organic compound which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (229) of Embodiment 1 2-trimethylsilyl-N, N, N ′, N′-tetrakis (3,5-di
- a method for synthesizing -tert-butylphenyl) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 9,10-dibromo-2-trimethylsilylanthracene> 2.7 g (11 mmol) of 2-trimethylsilylanthracene was placed in a 500 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. 110 mL of N, N-dimethyl sulfoxide was added thereto and stirred at room temperature. 4.0 g (23 mmol) of N-bromosuccinimide was added thereto and stirred at room temperature for 15 hours. After stirring, water was added to the reaction mixture to obtain an aqueous layer and an organic layer. The aqueous layer was extracted with toluene, and the resulting extract and the organic layer were combined.
- FIGS. 70B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 71 is a chart in which the range of 0.0 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 9,10-dibromo-2-trimethylsilylanthracene was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth> 1.4 g (3.3 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-trimethylsilylanthracene, 2.6 g (6.6 mmol) bis (3,5-tert-butylphenyl) amine, 1.3 g (14 mmol) Of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- 0.40 g of the obtained yellow solid was purified by sublimation by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 260 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 3.5 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.35 g and a recovery rate of 87%.
- FIGS. 72 and 73 are charts in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 73 is a chart in which the range of 0.0 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- an organic compound N, N ′-(2-phenylanthracene-9,10-diyl) -N, N which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (250) of Embodiment 1 is used.
- a method for synthesizing '-bis (3,5-dicyclohexylphenyl) -N, N'-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) diamine (abbreviation: 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 3,5-dicyclohexylphenyl trifluoromethanesulfonic acid> 8.2 g (32 mmol) of 3,5-dicyclohexylphenol was placed in a 1 L eggplant flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. 130 mL of dichloromethane and 12 mL (86 mmol) of triethylamine were added thereto and stirred at 0 ° C. 8 mL (48 mmol) of trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride in 50 mL dichloromethane was added dropwise thereto, and the mixture was stirred for 3 hours while returning the temperature to room temperature.
- FIGS. 74B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 74A is enlarged.
- FIG. 75 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 3,5-dicyclohexylphenyl trifluoromethanesulfonic acid was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 3,5-di-cyclohexyl-3 ′, 5′-di-tert-butyldiphenylamine> 3.9 g (10 mmol) of 3,5-dicyclohexylphenyl trifluoromethanesulfonic acid was placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- FIGS. 76B is a chart in which the range of 5.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 76A is enlarged.
- FIG. 76 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. 77A is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 3,5-di-cyclohexyl-3 ′, 5′-di-tert-butyldiphenylamine was obtained.
- Step 3 Synthesis of 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth> 1.4 g (3.4 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene and 3.2 g (7.2 mmol) 3,5-di-cyclohexyl-3 ′, 5′-di-tert-butyldiphenylamine Then, 1.3 g (14 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- the obtained yellow solid was recrystallized with ethyl acetate and ethanol to obtain the target yellow solid.
- the obtained yellow solid was purified by high performance liquid chromatography (abbreviation: HPLC) (developing solvent: chloroform) to obtain 0.79 g of the objective yellow solid in a yield of 20%.
- HPLC high performance liquid chromatography
- Sublimation purification of 0.79 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 275 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 3.5 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.72 g and a recovery rate of 91%.
- FIGS. 78 and 79 are shown below.
- FIGS. 78B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 79 is a chart obtained by enlarging the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth (structural formula (250)) was obtained.
- FIG. 80 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- an organic compound which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (222) of Embodiment 1 2-phenyl-N, N, N ′, N′-tetrakis (3,5-dicyclohexyl) is used.
- a method for synthesizing (phenyl) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of bis (3,5-cyclohexylphenyl) amine> 1.4 g (3.5 mmol) of 3,5-dicyclohexylphenyl trifluoromethanesulfonic acid was placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- FIG. 81B is a chart in which the range of 5.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 81A is enlarged.
- FIG. 82 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that bis (3,5-cyclohexylphenyl) amine was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth> 0.35 g (0.85 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene, 0.85 g (1.7 mmol) bis (3,5-cyclohexylphenyl) amine, and 0.34 g (3.5 mmol) Of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- 0.19 g of the obtained yellow solid was purified by sublimation by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 320 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 3.4 Pa. After sublimation purification, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.16 g and a recovery rate of 82%.
- FIGS. 83 and 84 are shown in which the measurement result by 1 H NMR of the yellow solid obtained in the above Step 2.
- FIGS. 83 and 84 are shown in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 83A is enlarged.
- FIG. 84 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 85 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- an organic compound which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (221) of Embodiment 1 2-phenyl-N, N, N ′, N′-tetrakis (3,5-di
- a method for synthesizing -tert-butylphenyl) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- the obtained yellow solid was recrystallized with ethyl acetate and ethanol to obtain 0.51 g of the objective yellow solid in a yield of 15%.
- This synthesis scheme is shown in (I-1) below.
- Sublimation purification of 0.50 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 270 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 3.6 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.38 g and a recovery rate of 77%.
- FIGS. 86B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 86A is enlarged.
- FIG. 87 is a chart obtained by enlarging the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth (structural formula (221)) was obtained.
- FIG. 88 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the toluene solution of 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth showed absorption peaks around 486 nm, 387 nm, and 366 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 534 nm (excitation wavelength: 470 nm).
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 3,5-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) aniline> 2.5 g (10 mmol) 3,5-dibromoaniline, 4.9 g (21 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butylphenylboronic acid, 0.27 g (0.89 mmol) tri-o-tolyl Phosphine was placed in a 500 mL three-neck flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. To this mixture was added 75 mL of toluene, 25 mL of ethanol, and 20 mL of 2M aqueous potassium carbonate solution.
- FIG. 89B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 89A is enlarged.
- FIG. 90 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. 89A is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 3,5-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) aniline was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) diphenylamine> 0.72 g (2.7 mmol) 1-bromo-3,5-di-tert-butylbenzene and 1.3 g (2.7 mmol) 3,5-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) ) Aniline and 0.50 g (5.2 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- FIGS. 91B is a chart in which the range of 5.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 92A is enlarged.
- FIG. 91 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. 92A is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) diphenylamine was obtained.
- Step 3 Synthesis of 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02> 0.80 g (1.9 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene and 1.3 g (1.9 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-bis (3 5-Di-tert-butylphenyl) diphenylamine, 0.36 g (3.7 mmol) sodium t-butoxide, and 0.18 g (0.44 mmol) SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. .
- Sublimation purification of 0.30 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 295 ° C. for 15 hours under the condition of a pressure of 3.8 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.25 g and a recovery rate of 83%.
- FIG. 93B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 93A is enlarged.
- FIG. 94 is a chart obtained by enlarging the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02 was obtained.
- FIG. 95 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the toluene solution of 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02 showed absorption peaks in the vicinity of 484 nm, 392 nm, and 343 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 529 nm (excitation wavelength: 465 nm).
- a method for synthesizing -di-tert-butylphenyl) -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth> 1.8 g (3.6 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2,6-diphenylanthracene, 2.8 g (7.2 mmol) bis (3,5-tert-butylphenyl) amine, 1.4 g ( 15 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- 0.61 g of the obtained yellow solid was purified by sublimation by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 280 ° C. for 15 hours under the condition of a pressure of 3.8 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.56 g and a recovery rate of 91%.
- FIG. 96B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 96A is enlarged.
- FIG. 97 is a chart obtained by enlarging the range of 0.5 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 98 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- an organic compound which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (264) of Embodiment 1 2-phenyl-N, N, N ′, N′-tetrakis [3,5-bis
- a method for synthesizing (4-cyclohexylphenyl) phenyl] -9,10-anthracenediamine (abbreviation: 2Ph-mmchPDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) aniline> 0.87 g (3.5 mmol) 3,5-dibromoaniline, 2.0 g (7.0 mmol) 4-cyclohexylphenylboronic acid pinacol ester, 0.28 g (0.92 mmol) tri-o-tolyl Phosphine was placed in a 200 mL three-neck flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. To this mixture was added 20 mL of toluene, 5 mL of ethanol, and 7 mL of 2M aqueous potassium carbonate solution.
- FIGS. 99B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 99A is enlarged.
- FIG. 100 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. 99A is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) aniline was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 1-chloro-3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) benzene> 1.4 g (5.2 mmol) of 1,3-dibromo-5-chlorobenzene, 3.0 g (10 mmol) of 4-cyclohexylphenylboronic acid pinacol ester, 0.28 g (0.92 mmol) of tri-o- Tolylphosphine was placed in a 200 mL three-neck flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. To this mixture was added 30 mL of toluene, 10 mL of ethanol, and 10 mL of 2M aqueous potassium carbonate solution.
- FIGS. 101B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 102 is a chart obtained by enlarging the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 1-chloro-3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) benzene was obtained.
- Step 3 Synthesis of bis [3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) phenyl] amine> 0.95 g (2.2 mmol) 1-chloro-3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) benzene and 0.95 g (2.3 mmol) 3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) aniline; 0.44 g (4.6 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide and 50 mg (0.14 mmol) of n-butyldiadamantylphosphine were placed in a 100 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- FIGS. 103B is a chart in which the range of 5.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 103A is enlarged.
- FIG. 104 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. 103A is enlarged. From this result, it was found that bis [3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) phenyl] amine was obtained.
- Step 4 Synthesis of 2Ph-mmchPDPhA2Anth> 0.35 g (0.85 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene, 1.4 g (1.8 mmol) bis [3,5-bis (4-cyclohexylphenyl) phenyl] amine; 34 g (3.5 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- FIGS. 105B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 106 is a chart in which the range of 0.5 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmchPDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 107 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmchPDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the toluene solution of 2Ph-mmchPDPhA2Anth showed absorption peaks near 467 nm, 393 nm, and 351 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 526 nm (excitation wavelength: 455 nm).
- an organic compound which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (257) of Embodiment 1, N, N ′-(2-phenylanthracene-9,10-diyl) -N, N A method for synthesizing '-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) -N, N'-bis (3,5-di-trimethylsilylphenyl) diamine (abbreviation: 2Ph-mmtBuTMSDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- the organic compound can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ', 5'-di-trimethylsilyldiphenylamine> 2.0 g (6.6 mmol) 3,5-bis (trimethylsilyl) bromobenzene, 1.6 g (7.8 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butylaniline, 1.5 g (16 mmol) sodium t-Butoxide was placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. 35 mL of toluene was added to the mixture, and the mixture was degassed under reduced pressure.
- the synthesis scheme of Step 1 is shown in (M-1) below.
- FIGS. 108B is a chart in which the range of 5.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 109 is a chart in which the range of 0.0 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. From this result, it was found that 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-di-trimethylsilyldiphenylamine was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 2Ph-mmtBuTMSDPhA2Anth> 1.3 g (3.1 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene and 2.8 g (6.5 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-di-trimethylsilyldiphenylamine Then, 1.2 g (12 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- Sublimation purification of 0.31 g of the obtained yellow solid was performed by a train sublimation method.
- the sublimation purification was performed by heating the yellow solid at 220 ° C. for 15 hours under the pressure of 3.6 Pa. After purification by sublimation, the target yellow solid was obtained in a yield of 0.27 g and a recovery rate of 87%.
- FIGS. 110 and 111 the measurement result by 1 H NMR of the yellow solid obtained in the above Step 2 is shown below.
- 1 H NMR charts are shown in FIGS. 110 and 111.
- FIG. 110B is a chart in which the range of 6.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG.
- FIG. 111 is a chart in which the range of 0.0 ppm to 2.0 ppm in FIG. 110 is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmtBuTMSDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 112 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmtBuTMSDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the light-emitting element 75 to the light-emitting element 98 and the comparative light-emitting element 99 to the comparative light-emitting element 103 are different from the manufacturing method of the light-emitting element 30 described above only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130. A manufacturing method similar to that of the light-emitting element 30 was used. Since details of the element structure are as shown in Tables 14 to 17, details of the manufacturing method are omitted.
- GD270 is a phosphorescent material containing Ir.
- 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group and has a structure in which a phenyl group is bonded to an anthracene skeleton that is a luminophore.
- 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group, and has a structure in which two phenyl groups are bonded to an anthracene skeleton that is a luminophore.
- 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group, and has a structure in which a trimethylsilyl group is bonded to an anthracene skeleton that is a luminophore.
- 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group, and has a cyclohexyl group and a tertiary butyl group as the protective groups. Further, it has a structure in which a phenyl group is bonded to an anthracene skeleton which is a luminophore.
- 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group, and has a cyclohexyl group as the protective group.
- 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02 is a fluorescent material having a protective group, and has a structure in which a biphenyl group having a tertiary butyl group is bonded to an amino group. Further, it has a structure in which a phenyl group is bonded to an anthracene skeleton which is a luminophore.
- TTPA is a fluorescent material having an anthracene skeleton and does not have a bulky substituent.
- the comparative light emitting element 103 is a phosphorescent light emitting element that emits light from the GD 270.
- FIG. 125 illustrates an electroluminescence spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 99 to the comparative light-emitting element 103 when current is supplied at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.). In each figure, the measurement results of the comparative light emitting element 103 are shown at the same time.
- the comparative light-emitting element 103 is a light-emitting element that does not have a fluorescent material, and is a phosphorescent light-emitting element in which light emission derived from GD270 is observed.
- the light-emitting elements 76 to 98 can be regarded as elements obtained by adding a fluorescent material having a protective group to the comparative light-emitting element 103.
- Table 18 and Table 19 show element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 75 to 98 and the comparative light-emitting elements 99 to 99 at around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the emission spectra of the light emitting elements 75 to 78 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 540 nm and a half width of about 69 nm.
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 79 to 82 show green light emission derived from 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth, whose peak wavelength is around 548 nm and whose half width is around 68 nm. It was.
- FIG. 116 shows green light emission derived from 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth, whose peak wavelength is around 548 nm and whose half width is around 68 nm. It was.
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 83 to 86 showed green light emission derived from 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 532 nm and a full width at half maximum of around 70 nm.
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 87 to 90 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 540 nm and a half width of about 68 nm.
- FIG. 120 the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 87 to 90 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 540 nm and a half width of about 68 nm.
- the light emission spectra of the light emitting elements 91 to 94 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 543 nm and a half width of around 65 nm.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 95 to 98 show green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02 having a peak wavelength of around 530 nm and a half width of around 65 nm. It was.
- FIG. 124 emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 95 to 98 show green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02 having a peak wavelength of around 530 nm and a half width of around 65 nm. It was.
- emission spectra of the comparative light-emitting elements 99 to 102 showed green light emission derived from TTPA having a peak wavelength of about 541 nm and a half-value width of about 68 nm. Light emission different from that of the comparative light emitting element 103 was observed from all the light emitting elements.
- each light-emitting element As described above, light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light-emitting element was obtained from the light-emitting elements 75 to 98. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex or the phosphorescent material.
- the light-emitting elements 75 to 98 emit light derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIGS. 113 to 124, Table 18, and Table 19, high light emission exceeding the external quantum efficiency of 10% is achieved. Showed efficiency. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission. Therefore, it was found that by using a guest material having a protecting group for the light-emitting layer, energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material and nonradiative deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed.
- FIG. 163 shows an EL (light emission) spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 103, 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth used for the light-emitting element 33, 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth used for the light-emitting elements 75 to 78, and 2 used for the light-emitting elements 79 to 82.
- the absorption spectrum in the toluene solution of 6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth is shown, respectively.
- 2tBu-mmtBuDPhA2Anth has a tertiary butyl group
- 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth has one phenyl group
- 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth has two phenyl groups.
- FIG. 163 shows that the rising of the absorption spectrum is shifted to the longer wavelength side as the number of phenyl groups bonded to the luminophore is increased. For this reason, the absorption spectrum of the energy acceptor having a large number of phenyl groups bonded to the luminophore has a larger overlap with the emission spectrum of GD270 which is an energy donor. Therefore, from formula (1), it can be said that the energy acceptor having a phenyl group in the luminophore is preferable because the energy transfer rate by the Förster mechanism becomes faster.
- the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum of the guest material used in this example overlaps with the emission spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 103. Therefore, the energy of GD270 functioning as an energy donor is efficiently transferred to each guest material by the Forster mechanism.
- FIGS. 113 to 124 show that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, a light-emitting color similar to the energy donor is efficiently obtained from the guest material.
- FIG. 126 shows the relationship between the guest material concentration and the external quantum efficiency in each guest material. 126, the light-emitting element 75 to the light-emitting element 98 of one embodiment of the present invention using a guest material having a protective group suppresses a decrease in efficiency due to an increase in concentration as compared to the comparative light-emitting element 99 to the comparative light-emitting element 102. You can see that.
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention suppresses energy transfer of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism even when the concentration of the guest material is high, and thus triplets Since non-radiative deactivation of excitation energy can be suppressed, a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be obtained.
- the concentration of the guest material can be increased, and a light-emitting element with favorable emission efficiency and reliability can be obtained.
- FIG. 133 shows the results of constant current drive tests at 2.0 mA for the comparative light-emitting elements 99 to 102.
- the comparative light-emitting element 103 exhibits phosphorescence having a long emission lifetime derived from light emission of the phosphorescent material GD270. From these facts, it can be seen that by adding a fluorescent material as a guest material to the light emitting layer, the ratio of the fast fluorescent component derived from the fluorescent material is increased.
- the light-emitting element with higher guest material concentration is more reliable. Improved. That is, it can be seen that there is a correlation between the emission lifetime and the excitation lifetime. This suggests that the energy transfer by the Forster mechanism between the energy donor and the acceptor is promoted by increasing the guest material concentration. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, energy transfer due to the Dexter mechanism between the energy donor and the acceptor can be suppressed; thus, the light-emitting layer can be doped with a fluorescent material at a high concentration.
- a light-emitting element having efficiency can be realized, and further, the energy transfer speed by the Forster mechanism can be increased, so that reliability can be improved.
- the comparative light-emitting element 99 to the comparative light-emitting element 102 have the same tendency in reliability and light emission lifetime, but the external quantum efficiency is significantly reduced. That is, it is difficult for a light emitting device using TTPA, which is a comparative material, to achieve both high luminous efficiency and high reliability.
- the light-emitting elements 104 to 127 are different from the above-described light-emitting element 1 only in the fluorescent material (guest material) used for the light-emitting layer 130, and the other manufacturing steps are the same as those of the light-emitting element 1. Since details of the element structure are as shown in Tables 20 to 23, details of the manufacturing method are omitted.
- FIG. 137 to FIG. 148 show the external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 104 to 127 and the comparative light-emitting element 29 and electroluminescence spectra obtained when a current is passed at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 , respectively. Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.).
- Table 24 and Table 25 show element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 104 to 127 and the comparative light-emitting element 29 around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 104 to 107 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 539 nm and a half-width of around 62 nm.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 108 to 111 show green light emission derived from 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 548 nm and a half-value width of around 64 nm. It was.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 112 to 115 showed green light emission derived from 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 533 nm and a half-width of around 67 nm.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 116 to 119 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 539 nm and a half width of around 64 nm.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 120 to 123 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmchDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 542 nm and a half-value width of around 62 nm.
- emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 124 to 127 show green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth-02 having a peak wavelength of around 530 nm and a full width at half maximum of around 65 nm. It was.
- Light emission different from the light emission exhibited by the comparative light-emitting element 29 was obtained from all the light-emitting elements. Note that the comparative light-emitting element 29 emits light derived from an exciplex composed of 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 .
- each light-emitting element As described above, light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light-emitting element was obtained from the light-emitting elements 104 to 127. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex or the phosphorescent material.
- the light-emitting elements 104 to 127 show light emission derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIGS. 137 to 148, Table 24, and Table 25, the external quantum efficiency exceeding 18% is very high. High luminous efficiency was shown. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission. Therefore, it was found that by using a guest material having a protecting group for the light-emitting layer, energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material and nonradiative deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed.
- the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum of the guest material used in this example and the emission spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 29 overlap. Therefore, the excitation energy of the exciplex composed of Ir (ppz) 3 and 4,6mCzP2Pm functioning as an energy donor is efficiently transferred to each guest material by the Förster mechanism.
- FIG. 149 shows the relationship between the guest material concentration and the external quantum efficiency in each guest material.
- FIG. 149 shows that in the light-emitting elements 104 to 127 of one embodiment of the present invention using a guest material having a protective group, reduction in efficiency due to increase in concentration is suppressed. Moreover, it turns out that luminous efficiency is improving by adding a guest material depending on density
- the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention suppresses triplet excitation energy transfer from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism even when the concentration of the guest material is high. Since non-radiative deactivation of excitation energy can be suppressed, a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be obtained.
- the comparative light emitting element 29 emits light of an exciplex of 4,6mCzP2Pm and Ir (ppz) 3 which are host materials, and emits light having an early fluorescent component of 1 ⁇ s or less and a delayed fluorescent component of about 3 ⁇ s. It was. From these facts, it can be seen that by adding a fluorescent material as a guest material to the light emitting layer, the ratio of the fast fluorescent component derived from the fluorescent material is increased.
- the light-emitting elements 104 to 119 and the light-emitting elements 124 to 127 using the guest material having a protective group which is one embodiment of the present invention are light-emitting elements having a high concentration of a fluorescent material. Even if it is, it shows high external quantum efficiency. That is, it can be seen that the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention shows high light emission efficiency even when the ratio of light emission derived from the fluorescent material is increased. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, energy transfer of the triplet excitation energy and deactivation of the triplet excitation energy by the Dexter mechanism from the host material to the guest material can be suppressed. This suggests that the energy transfer efficiency of the excitation energy by the Forster mechanism can be improved.
- an organic compound N, N ′-(2-phenylanthracene-9,10-diyl) -N, N which is one embodiment of the present invention represented by the structural formula (261) of Embodiment 1 is used.
- a method for synthesizing '-bis (3,5-di-tert-butylphenyl) -N, N'-bis (3,5-dihexylphenyl) diamine (abbreviation: 2Ph-mmnhtBuDPhA2Anth) will be described.
- This compound is a guest material having a protective group that can be preferably used in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- Step 1 Synthesis of 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-dihexyldiphenylamine> 2.0 g (6.1 mmol) 1-bromo-3,5-dihexylbenzene, 1.3 g (6.3 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butylaniline and 1.2 g (12 mmol) sodium t-Butoxide was placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen. 35 mL of toluene was added to the mixture, and the mixture was degassed under reduced pressure.
- the synthesis scheme of Step 1 is shown in (N-1) below.
- FIGS. 163 and 164 are shown in FIGS. 163 and 164.
- FIG. 163B is a chart in which the range of 5.5 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 163A is enlarged.
- FIG. 164 is a chart in which the range of 0.0 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. 163 (A) is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-dihexyldiphenylamine was obtained.
- Step 2 Synthesis of 2Ph-mmnhtBuDPhA2Anth> 1.2 g (2.9 mmol) 9,10-dibromo-2-phenylanthracene and 2.6 g (5.8 mmol) 3,5-di-tert-butyl-3 ′, 5′-dihexyldiphenylamine; 1.1 g (11 mmol) of sodium t-butoxide and 60 mg (0.15 mmol) of SPhos were placed in a 200 mL three-necked flask, and the atmosphere in the flask was replaced with nitrogen.
- FIGS. 166 and 167 are shown below.
- FIGS. 166 and 167 are shown in FIGS. 166 and 167.
- FIG. 166 (B) is a chart in which the range of 6.0 ppm to 9.0 ppm in FIG. 166 (A) is enlarged.
- FIG. 167 is a chart in which the range of 0.0 ppm to 3.0 ppm in FIG. 166 (A) is enlarged. From this result, it was found that 2Ph-mmnhtBuDPhA2Anth was obtained.
- FIG. 168 shows the results of measuring the absorption spectrum and emission spectrum of a toluene solution of 2Ph-mmnhtBuDPhA2Anth.
- the measuring method is the same as the method shown in Example 1.
- the toluene solution of 2Ph-mmtBuTMSDPhA2Anth showed absorption peaks in the vicinity of 485 nm, 388 nm, and 365 nm, and the emission wavelength peak was 533 nm (excitation wavelength: 475 nm).
- the light-emitting element 128 to the light-emitting element 130 and the comparative light-emitting element 131 are different from the light-emitting element 79 described above only in the host material of the light-emitting layer 130, the concentration of the guest material, and the material of the electron transport layer 118 (1). Is a manufacturing method similar to that of the light-emitting element 79.
- GD270 is a phosphorescent material containing Ir.
- 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group. Note that the value of z 1 varies depending on each light emitting element, and the value of z 1 in each light emitting element is a value shown in Table 27.
- a weight ratio of 4,8mDBTP2Bfpm, PCCP, and GD270 4,8mDBTP2Bfpm: PCCP: GD270
- the film was co-deposited to a thickness of 40 nm.
- the comparative light emitting element 131 is a phosphorescent light emitting element in which GD270 exhibits phosphorescence.
- the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 can be regarded as elements in which a fluorescent material having a protective group is added to the light-emitting layer 130 of the comparative light-emitting element 131.
- 4,8mDBTP2Bfpm and PCCP are combinations that form an exciplex.
- 4,8mDBTP2Bfpm was deposited as an electron transport layer 118 (1) on the light-emitting layer 130 so as to have a thickness of 20 nm.
- FIG. 169 shows external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 and the comparative light-emitting element 131.
- FIG. 170 shows an electroluminescence spectrum when current is supplied to the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 and the comparative light-emitting element 131 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.). In addition, the measurement results of the comparative light emitting element 131 are simultaneously shown in the respective drawings.
- Table 28 shows element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 and the comparative light-emitting element 131 around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 showed green light emission derived from 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of about 548 nm and a half width of about 68 nm. Therefore, light emission different from that of the comparative light-emitting element 131 was observed from all the light-emitting elements. Note that as shown in FIG. 170, the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 131 showed green emission derived from GD270 having a peak wavelength of 523 nm and a half-value width of around 75 nm.
- each light-emitting element As described above, light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light-emitting element was obtained from the light-emitting elements 128 to 130. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex or the phosphorescent material.
- the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 showed light emission derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIG. 169 and Table 28, the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 showed high light emission efficiency exceeding the external quantum efficiency of 18%. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission. Therefore, it was found that by using a guest material having a protecting group for the light-emitting layer, energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material and nonradiative deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed.
- the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum of the guest material used in this example overlaps with the emission spectrum of the comparative light emitting element 103. Therefore, the energy of GD270 functioning as an energy donor is efficiently transferred to each guest material by the Forster mechanism.
- FIG. 171 shows the relationship between the guest material concentration and the external quantum efficiency in each guest material.
- FIG. 171 shows that in the light-emitting element 128 to the light-emitting element 130 of one embodiment of the present invention using a guest material having a protective group, a decrease in efficiency accompanying an increase in concentration is extremely small. Therefore, the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention suppresses triplet excitation energy transfer from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism even when the concentration of the guest material is high, and does not emit triplet excitation energy. Since deactivation can be suppressed, a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be obtained.
- an organic compound having a benzofuropyrimidine skeleton and / or a dibenzothiophene skeleton such as 4,8mDBTP2Bfpm, can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 172 shows that reliability is improved when the guest material concentration is increased. This suggests that the excitation energy in the light emitting layer can be efficiently converted into the light emission of the guest material by increasing the guest material concentration. That is, it is suggested that by increasing the guest material concentration, the energy transfer rate of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material by the Forster mechanism can be increased. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, the concentration of the guest material can be increased, and a light-emitting element with favorable emission efficiency and reliability can be obtained.
- the light-emitting element 82 and the light-emitting element 130 differ only in the host material having the electron-transport property of the light-emitting layer and the material used for the electron-transport layer 118 (1).
- the 10% luminance reduction time (LT90) of the light-emitting element 82 and the light-emitting element 130 was about 330 hours and 190 hours, respectively, both having very good reliability, but the light-emitting element 130 was better. Therefore, the organic compound having a benzofuropyrimidine skeleton and / or a dibenzothiophene skeleton used for the light-emitting element 130 can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- the light-emitting element 132 to the light-emitting element 135 and the comparative light-emitting element 136 are different from the light-emitting element 79 described above only in the materials of the light-emitting layer 130 and the hole-transporting layer 112, and other steps are the same as those for the light-emitting element 79. It was.
- mPCCzPTzn-02, PCBBiF, and 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth have a weight ratio (mPCCzPTzn-02: PCBiF: 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth) of 0.8: 0.2: w 1 And co-evaporated to a thickness of 40 nm.
- mPCCzPTzn-02 and PCBBiF are a combination that forms an exciplex. As described above, the exciplex can convert triplet excitation energy into singlet excitation energy. Therefore, the exciplex functions as an energy donor in the light-emitting layer 130.
- 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth is a fluorescent material having a protective group and functions as an energy donor. Note that the value of w 1 varies depending on each light emitting element, and the value of w 1 in each light emitting element is a value shown in Table 30.
- MCzFLP was deposited as a hole transport layer 112 on the hole injection layer 111 of the comparative light emitting device 136 so as to have a thickness of 20 nm.
- mPCCzPTzn-02 and PCBBiF have a weight ratio (mPCCzPTzn-02: PCBBiF) of 0.8: 0.2 and a thickness of 40 nm. Co-deposited as follows. From the comparative light emitting element 131, light emission from an exciplex formed by mPCCzPTzn-02 and PCBBiF is observed as described later.
- the light-emitting elements 132 to 135 can be regarded as elements in which 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth is added as a guest material to the light-emitting layer of the comparative light-emitting element 136.
- FIG. 173 shows external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 132 to 135 and the comparative light-emitting element 136.
- FIG. 174 shows an electroluminescence spectrum when current is passed through the light-emitting elements 128 to 130 and the comparative light-emitting element 136 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.). In addition, each figure shows the measurement results of the comparative light emitting element 136 at the same time.
- Table 31 shows element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 132 to 135 and the comparative light-emitting element 136 around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the emission spectra of the light-emitting elements 132 to 135 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of around 534 nm and a half-value width of around 67 nm. Therefore, light emission different from that of the comparative light-emitting element 136 was observed from all the light-emitting elements.
- the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 136 is green light emission derived from an exciplex formed by mPCCzPTzn-02 and PCBBiF having a peak wavelength of 537 nm and a half-width of about 83 nm. showed that.
- each light-emitting element As described above, light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light-emitting element was obtained from the light-emitting elements 132 to 135. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex.
- the light-emitting elements 132 to 135 show light emission derived from the fluorescent material, as shown in FIG. 173 and Table 31, the light-emitting elements having a high concentration of the fluorescent material exceed 9%. High luminous efficiency was shown. This is a value exceeding the maximum value of the external quantum efficiency of the fluorescent light emitting device. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission.
- FIG. 175 shows a relationship between an EL (light emission) spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 136 and an absorption spectrum and an emission spectrum in a toluene solution of 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth used for the light-emitting elements 132 to 135.
- FIG. 175 shows that when the absorption spectra of the guest materials are compared, the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum and the emission spectrum overlap. Therefore, it can be seen that energy transfer is caused by the Forster mechanism from GD270 to 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth.
- FIG. 176 shows the relationship between the guest material concentration and the external quantum efficiency.
- FIG. 176 shows that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, the decrease in efficiency accompanying increase in concentration is small. Therefore, the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention suppresses triplet excitation energy transfer from the host material to the guest material by the Dexter mechanism even when the concentration of the guest material is high, and does not emit triplet excitation energy. Since deactivation can be suppressed, a light-emitting element with high emission efficiency can be obtained. It was also found that an exciplex can be preferably used for the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention.
- FIG. 177 shows that reliability is improved when the guest material concentration is increased. This suggests that the excitation energy in the light emitting layer can be efficiently converted into the light emission of the guest material by increasing the guest material concentration. That is, it is suggested that by increasing the guest material concentration, the energy transfer rate of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material by the Forster mechanism can be increased. Therefore, in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, the concentration of the guest material can be increased, and a light-emitting element with favorable emission efficiency and reliability can be obtained.
- the light-emitting elements 137 to 141 and the comparative light-emitting element 142 are different from the light-emitting element 132 described above only in the material of the light-emitting layer 130 and the electron transport layer 118 (1), and other steps are similar to those of the light-emitting element 132. A production method was adopted.
- Comparative Light-Emitting Element 142 As the light emitting layer 130 on the hole transport layer 112, 4mCzBPBfpm and PCBBiF are co-evaporated so that the weight ratio (4mCzBPBfpm: PCBBiF) is 0.8: 0.2 and the thickness is 40 nm. did. As will be described later, light emission from an exciplex formed by 4mCzBPBfpm and PCBBiF is observed from the comparative light emitting element 131. Further, the light-emitting elements 137 to 141 can be regarded as elements in which each guest material is added to the light-emitting layer of the comparative light-emitting element 142.
- FIG. 178 shows external quantum efficiency-luminance characteristics of the light-emitting elements 137 to 141 and the comparative light-emitting element 142.
- FIG. 179 shows an electroluminescence spectrum when current is supplied to the light-emitting elements 137 to 141 and the comparative light-emitting element 142 at a current density of 2.5 mA / cm 2 . Note that each light-emitting element was measured at room temperature (atmosphere kept at 23 ° C.). In addition, the measurement results of the comparative light-emitting element 142 are simultaneously shown in the respective drawings.
- Table 34 shows element characteristics of the light-emitting elements 137 to 141 and the comparative light-emitting element 142 around 1000 cd / m 2 .
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 137 showed green light emission derived from 2TMS-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 532 nm and a half width of 64 nm.
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 138 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 538 nm and a half width of 62 nm.
- the light emission spectrum of the light emitting element 139 showed green light emission derived from 2Ph-mmchtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 539 nm and a half width of 62 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the light-emitting element 140 showed green light emission derived from 2,6Ph-mmtBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 548 nm and a half width of 60 nm.
- the emission spectrum of the light-emitting element 141 showed green light emission derived from 2tBu-ptBuDPhA2Anth having a peak wavelength of 532 nm and a half width of 61 nm. Therefore, light emission different from that of the comparative light-emitting element 142 was observed from all the light-emitting elements. Note that as shown in FIG.
- the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 142 shows green light emission derived from an exciplex formed by 4mCzBPBfpm having a peak wavelength of 534 nm and a half width of about 78 nm and PCBBiF. It was.
- each light-emitting element As described above, light emission derived from the fluorescent material in each light-emitting element was obtained from the light-emitting elements 137 to 141. Therefore, it can be seen that the excitation energy of each light-emitting element moves to the fluorescent material that is the guest material of each light-emitting element. This suggests that both singlet excitation energy and triplet excitation energy generated in the light-emitting layer are transferred to the fluorescent material through the exciplex.
- the light-emitting elements 137 to 141 exhibited high light emission efficiency exceeding 9% as shown in FIG. 178 and Table 34 despite the light emission derived from the fluorescent material. This is a value exceeding the maximum value of the external quantum efficiency of the fluorescent light emitting device. From these results, it can be said that in the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention, non-radiative deactivation of triplet excitons is suppressed and light is efficiently converted into light emission. Therefore, it was found that by using a guest material having a protecting group for the light-emitting layer, energy transfer by the Dexter mechanism of triplet excitation energy from the host material to the guest material and nonradiative deactivation of triplet excitation energy can be suppressed. Moreover, it turned out that an exciplex can also be used suitably as this host material.
- the absorption band on the longest wavelength side of the absorption spectrum of the guest material used in this example overlaps with the emission spectrum of the comparative light-emitting element 142. Therefore, the energy of the exciplex functioning as an energy donor is efficiently transferred to each guest material by the Forster mechanism.
- FIG. 180 indicates that the light-emitting element of one embodiment of the present invention to which the guest material is added has higher reliability than the comparative light-emitting element 141. This suggests that the excitation energy in the light emitting layer can be efficiently converted into the light emission of the guest material by adding a fluorescent material having a protecting group as the guest material.
Landscapes
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Materials Engineering (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Spectroscopy & Molecular Physics (AREA)
- Optics & Photonics (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Electroluminescent Light Sources (AREA)
- Nitrogen Condensed Heterocyclic Rings (AREA)
- Organic Low-Molecular-Weight Compounds And Preparation Thereof (AREA)
- Optical Filters (AREA)
Abstract
Description
本実施の形態では、本発明の一態様の発光素子について、図1乃至図6を用いて以下説明する。
まず、本発明の一態様の発光素子の構成について、図1を用いて、以下説明する。
次に、発光層130の発光機構について、以下説明を行う。
図1(C)は、本発明の一態様の発光素子中の発光層におけるエネルギー準位の相関の一例である。本構成例では化合物131にTADF材料を用いた場合について示している。
・Host(131):化合物131
・Guest(132):化合物132
・TC1:化合物131のT1準位
・SC1:化合物131のS1準位
・SG:化合物132のS1準位
・TG:化合物132のT1準位
図2(A)に一般的な蛍光性材料である、保護基を有さない蛍光性材料をゲスト材料としてホスト材料に分散させた場合と、図2(B)本発明の一態様の発光素子に用いる、保護基を有する蛍光性材料をゲスト材料としてホスト材料に分散させた場合の概念図を示す。ホスト材料はエネルギードナー、ゲスト材料はエネルギーアクセプターと読み替えても構わない。ここで、保護基は、発光団とホスト材料との距離を遠ざける機能を有する。図2(A)において、ゲスト材料301は発光団310を有する。ゲスト材料301はエネルギーアクセプターとしての機能を有する。一方、図2(B)において、ゲスト材料302は発光団310と保護基320を有する。また、図2(A)及び(B)においてゲスト材料301及びゲスト材料302はホスト材料330に囲まれている。図2(A)では発光団とホスト材料の距離が近いため、ホスト材料330からゲスト材料301へのエネルギー移動として、フェルスター機構によるエネルギー移動(図2(A)及び(B)中、ルートA4)とデクスター機構によるエネルギー移動(図2(A)及び(B)中、ルートA5)の両方が生じうる。デクスター機構によるホスト材料からゲスト材料への三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動が生じゲスト材料の三重項励起状態が生成すると、ゲスト材料が蛍光性材料である場合、三重項励起エネルギーが無放射失活するため、発光効率低下の一因となる。
ここで下記構造式(102)で示される、本発明の一態様の発光素子に用いることができる蛍光性材料である、N,N’−[(2−tert−ブチルアントラセン)−9,10−ジイル]−N,N’−ビス(3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミン(略称:2tBu−mmtBuDPhA2Anth)の構造を示す。2tBu−mmtBuDPhA2Anthにおいて、アントラセン環が発光団であり、ターシャリーブチル(tBu)基が保護基として作用する。
図4(C)は、本発明の一態様の発光素子150の発光層130におけるエネルギー準位の相関の一例である。図4(A)に示す発光層130は、化合物131と、化合物132と、さらに化合物133と、を有する。本発明の一態様において、化合物132は、蛍光性材料であると好ましい。また、本構成例では、化合物131と化合物133は励起錯体を形成する組合せである。
・Comp(131):化合物131
・Comp(133):化合物133
・Guest(132):化合物132
・SC1:化合物131のS1準位
・TC1:化合物131のT1準位
・SC3:化合物133のS1準位
・TC3:化合物133のS1準位
・TG:化合物132のT1準位
・SE:励起錯体のS1準位
・TE:励起錯体のT1準位
本構成例では、上述のExEFを利用した発光素子の化合物133として、燐光性材料を用いた場合について説明する。すなわち、励起錯体を形成する化合物の一方に燐光性材料を用いた場合について説明する。
本構成例では上述のExEFを利用した発光素子の化合物133として、TADF性を有する材料を用いた場合について図4(D)を用いて説明する。
図5(A)は発光層130に4種の材料を用いた場合について示している。図5(A)において発光層130は化合物131、化合物132、化合物133、化合物134と、を有する。本発明の一態様において、化合物133は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換できる機能を有する。本構成例では化合物133が燐光性材料である場合について説明する。化合物132は、蛍光発光を呈するゲスト材料である。また、化合物131は化合物134と励起錯体を形成する有機化合物である。
・SC4:化合物134のS1準位
・TC4:化合物134のT1準位
本構成例では、上述の発光層の構成例5で説明した化合物134にTADF性を有する材料を用いた場合について説明する。
図6(B)は、本発明の一態様の発光素子150の発光層130におけるエネルギー準位の相関の一例である。図6(A)に示す発光層130は、化合物131と、化合物132と、さらに化合物133と、を有する。本発明の一態様において、化合物132は、保護基を有する蛍光性材料である。また、化合物133は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する。本構成例では化合物133が燐光性材料である場合について説明する。
・Comp(131):化合物131
・Comp(133):化合物133
・Guest(132):化合物132
・SC1:化合物131のS1準位
・TC1:化合物131のT1準位
・TC3:化合物133のT1準位
・TG:化合物132のT1準位
・SG:化合物132のS1準位
図6(C)は、本発明の一態様の発光素子150の発光層130におけるエネルギー準位の相関の一例である。図6(C)に示す発光層130は、化合物131と、化合物132と、さらに化合物133と、を有する。本発明の一態様において、化合物132は、保護基を有する蛍光性材料である。また、化合物133は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換できる機能を有する。本構成例では化合物133がTADF性を有する化合物である場合について説明する。
・SC3:化合物133のS1準位
ここで、フェルスター機構と、デクスター機構について説明する。ここでは、励起状態である第1の材料から基底状態である第2の材料への励起エネルギーの供与に関し、第1の材料と第2の材料との分子間のエネルギー移動過程について説明するが、どちらか一方が励起錯体の場合も同様である。
フェルスター機構では、エネルギー移動に、分子間の直接的接触を必要とせず、第1の材料及び第2の材料の双極子振動の共鳴現象を通じてエネルギー移動が起こる。双極子振動の共鳴現象によって第1の材料が第2の材料にエネルギーを受け渡し、励起状態の第1の材料が基底状態になり、基底状態の第2の材料が励起状態になる。なお、フェルスター機構の速度定数kh*→gを数式(1)に示す。
デクスター機構では、第1の材料と第2の材料が軌道の重なりを生じる接触有効距離に近づき、励起状態の第1の材料の電子と、基底状態の第2の材料との電子の交換を通じてエネルギー移動が起こる。なお、デクスター機構の速度定数kh*→gを数式(2)に示す。
まず、フェルスター機構によるエネルギー移動を考える。数式(3)に数式(1)を代入することでτを消去することができる。したがって、フェルスター機構の場合、エネルギー移動効率φETは、第1の材料の励起状態の寿命τに依存しない。また、エネルギー移動効率φETは、発光量子収率φが高い方が良いと言える。
次に、本発明の一態様に係わる発光素子の構成要素の詳細について、以下説明を行う。
発光層130に用いることができる材料について、それぞれ以下に説明する。本発明の一態様の発光素子の発光層には、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有するエネルギーアクセプターと、発光団及び保護基を有するエネルギードナーを用いる。三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する材料としては、TADF性材料、励起錯体及び燐光性材料等が挙げられる。
(LA)2(SA)n−1MnX3n+1:(g2)
(PA)(SA)n−1MnX3n+1:(g3)
電極101及び電極102は、発光層130へ正孔と電子を注入する機能を有する。電極101及び電極102は、金属、合金、導電性化合物、およびこれらの混合物や積層体などを用いて形成することができる。金属としてはアルミニウム(Al)が典型例であり、その他、銀(Ag)、タングステン、クロム、モリブデン、銅、チタンなどの遷移金属、リチウム(Li)やセシウムなどのアルカリ金属、カルシウム、マグネシウム(Mg)などの第2族金属を用いることができる。遷移金属としてイッテルビウム(Yb)などの希土類金属を用いても良い。合金としては、上記金属を含む合金を使用することができ、例えばMgAg、AlLiなどが挙げられる。導電性化合物としては、例えば、インジウム錫酸化物(Indium Tin Oxide、以下ITO)、珪素または酸化珪素を含むインジウム錫酸化物(略称:ITSO)、インジウム亜鉛酸化物(Indium Zinc Oxide)、タングステン及び亜鉛を含有したインジウム酸化物などの金属酸化物が挙げられる。導電性化合物としてグラフェンなどの無機炭素系材料を用いても良い。上述したように、これらの材料の複数を積層することによって電極101及び電極102の一方または双方を形成しても良い。
正孔注入層111は、一対の電極の一方(電極101または電極102)からのホール注入障壁を低減することでホール注入を促進する機能を有し、例えば遷移金属酸化物、フタロシアニン誘導体、あるいは芳香族アミンなどによって形成される。遷移金属酸化物としては、モリブデン酸化物やバナジウム酸化物、ルテニウム酸化物、タングステン酸化物、マンガン酸化物などが挙げられる。フタロシアニン誘導体としては、フタロシアニンや金属フタロシアニンなどが挙げられる。芳香族アミンとしてはベンジジン誘導体やフェニレンジアミン誘導体などが挙げられる。ポリチオフェンやポリアニリンなどの高分子化合物を用いることもでき、例えば自己ドープされたポリチオフェンであるポリ(エチレンジオキシチオフェン)/ポリ(スチレンスルホン酸)などがその代表例である。
正孔輸送層112は正孔輸送性材料を含む層であり、正孔注入層111の材料として例示した材料を使用することができる。正孔輸送層112は正孔注入層111に注入された正孔を発光層130へ輸送する機能を有するため、正孔注入層111のHOMO準位と同じ、あるいは近いHOMO準位を有することが好ましい。
電子輸送層118は、電子注入層119を経て一対の電極の他方(電極101または電極102)から注入された電子を発光層130へ輸送する機能を有する。電子輸送性材料としては、正孔よりも電子の輸送性の高い材料を用いることができ、1×10−6cm2/Vs以上の電子移動度を有する材料であることが好ましい。電子を受け取りやすい化合物(電子輸送性を有する材料)としては、含窒素複素芳香族化合物のようなπ電子不足型複素芳香族や金属錯体などを用いることができる。具体的には、発光層130に用いることができる電子輸送性材料として挙げたキノリン配位子、ベンゾキノリン配位子、オキサゾール配位子、あるいはチアゾール配位子を有する金属錯体が挙げられる。また、オキサジアゾール誘導体、トリアゾール誘導体、フェナントロリン誘導体、ピリジン誘導体、ビピリジン誘導体、ピリミジン誘導体などが挙げられる。また、1×10−6cm2/Vs以上の電子移動度を有する物質であることが好ましい。なお、正孔よりも電子の輸送性の高い物質であれば、上記以外の物質を電子輸送層として用いても構わない。また、電子輸送層118は、単層だけでなく、上記物質からなる層が二層以上積層してもよい。
電子注入層119は電極102からの電子注入障壁を低減することで電子注入を促進する機能を有し、例えば第1族金属、第2族金属、あるいはこれらの酸化物、ハロゲン化物、炭酸塩などを用いることができる。また、先に示す電子輸送性材料と、これに対して電子供与性を示す材料の複合材料を用いることもできる。電子供与性を示す材料としては、第1族金属、第2族金属、あるいはこれらの酸化物などを挙げることができる。具体的には、フッ化リチウム(LiF)、フッ化ナトリウム(NaF)、フッ化セシウム(CsF)、フッ化カルシウム(CaF2)、リチウム酸化物(LiOx)等のようなアルカリ金属、アルカリ土類金属、またはそれらの化合物を用いることができる。また、フッ化エルビウム(ErF3)のような希土類金属化合物を用いることができる。また、電子注入層119にエレクトライドを用いてもよい。該エレクトライドとしては、例えば、カルシウムとアルミニウムの混合酸化物に電子を高濃度添加した物質等が挙げられる。また、電子注入層119に、電子輸送層118で用いることが出来る物質を用いても良い。
また、本発明の一態様に係る発光素子は、ガラス、プラスチックなどからなる基板上に作製すればよい。基板上に作製する順番としては、電極101側から順に積層しても、電極102側から順に積層しても良い。
本実施の形態では、本発明の一態様の発光素子に好適に用いることのできる有機化合物の合成方法の一例について、一般式(G1)及び(G2)で表される有機化合物を例に説明する。
上記一般式(G1)で表される有機化合物は、種々の反応を適用した合成方法により合成することができる。例えば、下記に示す合成スキーム(S−1)および(S−2)により合成することができる。化合物1と、アリールアミン(化合物2)と、アリールアミン(化合物3)とをカップリングすることにより、ジアミン化合物(化合物4)を得る。
一般式(G2)で表される本発明の一態様の有機化合物は、あらゆる有機反応を利用することで合成することができる。例として、二種の方法を下記に示す。
本実施の形態においては、実施の形態1に示す発光素子の構成と異なる構成の発光素子について、図7を用いて、以下説明を行う。なお、図7において、図1(A)に示す符号と同様の機能を有する箇所には、同様のハッチパターンとし、符号を省略する場合がある。また、同様の機能を有する箇所には、同様の符号を付し、その詳細な説明は省略する場合がある。
図7は、発光素子250の断面模式図である。
本実施の形態では実施の形態1及び実施の形態3で説明した発光素子を用いた発光装置について、図8(A)及び図8(B)を用いて説明する。
図9には発光装置の一例として、白色発光を呈する発光素子を形成し、着色層(カラーフィルタ)を形成した発光装置の例を示す。
トップエミッション型の発光装置の断面図を図10(A)及び図10(B)に示す。この場合、基板1001は光を通さない基板を用いることができる。TFTと発光素子の陽極とを接続する接続電極を作製するまでは、ボトムエミッション型の発光装置と同様に形成する。その後、第3の層間絶縁膜1037を電極1022を覆って形成する。この絶縁膜は平坦化の役割を担っていても良い。第3の層間絶縁膜1037は第2の層間絶縁膜1021と同様の材料の他、他の様々な材料を用いて形成することができる。
本実施の形態では、本発明の一態様の電子機器及び表示装置について説明する。
本実施の形態では、本発明の一態様の発光素子を様々な照明装置に適用する一例について、図14を用いて説明する。本発明の一態様である発光素子を用いることで、発光効率が良好な、信頼性の高い照明装置を作製できる。
5.4g(20mmol)の1−ブロモ−3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルベンゼンと、5.0g(24mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルアニリンと4.7g(49mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に100mLのトルエンを加え、得られた混合物を減圧脱気した。この混合物に1.3mL(1.5mmol)のトリ−tert−ブチルホスフィン(10w%ヘキサン溶液)と0.17g(0.3mmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加えた後、窒素気流下、120℃で6時間攪拌した。
0.95g(2.5mmol)の2−tert−ブチルアントラセンと、2.0g(5.1mmol)のビス(3,5−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミンと、1.0g(10mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に30mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、170℃で5時間攪拌した。
5.6g(24mmol)の1,4−シクロヘキサンジオン−2,5−ジカルボン酸ジメチルと、10g(48mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルアニリンを、還流管を付けた200mL三口フラスコに入れ、この混合物を170℃で2時間撹拌した。得られた赤橙色固体にメタノールを加えてスラリー化し、混合物を吸引ろ過により回収した。得られた固体をヘキサンとメタノールにて洗浄し乾燥させたところ、目的物の赤橙色固体を12g、収率82%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを以下(E−1)に示す。
ステップ1で得られた12g(20mmol)の1,4−シクロヘキサジエン−1,4−ジカルボン酸,2,5−ビス{(3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミノ}−ジメチルエステルと,150mLのトルエンとを、還流管を付けた300mL三口フラスコに入れた。この混合物に空気をバブリングしながら15時間還流した。撹拌後、析出した固体を吸引ろ過で回収し、得られた固体をヘキサンとメタノールを用いて洗浄したところ、目的物の赤色固体を7.3g得た。得られたろ液を濃縮しさらに固体を得た。この固体をヘキサンとメタノールを用いて洗浄し吸引ろ過により回収したところ、目的物の赤色固体を3.1g得た。よって、目的化合物を計10.4g、収率85%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを以下(E−2)に示す。
ステップ2で得られた4.0g(6.7mmol)の1,4−ベンゼンジカルボン酸,2,5−ビス{(3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミノ}−ジメチルエステルと、3.9g(14.6mmol)の1−ブロモ−3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルベンゼンと、0.46g(7.3mmol)の銅と、50mgのヨウ化銅(0.26mmol)と、1.0g(7.3mmol)の炭酸カリウムと、10mLのキシレンとを、還流管を付けた200mL三口フラスコに入れ、混合物の減圧脱気をした後、系内を窒素置換した。この混合物を20時間還流した。得られた混合物に、0.46g(7.3mmol)の銅と、50mgのヨウ化銅(0.26mmol)を加えて更に16時間還流した。得られた混合物にジクロロメタンを加えてスラリー化した。吸引ろ過にて固体を除去し、得られたろ液を濃縮した。得られた固体をヘキサンとエタノールで洗浄した。洗浄した固体を、ヘキサン/トルエンを用いて再結晶したところ、目的化合物の黄色固体を4.4g、収率72%で得た。ステップ3の合成スキームを以下(E−3)に示す。
ステップ3で得られた4.4g(4.8mmol)の1,4−ベンゼンジカルボン酸,2,5−ビス[N,N’−ビス(3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミノ]−ジメチルエステルと、20mLのメタンスルホン酸を、還流管を付けた100mL三口フラスコに入れ、この混合物を160℃で7時間撹拌した。この混合物を常温まで冷ましてから、300mLの氷水へゆっくり注いだ後常温になるまで放置した。この混合物を自然ろ過し、得られた固体を水と飽和炭酸水素ナトリウム水溶液で洗浄した。この固体をトルエンに溶かし、得られたトルエン溶液を水と飽和食塩水で洗浄し、硫酸マグネシウムで乾燥した。この混合物をセライト(和光純薬工業株式会社、カタログ番号:537−02305)と酸化アルミニウムを通してろ過した。得られたろ液を濃縮したところ、3.3gの黒褐色固体を得た。得られた固体を、シリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:酢酸エチル=20:1)により精製したところ、目的化合物の赤橙色固体を150mg、収率5%で得た。ステップ4の合成スキームを以下(E−4)に示す。
以下に、本実施例で作製した発光素子の作製方法を示す。
ガラス基板上に電極101として、ITSO膜を厚さが70nmになるように形成した。なお、電極101の電極面積は、4mm2(2mm×2mm)とした。
発光素子5乃至発光素子16及び比較発光素子17乃至比較発光素子29は先に示す発光素子1乃至発光素子4と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子1と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表1乃至表3に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した発光素子1乃至発光素子16及び比較発光素子17乃至比較発光素子29の特性を測定した。輝度およびCIE色度の測定には色彩輝度計(トプコン社製、BM−5A)を用い、電界発光スペクトルの測定にはマルチチャンネル分光器(浜松ホトニクス社製、PMA−11)を用いた。
次に、各発光素子の発光層に用いた、4,6mCzP2Pm及びIr(ppz)3の電気化学的特性(酸化反応特性および還元反応特性)をサイクリックボルタンメトリ(CV)測定によって測定した。測定方法は実施例5に記載の方法と同様である。
図44に各ゲスト材料における、ゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図44より保護基を有するゲスト材料を用いた、本発明の一態様の発光素子1乃至発光素子16では、比較発光素子17乃至比較発光素子28と比べ、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が抑制されていることが分かる。上述のように、比較発光素子17乃至比較発光素子28に用いた蛍光性材料をゲスト材料に用い、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換できる機能を有する材料をホスト材料に用いた蛍光発光素子において、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くすると発光効率が大きく低下してしまう問題があった。比較発光素子17乃至比較発光素子28ではゲスト材料濃度を1wt%から10wt%まで変化させると外部量子効率が40%乃至50%程度低下してしまう。すなわち、比較発光素子17乃至比較発光素子28ではデクスター機構によるエネルギー移動を抑制できていないことが示されている。一方、本発明の一態様である保護基を有する蛍光性材料をゲスト材料として用いた発光素子では、該効率の低下を抑制できる。また、ゲスト材料によっては、濃度を上げることによって、発光効率が向上することも示された。これは、保護基を有するゲスト材料を発光層に用いることで、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動および三重項励起エネルギーの失活が抑制されるためである。さらに、ゲスト材料の濃度を上げることによってホスト材料からゲスト材料へのフェルスター機構による励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を効率良く利用できるため、三重項励起エネルギーと一重項励起エネルギーの双方を蛍光性材料の発光へ効率よく変換することができるからである。特に、発光団にジフェニルアミノ基が結合し、該フェニル基に2つの保護基を有し、該2つの保護基がフェニル基の3位および5位に結合している、2tBu−mmtBuDPhA2Anth及び2,6tBu−mmtBuDPhA2Anthをゲスト材料に用いた、発光素子5乃至8及び発光素子13乃至16では特に該効果が大きいことが分かった。該結合位置に保護基を有することによって、効率良く発光団をホスト材料から遠ざけることが可能であることが示唆される。以上より、本発明の一態様の発光素子によって、ゲスト材料濃度が高く、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができることが分かった。
次に各ゲスト材料における、濃度による発光速度の違いについて調査するために各発光素子の蛍光寿命測定を行った。測定にはピコ秒蛍光寿命測定システム(浜松ホトニクス社製)を用いた。本測定では、発光素子における蛍光発光の寿命を測定するため、発光素子に矩形パルス電圧を印加し、その電圧の立下りから減衰していく発光をストリークカメラにより時間分解測定した。パルス電圧は10Hzの周期で印加し、繰り返し測定したデータを積算することにより、S/N比の高いデータを得た。また、測定は室温(300K)で、発光素子の輝度が1000cd/m2付近になるよう印加パルス電圧を3Vから4V付近で印加し、印加パルス時間幅が100μsec、負バイアス電圧が−5V(素子駆動のOFF時)、測定時間範囲が20μsecの条件で行った。測定結果を図45乃至図51に示す。なお、測定結果を図45乃至図51において、縦軸は、定常的にキャリアが注入されている状態(パルス電圧のON時)における発光強度で規格化した強度で示す。また、横軸は、パルス電圧の立下りからの経過時間を示す。
次に、発光素子1乃至発光素子16の0.5mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図52乃至図55に示す。図52乃至図55からゲスト材料濃度を高めると、信頼性が良好になることが分かった。これは、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、発光層内の励起エネルギーを効率良くゲスト材料の発光に変換できていることを示唆している。すなわち、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのフェルスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動速度を高めることができていることが示唆される。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子では、ゲスト材料の濃度を高めることができ、発光効率及び信頼性が良好な発光素子を得ることができる。
次に、発光素子4、発光素子8、比較発光素子17、比較発光素子21、比較発光素子25及び比較発光素子29について0.5mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図69に示す。
以下に、本実施例で作製した発光素子の作製方法を示す。
ガラス基板上に電極101として、ITSO膜を厚さが70nmになるように形成した。なお、電極101の電極面積は、4mm2(2mm×2mm)とした。
発光素子31乃至発光素子33及び比較発光素子34乃至比較発光素子36は先に示す発光素子30の作製方法と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子30と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表6及び表7に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した発光素子30乃至発光素子33及び比較発光素子34乃至比較発光素子36の特性を測定した。なお、測定方法は実施例6と同様である。
次に、発光素子30乃至発光素子33及び比較発光素子34乃至比較発光素子36の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図58に示す。図58から発光素子30乃至発光素子33、比較発光素子34及び比較発光素子36は輝度30%減少時間が500時間を越える良好な信頼性を有することが分かった。また、本測定のように、発光素子に加える電流負荷を各発光素子で同じ条件で信頼性を評価した場合、発光素子30乃至発光素子33、比較発光素子34及び比較発光素子36の信頼性は概ね同様な結果となった。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子は高効率かつ高信頼性な発光素子を得ることができる。
発光素子37乃至発光素子40は、先に示す発光素子1の作製と、発光層130のゲスト材料のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は、発光素子1と同様の作製方法とした。
比較発光素子41乃至比較発光素子44は先に示す発光素子37乃至発光素子40と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子1と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表9及び表10に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した発光素子37乃至発光素子40及び比較発光素子41乃至比較発光素子44の特性を測定した。なお、測定方法は実施例6と同様である。
図63に各ゲスト材料における、ゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図63より保護基を有するゲスト材料を用いた、本発明の一態様の発光素子37乃至発光素子40では、比較発光素子41乃至比較発光素子44と比べ、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が抑制されていることが分かる。よって、上述のように、本発明の一態様の発光素子は、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くしても、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を抑制し、三重項励起エネルギーの無放射失活を抑制できるため、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができる。
次に、上記作製した発光素子37乃至発光素子40及び比較発光素子41乃至比較発光素子44の蛍光寿命を測定した。なお、測定方法は実施例1と同様である。その結果を図64及び図65に示す。
発光素子45は、先に示す発光素子30の作製と、発光層130のゲスト材料のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は、発光素子30と同様の作製方法とした。
比較発光素子46は先に示す発光素子45の作製方法と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子45と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表12に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した発光素子45及び比較発光素子46の特性を測定した。なお、測定方法は実施例6と同様である。
2.7g(11mmol)の2−トリメチルシリルアントラセンを500mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。ここに110mLのN,N−ジメチルスルホキシドを加え、室温で撹拌した。ここに4.0g(23mmol)のN−ブロモスクシンイミドを加え、室温で15時間撹拌した。撹拌後、この反応混合物に水を加え水層と有機層を得た。水層をトルエンで抽出し、得られた抽出液と有機層を合わせた。抽出液と有機層の混合溶液を水と、飽和チオ硫酸ナトリウム水溶液で洗浄後、硫酸マグネシウムで乾燥した。この混合物を自然ろ過により濾別し、濾液を濃縮して黄褐色固体を得た。得られた黄褐色固体にヘキサン450mLとトルエン50mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、黄褐色固体を得た。得られた固体を酢酸エチル/エタノールにて再結晶し、黄色固体を2.4g、収率54%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(F−1)に示す。
1.4g(3.3mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−トリメチルシリルアントラセンと、2.6g(6.6mmol)のビス(3,5−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミンと、1.3g(14mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に33mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で6時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン400mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=9:1)により精製したところ、黄色固体を得た。得られた黄色固体を酢酸エチルとエタノールにて再結晶したところ、目的物の黄色固体を0.40g、収率12%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(F−2)に示す。
8.2g(32mmol)の3,5−ジシクロヘキシルフェノールを1Lナスフラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。ここに130mLのジクロロメタンと、12mL(86mmol)のトリエチルアミンを加え、0℃で撹拌した。ここに8mL(48mmol)のトリフルオロメタンスルホン酸無水物の50mLジクロロメタン溶液を滴下し、温度を室温に戻しながら3時間撹拌した。撹拌後、この混合物に1N塩酸を加え、水層をジクロロメタンで抽出した。得られた抽出液と有機層を合わせ、水と、飽和食塩水で洗浄後、硫酸マグネシウムで乾燥した。この混合物を自然ろ過により濾別し、濾液を濃縮して褐色油状物を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン)により精製したところ、目的物の無色油状物を11g、収率84%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(G−1)に示す。
3.9g(10mmol)の3,5−ジシクロヘキシルフェニルトリフルオロメタンスルホン酸を200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。ここに20mLのテトラヒドロフラン(略称:THF)と、2.5g(12mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルアニリンと4.6g(14mmol)の炭酸セシウムと、0.6g(0.96mmol)の(±)−2,2’−ビス(ジフェニルホスフィノ)−1,1’−ビナフチル(略称:(±)−BINAP)を加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に0.14g(0.62mmol)の酢酸パラジウム(II)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、70℃で14時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン300mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、赤褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=17:3)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色固体を3.2g、収率72%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(G−2)に示す。
1.4g(3.4mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−フェニルアントラセンと、3.2g(7.2mmol)の3,5−ジ−シクロヘキシル−3’,5’−ジ−tert−ブチルジフェニルアミンと、1.3g(14mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に35mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で7時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン300mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。
1.4g(3.5mmol)の3,5−ジシクロヘキシルフェニルトリフルオロメタンスルホン酸を200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。ここに10mLのTHFと、0.91g(3.5mmol)の3,5−ジ−シクロヘキシルアニリンと1.6g(4.9mmol)の炭酸セシウムと、0.40g(0.64mmol)の(±)−BINAPを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に0.10g(0.45mmol)の酢酸パラジウム(II)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、70℃で24時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン500mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色油状物を得た。この油状物をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=4:1)により精製したところ、目的物の白色固体を0.90g、収率52%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(H−1)に示す。
0.35g(0.85mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−フェニルアントラセンと、0.85g(1.7mmol)のビス(3,5−シクロヘキシルフェニル)アミンと、0.34g(3.5mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosと、を200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に10mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で7時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン500mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライトの固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=4:1)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色固体を得た。得られた黄色固体をHPLC(展開溶媒:クロロホルム)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色固体を0.19g、収率18%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(H−2)に示す。
2.5g(10mmol)の3,5−ジブロモアニリンと、4.9g(21mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニルボロン酸と、0.27g(0.89mmol)のトリ−ο−トリルホスフィンを500mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に75mLのトルエンと、25mLのエタノールと、20mLの2M炭酸カリウム水溶液を加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(0.18mmol)の酢酸パラジウム(II)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、90℃で7時間攪拌した。撹拌後、この混合物に水を加え、水層をトルエンで抽出した。得られた抽出液と有機層を合わせ、水と、飽和食塩水で洗浄後、硫酸マグネシウムで乾燥した。この混合物を自然ろ過により濾別し、濾液を濃縮して褐色油状物を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:トルエン)により精製したところ、目的物の茶白色固体を1.8g、収率37%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(J−1)に示す。
0.72g(2.7mmol)の1−ブロモ−3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルベンゼンと、1.3g(2.7mmol)の3,5−ビス(3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニル)アニリンと、0.50g(5.2mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に30mLのトルエンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に0.30mL(97μmol)のトリ−tert−ブチルホスフィン(10w%ヘキサン溶液)と40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、90℃で3時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン300mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=17:3)により精製したところ、目的物の茶白色固体を1.3g、収率71%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(J−2)に示す。
0.80g(1.9mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−フェニルアントラセンと、1.3g(1.9mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチル−3’,5’−ビス(3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルフェニル)ジフェニルアミンと、0.36g(3.7mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、0.18g(0.44mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に10mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に0.12g(0.21mmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で20時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン400mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=9:1)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色固体を得た。得られた黄色固体をヘキサンとメタノールにて再結晶したところ、目的物の黄色固体を0.30g、収率20%で得た。ステップ3の合成スキームを下記(J−3)に示す。
1.8g(3.6mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2,6−ジフェニルアントラセンと、2.8g(7.2mmol)のビス(3,5−tert−ブチルフェニル)アミンと、1.4g(15mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に36mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で3時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン400mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=9:1)により精製したところ、黄色固体を得た。得られた黄色固体を酢酸エチルとエタノールにて再結晶したところ、目的物の黄色固体を0.61g、収率15%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(K−1)に示す。
0.87g(3.5mmol)の3,5−ジブロモアニリンと、2.0g(7.0mmol)の4−シクロヘキシルフェニルボロン酸ピナコールエステルと、0.28g(0.92mmol)のトリ−ο−トリルホスフィンを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に20mLのトルエンと、5mLのエタノールと、7mLの2M炭酸カリウム水溶液を加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(0.18mmol)の酢酸パラジウム(II)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、90℃で9時間攪拌した。撹拌後、この混合物に水を加え、水層をトルエンで抽出した。得られた抽出液と有機層を合わせ、水と、飽和食塩水で洗浄後、硫酸マグネシウムで乾燥した。この混合物を自然ろ過によりろ別し、ろ液を濃縮して褐色油状物を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:トルエン)により精製したところ、目的物の茶白色固体を0.95g、収率67%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(L−1)に示す。
1.4g(5.2mmol)の1,3−ジブロモ−5−クロロベンゼンと、3.0g(10mmol)の4−シクロヘキシルフェニルボロン酸ピナコールエステルと、0.28g(0.92mmol)のトリ−ο−トリルホスフィンを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に30mLのトルエンと、10mLのエタノールと、10mLの2M炭酸カリウム水溶液を加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に60mg(0.27mmol)の酢酸パラジウム(II)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、90℃で13時間攪拌した。撹拌後、この混合物に水を加え、水層をトルエンで抽出した。得られた抽出液と有機層を合わせ、水と、飽和食塩水で洗浄後、硫酸マグネシウムで乾燥した。この混合物を自然ろ過によりろ別し、ろ液を濃縮して褐色油状物を得た。この油状物をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン)により精製したところ、目的物の白色固体を0.95g、収率43%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(L−2)に示す。
0.95g(2.2mmol)の1−クロロ−3,5−ビス(4−シクロヘキシルフェニル)ベンゼンと、0.95g(2.3mmol)の3,5−ビス(4−シクロヘキシルフェニル)アニリンと、0.44g(4.6mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、50mg(0.14mmol)のn−ブチルジアダマンチルホスフィンを100mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に15mLのトルエンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に30mg(52μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、120℃で4時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン500mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=3:2)により精製したところ、目的物の白色固体を1.4g、収率79%で得た。ステップ3の合成スキームを下記(L−3)に示す。
0.35g(0.85mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−フェニルアントラセンと、1.4g(1.8mmol)のビス[3,5−ビス(4−シクロヘキシルフェニル)フェニル]アミンと、0.34g(3.5mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に10mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で6時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン500mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=4:1)により精製したところ、黄色固体−1を得た。得られた黄色固体−1をトルエンと酢酸エチルにて再結晶したところ、黄色固体−2を得た。得られた黄色固体−2をHPLC(展開溶媒:クロロホルム)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色固体を0.68g、収率43%で得た。ステップ3の合成スキームを下記(L−4)に示す。
2.0g(6.6mmol)の3,5−ビス(トリメチルシリル)ブロモベンゼンと、1.6g(7.8mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルアニリンと、1.5g(16mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に35mLのトルエンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に0.40mL(0.13mmol)のトリ−tert−ブチルホスフィン(10w%ヘキサン溶液)と60mg(0.10mol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、90℃で1時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン500mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色油状物を得た。この褐色油状物をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=9:1)により精製したところ、目的物の無色油状物を2.8g、収率99%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(M−1)に示す。
1.3g(3.1mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−フェニルアントラセンと、2.8g(6.5mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチル−3’,5’−ジ−トリメチルシリルジフェニルアミンと、1.2g(12mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に35mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で7時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン500mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色固体を得た。この固体をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=9:1)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色固体を得た。得られた黄色固体を酢酸エチルとエタノールにて再結晶したところ、目的物の黄色固体を0.31g、収率9%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(M−2)に示す。
発光素子75乃至発光素子98及び比較発光素子99乃至比較発光素子103は先に示す発光素子30の作製方法と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子30と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表14乃至表17に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した発光素子76乃至発光素子98及び比較発光素子99乃至比較発光素子103の特性を測定した。測定は実施例6と同様に行った。
図126に各ゲスト材料における、ゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図126より保護基を有するゲスト材料を用いた、本発明の一態様の発光素子75乃至発光素子98では、比較発光素子99乃至比較発光素子102と比べ、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が抑制されていることが分かる。よって、上述のように、本発明の一態様の発光素子が、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くしても、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を抑制し、三重項励起エネルギーの無放射失活を抑制できるため、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができる。
次に、発光素子76乃至発光素子98及び比較発光素子103の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図127乃至図132に示す。図127乃至図132からゲスト材料濃度を高めると、信頼性が良好になることが分かった。これは、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、発光層内の励起エネルギーを効率良くゲスト材料の発光に変換できていることを示唆している。すなわち、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのフェルスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動速度を高めることができていることが示唆される。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子では、ゲスト材料の濃度を高めることができ、発光効率及び信頼性が良好な発光素子を得ることができる。また、比較発光素子99乃至比較発光素子102の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験の結果を図133に示した。
次に発光素子79乃至発光素子82、発光素子87乃至発光素子90及び比較発光素子99乃至比較発光素子103における、濃度による発光速度の違いについて調査するために各発光素子の蛍光寿命測定を行った。測定は先に示す実施例と同様に行った。その結果を図134乃至図136に示す。
発光素子104乃至発光素子127は先に示す発光素子1と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子1と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表20乃至表23に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した発光素子104乃至発光素子127の特性を測定した。測定は実施例6と同様に行った。
図149に各ゲスト材料における、ゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図149より保護基を有するゲスト材料を用いた、本発明の一態様の発光素子104乃至発光素子127では、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が抑制されていることが分かる。また、濃度によってはゲスト材料を添加することによって、発光効率が向上していることが分かる。よって、上述のように、本発明の一態様の発光素子は、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くしても、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を抑制し、三重項励起エネルギーの無放射失活を抑制できるため、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができる。
次に、発光素子104乃至発光素子127の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図150乃至図155に示す。図150乃至図155からゲスト材料濃度を高めると、信頼性が良好になることが分かった。これは、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、発光層内の励起エネルギーを効率良くゲスト材料の発光に変換できていることを示唆している。すなわち、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのフェルスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動速度を高めることができていることが示唆される。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子では、ゲスト材料の濃度を高めることができ、発光効率及び信頼性が良好な発光素子を得ることができる。
次に発光素子104乃至発光素子119及び発光素子124乃至発光素子127における濃度による発光速度の違いについて調査するために各発光素子の蛍光寿命測定を行った。測定は先に示す実施例と同様に行った。その結果を図156乃至図160に示す。
2.0g(6.1mmol)の1−ブロモ−3,5−ジヘキシルベンゼンと、1.3g(6.3mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチルアニリンと、1.2g(12mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に35mLのトルエンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に0.40mL(0.13mmol)のトリ−tert−ブチルホスフィン(10w%ヘキサン溶液)と60mg(0.10mol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、80℃で6時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン300mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色油状物を得た。この褐色油状物をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=9:1)により精製したところ、目的物の無色油状物を2.6g、収率94%で得た。ステップ1の合成スキームを下記(N−1)に示す。
1.2g(2.9mmol)の9,10−ジブロモ−2−フェニルアントラセンと、2.6g(5.8mmol)の3,5−ジ−tert−ブチル−3’,5’−ジヘキシルジフェニルアミンと、1.1g(11mmol)のナトリウム t−ブトキシドと、60mg(0.15mmol)のSPhosを200mL三口フラスコに入れ、フラスコ内を窒素置換した。この混合物に30mLのキシレンを加え、この混合物を減圧脱気した後、混合物に40mg(70μmol)のビス(ジベンジリデンアセトン)パラジウム(0)を加え、この混合物を窒素気流下、150℃で7時間攪拌した。撹拌後、得られた混合物にトルエン300mLを加えてから、フロリジール、セライト、酸化アルミニウムを通して吸引ろ過し、ろ液を得た。得られたろ液を濃縮し、褐色油状物を得た。この油状物をシリカゲルカラムクロマトグラフィー(展開溶媒:ヘキサン:トルエン=10:1)により精製したところ、目的物の黄色油状物を得た。得られた黄色油状物を超臨界流体クロマトグラフィー(略称:SFC)および、高速液体クロマトグラフィー(略称:HPLC)(展開溶媒:クロロホルム)にて精製したところ、目的の黄色固体を50mg、収率1.5%で得た。ステップ2の合成スキームを下記(N−2)に示す。
発光素子128乃至発光素子130及び比較発光素子131は、先に示す発光素子79と、発光層130のホスト材料、ゲスト材料の濃度及び電子輸送層118(1)の材料のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は、発光素子79と同様の作製方法とした。
発光素子128乃至発光素子130の正孔輸送層112上に発光層130として、4,8−ビス[3−(ジベンゾチオフェン−4−イル)フェニル]ベンゾフロ[3,2−d]ピリミジン(略称:4,8mDBTP2Bfpm)と、PCCPと、GD270と、2,6Ph−mmtBuDPhA2Anthと、を重量比(4,8mDBTP2Bfpm:PCCP:GD270:2,6Ph−mmtBuDPhA2Anthh)が0.5:0.5:0.1:z1になるように、且つ厚さが40nmになるように共蒸着した。発光層130においては、GD270がIrを有する燐光性材料である。また、2,6Ph−mmtBuDPhA2Anthが保護基を有する蛍光性材料である。なお、z1の値は各発光素子によって異なり、各発光素子におけるz1の値は表27に示す値である。
比較発光素子131の正孔輸送層112上に発光層130として、4,8mDBTP2Bfpmと、PCCPと、GD270と、を重量比(4,8mDBTP2Bfpm:PCCP:GD270)が0.5:0.5:0.1となるように、且つ厚さが40nmになるように共蒸着した。比較発光素子131はGD270が燐光を呈する燐光発光素子である。発光素子128乃至発光素子130は比較発光素子131の発光層130に保護基を有する蛍光性材料を添加した素子と見なすことができる。なお、4,8mDBTP2BfpmとPCCPは励起錯体を形成する組合せである。
次に、上記作製した発光素子128乃至発光素子130及び比較発光素子131の特性を測定した。測定は実施例6と同様に行った。
図171に各ゲスト材料における、ゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図171より保護基を有するゲスト材料を用いた、本発明の一態様の発光素子128乃至発光素子130では、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が非常に小さいことが分かる。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子は、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くしても、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を抑制し、三重項励起エネルギーの無放射失活を抑制できるため、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができる。また、本発明の一態様の発光素子に4,8mDBTP2Bfpmのようにベンゾフロピリミジン骨格及び/またはジベンゾチオフェン骨格を有する有機化合物を好適に用いることができることが分かった。
次に、発光素子128乃至発光素子130の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図172に示す。図172からゲスト材料濃度を高めると、信頼性が良好になることが分かった。これは、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、発光層内の励起エネルギーを効率良くゲスト材料の発光に変換できていることを示唆している。すなわち、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのフェルスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動速度を高めることができていることが示唆される。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子では、ゲスト材料の濃度を高めることができ、発光効率及び信頼性が良好な発光素子を得ることができる。
発光素子132乃至発光素子135及び比較発光素子136は、先に示す発光素子79と、発光層130及び正孔輸送層112の材料のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は、発光素子79と同様の作製方法とした。
発光素子132乃至発光素子135の正孔注入層111上に正孔輸送層112として9−[3−(9−フェニル−9H−フルオレン−9−イル)フェニル]−9H−カルバゾール(略称:mCzFLP)を厚さが20nmとなるように蒸着した。
比較発光素子136の正孔注入層111上に正孔輸送層112としてmCzFLPを厚さが20nmとなるように蒸着した。
次に、上記作製した発光素子132乃至発光素子135及び比較発光素子136の特性を測定した。測定は実施例6と同様に行った。
図176にゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図176より本発明の一態様の発光素子では、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が小さいことが分かる。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子は、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くしても、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を抑制し、三重項励起エネルギーの無放射失活を抑制できるため、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができる。また、本発明の一態様の発光素子に励起錯体を好適に用いることができることが分かった。
次に、発光素子132乃至発光素子135の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図177に示す。図177からゲスト材料濃度を高めると、信頼性が良好になることが分かった。これは、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、発光層内の励起エネルギーを効率良くゲスト材料の発光に変換できていることを示唆している。すなわち、ゲスト材料濃度を高めることで、ホスト材料からゲスト材料へのフェルスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動速度を高めることができていることが示唆される。よって、本発明の一態様の発光素子では、ゲスト材料の濃度を高めることができ、発光効率及び信頼性が良好な発光素子を得ることができる。
発光素子137乃至発光素子141及び比較発光素子142は、先に示す発光素子132と、発光層130の材料及び電子輸送層118(1)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は、発光素子132と同様の作製方法とした。
正孔輸送層112上に発光層130として、4mCzBPBfpmと、PCBBiFと、を重量比(4mCzBPBfpm:PCBBiF)が0.8:0.2になるように、且つ厚さが40nmになるように共蒸着した。比較発光素子131からは後述するように4mCzBPBfpmと、PCBBiFが形成する励起錯体からの発光が観測される。また、発光素子137乃至発光素子141は比較発光素子142の発光層に各ゲスト材料を添加した素子とみなすことができる。
次に、上記作製した発光素子137乃至発光素子141及び比較発光素子142の特性を測定した。測定は実施例6と同様に行った。
次に、発光素子137乃至発光素子141の2.0mAにおける定電流駆動試験を行った。その結果を図180に示す。図180からゲスト材料を添加した本発明の一態様の発光素子の方が比較発光素子141よりも信頼性が良好になることが分かった。これは、保護基を有する蛍光性材料をゲスト材料として添加することで、発光層内の励起エネルギーを効率良くゲスト材料の発光に変換できていることを示唆している。
次に発光素子137乃至発光素子141及び比較発光素子142の蛍光寿命測定を行った。測定は先に示す実施例と同様に行った。その結果を図181に示す。
以下に、本実施例で作製した発光素子の作製方法を示す。
ガラス基板上に電極101として、ITSO膜を厚さが70nmになるように形成した。なお、電極101の電極面積は、4mm2(2mm×2mm)とした。
比較発光素子146乃至比較発光素子149は先に示す発光素子143乃至発光素子145と、発光層130の構成のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は発光素子1と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表35及び表36に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。
次に、上記作製した、発光素子143乃至発光素子145及び比較発光素子146乃至比較発光素子149の特性を測定した。測定は実施例6と同様に行った。
図186に各ゲスト材料における、ゲスト材料濃度と外部量子効率との関係を示す。図186より保護基を有するゲスト材料を用いた、本発明の一態様の発光素子143乃至発光素子145では、濃度の増加に伴う効率の低下が抑制されていることが分かる。一方、保護基を有さないゲスト材料を用いた比較発光素子146乃至比較発光素子148では濃度の増加に伴う効率低下が著しい。よって、上述のように、本発明の一態様の発光素子は、ゲスト材料の濃度を高くしても、エネルギードナーからゲスト材料へのデクスター機構による三重項励起エネルギーのエネルギー移動を抑制し、三重項励起エネルギーの無放射失活を抑制できるため、発光効率が高い発光素子を得ることができる。また、エネルギードナーとしてTADF材料も好適に用いることができることが分かった。
本参考例では、実施例6及び実施例7に用いたゲスト材料を三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有さないホスト材料に分散させた発光素子、すなわち該ゲスト材料を用いた一般的な蛍光発光素子の作製例及びその発光特性について説明する。本参考例で作製した発光素子の構成は図1(A)と同様である。素子構造の詳細を表38乃至表40に示す。また、使用した化合物の構造と略称を以下に示す。なお、他の有機化合物については先の実施例及び実施の形態を参照すればよい。
以下に、本参考例で作製した参考発光素子の作製方法を示す。
ガラス基板上に電極101として、ITSO膜を厚さが70nmになるように形成した。なお、電極101の電極面積は、4mm2(2mm×2mm)とした。
参考発光素子51乃至参考発光素子74は先に示す参考発光素子47乃至参考発光素子50の作製方法と、発光層130に用いた蛍光性材料(ゲスト材料)のみ異なり、それ以外の工程は参考発光素子47乃至参考発光素子50と同様の作製方法とした。素子構造の詳細は表14乃至表16に示す通りであるため、作製方法の詳細は省略する。なお、参考発光素子47乃至参考発光素子62に用いたゲスト材料は、本発明の一態様の発光素子に用いたゲスト材料であり、参考発光素子63乃至参考発光素子74に用いたゲスト材料は比較発光素子に用いたゲスト材料である。
次に、上記作製した参考発光素子47乃至参考発光素子74の特性を測定した。なお、測定方法は実施例6と同様である。
Claims (28)
- 一対の電極間に発光層を有する発光素子であって、
前記発光層は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第1の材料と、一重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第2の材料を有し、
前記第2の材料は、発光団及び5個以上の保護基を有し、
前記発光団は縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環であり、
前記5個以上の保護基は、それぞれ独立に炭素数1以上10以下のアルキル基、置換若しくは無置換の炭素数3以上10以下のシクロアルキル基、炭素数3以上12以下のトリアルキルシリル基のいずれか一を有し、
前記第2の材料から発光が得られる、発光素子。 - 請求項1において、
前記5個以上の保護基のうち、少なくとも4個がそれぞれ独立に、炭素数3以上10以下のアルキル基、置換または無置換の炭素数3以上10以下のシクロアルキル基、炭素数3以上12以下のトリアルキルシリル基のいずれか一である、発光素子。 - 一対の電極間に発光層を有する発光素子であって、
前記発光層は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第1の材料と、一重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第2の材料を有し、
前記第2の材料は、発光団及び少なくとも4つの保護基を有し、
前記発光団は縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環であり、
前記4つの保護基は前記縮合芳香環または前記縮合芳香環とは直接結合せず、
前記4つの保護基はそれぞれ独立に、炭素数3以上10以下のアルキル基、置換若しくは無置換の炭素数3以上10以下のシクロアルキル基、炭素数3以上12以下のトリアルキルシリル基のいずれか一を有し、
前記第2の材料から発光が得られる、発光素子。 - 一対の電極間に発光層を有する発光素子であって、
前記発光層は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第1の材料と、一重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第2の材料を有し、
前記第2の材料は、発光団及び2以上のジアリールアミノ基を有し、
前記発光団は縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環であり、
前記縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環は前記2以上のジアリールアミノ基と結合し、
前記2以上のジアリールアミノ基中のアリール基は、それぞれ独立に、少なくとも1つの保護基を有し、
前記保護基は、炭素数3以上10以下のアルキル基、置換若しくは無置換の炭素数3以上10以下のシクロアルキル基、炭素数3以上12以下のトリアルキルシリル基のいずれか一を有し、
前記第2の材料から発光が得られる、発光素子。 - 一対の電極間に発光層を有する発光素子であって、
前記発光層は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第1の材料と、一重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第2の材料を有し、
前記第2の材料は、発光団及び2以上のジアリールアミノ基を有し、
前記発光団は縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環であり、
前記縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環は前記2以上のジアリールアミノ基と結合し、
前記2以上のジアリールアミノ基中のアリール基は、それぞれ独立に、少なくとも2つの保護基を有し、
前記保護基は、炭素数3以上10以下のアルキル基、置換若しくは無置換の炭素数3以上10以下のシクロアルキル基、炭素数3以上12以下のトリアルキルシリル基のいずれか一を有し、
前記第2の材料から発光が得られる、発光素子。 - 請求項4または請求項5において、
前記ジアリールアミノ基がジフェニルアミノ基である、発光素子。 - 請求項2乃至請求項6のいずれか一項において、前記アルキル基が、分岐鎖アルキル基である発光素子。
- 一対の電極間に発光層を有する発光素子であって、
前記発光層は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第1の材料と、一重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第2の材料を有し、
前記第2の材料は、発光団及び複数の保護基を有し、
前記発光団は縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環であり、
前記複数の保護基を構成する原子の少なくとも一つが、前記縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環の一方の面の直上に位置し、かつ、前記複数の保護基を構成する原子の少なくとも一つが、前記縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環の他方の面の直上に位置し、
前記第2の材料から発光が得られる、発光素子。 - 一対の電極間に発光層を有する発光素子であって、
前記発光層は、三重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第1の材料と、一重項励起エネルギーを発光に変換する機能を有する第2の材料を有し、
前記第2の材料は、発光団及び2以上のジフェニルアミノ基を有し、
前記発光団は縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環であり、
前記縮合芳香環または縮合複素芳香環は前記2以上のジフェニルアミノ基と結合し、
前記2以上のジフェニルアミノ基中のフェニル基は、それぞれ独立に、3位および5位に保護基を有し、
前記保護基は、それぞれ独立に、炭素数3以上10以下のアルキル基、置換若しくは無置換の炭素数3以上10以下のシクロアルキル基、炭素数3以上10以下のトリアルキルシリル基のいずれか一を有し、
前記第2の材料から発光が得られる、発光素子。 - 請求項9において、前記アルキル基が、分岐鎖アルキル基である発光素子。
- 請求項7または請求項10において、
前記分岐鎖アルキル基は4級炭素を有する、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項11のいずれか1項において、
前記縮合芳香環または前記縮合複素芳香環が、ナフタレン、アントラセン、フルオレン、クリセン、トリフェニレン、テトラセン、ピレン、ペリレン、クマリン、キナクリドン、ナフトビスベンゾフランのいずれか一を含む、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項12のいずれか1項において、
前記第1の材料は、第1の有機化合物と第2の有機化合物を有し、
前記第1の有機化合物と前記第2の有機化合物は励起錯体を形成する、発光素子。 - 請求項13において、
前記第1の有機化合物は燐光発光を呈する化合物である、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項12のいずれか1項において、
前記第1の材料が燐光発光を呈する化合物である、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項12のいずれか1項において、
前記第1の材料が熱活性化遅延蛍光を呈する化合物である、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項16のいずれか1項において、
前記第1の材料の発光スペクトルは前記第2の材料の最も長波長側の吸収帯と重なる、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項17のいずれか1項において、
前記発光層において、前記第2の材料の濃度が、2wt%以上30wt%以下である、発光素子。 - 請求項1乃至請求項18のいずれか一項に記載の発光素子と、
カラーフィルタまたはトランジスタの少なくとも一方と、
を有する発光装置。 - 請求項19に記載の発光装置と、
筐体または表示部の少なくとも一方と、
を有する電子機器。 - 請求項1乃至請求項18のいずれか一項に記載の発光素子と、
筐体を有する照明装置。 - 一般式(G1)または(G2)で表される有機化合物。
- 請求項21乃至請求項24のいずれか一項において、
前記アルキル基が、分岐鎖アルキル基である有機化合物。 - 請求項25において、
前記分岐鎖アルキル基は4級炭素を有する有機化合物。 - 請求項22乃至請求項27のいずれか一項に記載の有機化合物のいずれか一または複数を用いた発光素子。
Priority Applications (7)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
DE112019001181.2T DE112019001181T5 (de) | 2018-03-07 | 2019-02-21 | Licht emittierendes Element, Anzeigevorrichtung, elektronisches Gerät, organische Verbindung und Beleuchtungsvorrichtung |
CN201980017679.6A CN111954939A (zh) | 2018-03-07 | 2019-02-21 | 发光元件、显示装置、电子设备、有机化合物及照明装置 |
KR1020207028270A KR20200130348A (ko) | 2018-03-07 | 2019-02-21 | 발광 소자, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 유기 화합물, 및 조명 장치 |
JP2020504470A JP7218348B2 (ja) | 2018-03-07 | 2019-02-21 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 |
US16/977,612 US11950497B2 (en) | 2018-03-07 | 2019-02-21 | Light-emitting element, display device, electronic device, organic compound, and lighting device |
JP2023009348A JP7480372B2 (ja) | 2018-03-07 | 2023-01-25 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 |
JP2024070262A JP2024091882A (ja) | 2018-03-07 | 2024-04-24 | 発光素子 |
Applications Claiming Priority (6)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
JP2018040387 | 2018-03-07 | ||
JP2018-040387 | 2018-03-07 | ||
JP2018131250 | 2018-07-11 | ||
JP2018-131250 | 2018-07-11 | ||
JP2018224768 | 2018-11-30 | ||
JP2018-224768 | 2018-11-30 |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
WO2019171197A1 true WO2019171197A1 (ja) | 2019-09-12 |
Family
ID=67846963
Family Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
PCT/IB2019/051403 WO2019171197A1 (ja) | 2018-03-07 | 2019-02-21 | 発光素子、表示装置、電子機器、有機化合物及び照明装置 |
Country Status (7)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (1) | US11950497B2 (ja) |
JP (3) | JP7218348B2 (ja) |
KR (1) | KR20200130348A (ja) |
CN (1) | CN111954939A (ja) |
DE (1) | DE112019001181T5 (ja) |
TW (1) | TWI844530B (ja) |
WO (1) | WO2019171197A1 (ja) |
Cited By (6)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
JPWO2020217129A1 (ja) * | 2019-04-25 | 2020-10-29 | ||
WO2020229918A1 (ja) * | 2019-05-10 | 2020-11-19 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光デバイス、発光機器、表示装置、電子機器及び照明装置 |
JP2021064641A (ja) * | 2019-10-10 | 2021-04-22 | 国立大学法人九州大学 | 組成物および有機発光素子 |
KR20220044658A (ko) | 2020-10-02 | 2022-04-11 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 디바이스, 에너지 도너 재료, 발광 장치, 표시 장치, 조명 장치, 및 전자 기기 |
JP2023033637A (ja) * | 2018-03-07 | 2023-03-10 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 |
KR20230137317A (ko) | 2021-01-28 | 2023-10-04 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 디바이스, 발광 장치, 전자 기기, 표시 장치,조명 장치 |
Families Citing this family (7)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
KR20210038406A (ko) | 2018-07-27 | 2021-04-07 | 이데미쓰 고산 가부시키가이샤 | 화합물, 유기 일렉트로루미네센스 소자용 재료, 유기 일렉트로루미네센스 소자, 및 전자 기기 |
US11930653B2 (en) | 2019-02-06 | 2024-03-12 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting device, light-emitting appliance, display device, electronic appliance, and lighting device |
TW202110791A (zh) * | 2019-08-29 | 2021-03-16 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 化合物、發光器件、發光裝置、電子裝置及照明設備 |
US12012405B2 (en) | 2019-12-27 | 2024-06-18 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Compound, light-emitting device, light-emitting apparatus, electronic device, and lighting device |
CN113122240B (zh) * | 2021-04-16 | 2023-08-29 | 西北工业大学 | 以碘代咔唑衍生物为主体的主客体掺杂发光材料及制备应用方法 |
CN114958342A (zh) * | 2022-04-29 | 2022-08-30 | 温州大学新材料与产业技术研究院 | 一种磷光性能可调的三组分掺杂发光材料及其制备方法 |
CN116396497B (zh) * | 2023-06-05 | 2023-10-20 | 吉林省卓材新研科技有限公司 | 一种金属有机框架材料及其配体结构和在纳米酶中的应用 |
Citations (6)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
JP2002256168A (ja) * | 2001-03-05 | 2002-09-11 | Toyo Ink Mfg Co Ltd | 蛍光着色剤 |
WO2006098080A1 (ja) * | 2005-03-15 | 2006-09-21 | Idemitsu Kosan Co., Ltd. | 芳香族アミン誘導体及びそれを用いた有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子 |
WO2015198988A1 (ja) * | 2014-06-26 | 2015-12-30 | 出光興産株式会社 | 有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子、有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子用材料、および電子機器 |
US20160104847A1 (en) * | 2014-10-13 | 2016-04-14 | Universal Display Corporation | Novel compounds and uses in devices |
JP2017502516A (ja) * | 2013-12-20 | 2017-01-19 | ユー・ディー・シー アイルランド リミテッド | 非常に短い減衰時間を有する高効率のoledデバイス |
WO2018097153A1 (ja) * | 2016-11-25 | 2018-05-31 | コニカミノルタ株式会社 | 発光性膜、有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子、有機材料組成物及び有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子の製造方法 |
Family Cites Families (100)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
DE69625018T2 (de) | 1995-09-25 | 2003-04-10 | Toyo Ink Mfg Co | Leuchtemittierender Stoff für organische Elektrolumineszensvorrichtung, und organische Elektrolumineszensvorrichtung mit diesem leuchtemittierendem dafür geeignetem Stoff |
DE19803889A1 (de) | 1998-01-31 | 1999-08-05 | Bosch Gmbh Robert | Elektrolumineszierende Anordnung unter Verwendung von dotierten Blendsystemen |
KR100913568B1 (ko) | 1999-05-13 | 2009-08-26 | 더 트러스티즈 오브 프린스턴 유니버시티 | 전계인광에 기초한 고 효율의 유기 발광장치 |
DE60111473T3 (de) | 2000-10-30 | 2012-09-06 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toyota Chuo Kenkyusho | Organische lichtemittierende Bauelemente |
SG2009086778A (en) | 2000-12-28 | 2016-11-29 | Semiconductor Energy Lab Co Ltd | Luminescent device |
TW519770B (en) | 2001-01-18 | 2003-02-01 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | Light emitting device and manufacturing method thereof |
ATE541011T1 (de) | 2001-06-29 | 2012-01-15 | Basf Se | Fluoreszierende diketopyrrolopyrrole |
ITTO20010692A1 (it) | 2001-07-13 | 2003-01-13 | Consiglio Nazionale Ricerche | Dispositivo elettroluminescente organico basato sull'emissione di ecciplessi od elettroplessi e sua realizzazione. |
US6863997B2 (en) | 2001-12-28 | 2005-03-08 | The Trustees Of Princeton University | White light emitting OLEDs from combined monomer and aggregate emission |
US6869695B2 (en) | 2001-12-28 | 2005-03-22 | The Trustees Of Princeton University | White light emitting OLEDs from combined monomer and aggregate emission |
US6951694B2 (en) | 2002-03-29 | 2005-10-04 | The University Of Southern California | Organic light emitting devices with electron blocking layers |
ITBO20020165A1 (it) | 2002-03-29 | 2003-09-29 | Consiglio Nazionale Ricerche | Dispositivo elettroluminescente organico con droganti cromofori |
TWI314947B (en) | 2002-04-24 | 2009-09-21 | Eastman Kodak Compan | Organic light emitting diode devices with improved operational stability |
TWI316827B (en) | 2003-02-27 | 2009-11-01 | Toyota Jidoshokki Kk | Organic electroluminescent device |
JP4531342B2 (ja) | 2003-03-17 | 2010-08-25 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 白色有機発光素子および発光装置 |
KR101391117B1 (ko) | 2003-03-24 | 2014-04-30 | 유니버시티 오브 써던 캘리포니아 | Ir의 페닐-피라졸 착물 |
EP1612202B1 (en) | 2003-04-10 | 2013-07-31 | Idemitsu Kosan Co., Ltd. | Aromatic amine derivative and organic electroluminescent element employing the same |
US7175922B2 (en) | 2003-10-22 | 2007-02-13 | Eastman Kodak Company | Aggregate organic light emitting diode devices with improved operational stability |
JPWO2005108335A1 (ja) | 2004-05-12 | 2008-03-21 | 出光興産株式会社 | 3,8−ジハロゲノ−1,6−置換ピレン及びその製造方法 |
US7597967B2 (en) | 2004-12-17 | 2009-10-06 | Eastman Kodak Company | Phosphorescent OLEDs with exciton blocking layer |
US20060134464A1 (en) | 2004-12-22 | 2006-06-22 | Fuji Photo Film Co. Ltd | Organic electroluminescent element |
JP4559922B2 (ja) | 2005-06-21 | 2010-10-13 | 株式会社東芝 | 蛍光性錯体及びそれを用いた照明装置 |
US20070090756A1 (en) | 2005-10-11 | 2007-04-26 | Fujifilm Corporation | Organic electroluminescent element |
CN101321755B (zh) | 2005-12-01 | 2012-04-18 | 新日铁化学株式会社 | 有机电致发光元件用化合物及有机电致发光元件 |
KR101383126B1 (ko) | 2005-12-05 | 2014-04-09 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 유기금속 착체, 및 이를 사용하는 발광 소자, 발광 장치 및전자 기기 |
TWI423982B (zh) | 2006-03-21 | 2014-01-21 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | 有機金屬錯合物及使用該有機金屬錯合物之發光元件,發光裝置和電子裝置 |
JP5238227B2 (ja) | 2006-12-27 | 2013-07-17 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 有機金属錯体および有機金属錯体を用いた発光素子、発光装置、並びに電子機器 |
JP2008288344A (ja) | 2007-05-16 | 2008-11-27 | Nippon Hoso Kyokai <Nhk> | 有機el素子 |
KR101547159B1 (ko) | 2007-05-18 | 2015-08-25 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광소자 및 발광소자를 포함하는 전자기기 |
US8034465B2 (en) | 2007-06-20 | 2011-10-11 | Global Oled Technology Llc | Phosphorescent oled having double exciton-blocking layers |
US8080811B2 (en) | 2007-12-28 | 2011-12-20 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Method for manufacturing evaporation donor substrate and light-emitting device |
US20110127503A1 (en) | 2008-07-31 | 2011-06-02 | Mitsubishi Chemical Corporation | Composition for organic electroluminescence element, organic thin film, organic electroluminescence element, organic el display device and organic el lighting |
JP5325707B2 (ja) | 2008-09-01 | 2013-10-23 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子 |
KR101596226B1 (ko) | 2008-09-05 | 2016-02-22 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 발광 장치 및 전자기기 |
US8476823B2 (en) | 2009-05-22 | 2013-07-02 | Idemitsu Kosan Co., Ltd. | Organic electroluminescent device |
WO2010148085A1 (en) | 2009-06-16 | 2010-12-23 | The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services | Rna nanoparticles and methods of use |
US8766269B2 (en) | 2009-07-02 | 2014-07-01 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting device, lighting device, and electronic device |
JP2011088887A (ja) | 2009-09-22 | 2011-05-06 | Semiconductor Energy Lab Co Ltd | ハロゲン化ジアリールアミン化合物、およびその合成方法 |
EP2471116B1 (en) | 2009-10-05 | 2013-12-11 | Thorn Lighting Ltd | Multilayer organic device |
KR101352116B1 (ko) | 2009-11-24 | 2014-01-14 | 엘지디스플레이 주식회사 | 백색 유기 발광 소자 |
WO2011070963A1 (ja) | 2009-12-07 | 2011-06-16 | 新日鐵化学株式会社 | 有機発光材料及び有機発光素子 |
TWI415846B (zh) | 2010-03-01 | 2013-11-21 | Semiconductor Energy Lab | 雜環化合物、發光元件、發光裝置、電子裝置、及照明裝置 |
EP2366753B1 (en) | 2010-03-02 | 2015-06-17 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-Emitting Element and Lighting Device |
JP2011213643A (ja) | 2010-03-31 | 2011-10-27 | Canon Inc | 銅錯体化合物及びこれを用いた有機発光素子 |
KR20110122051A (ko) | 2010-05-03 | 2011-11-09 | 제일모직주식회사 | 유기광전소자용 화합물 및 이를 포함하는 유기광전소자 |
EP2628743B1 (en) | 2010-10-13 | 2016-02-24 | Nippon Steel & Sumikin Chemical Co., Ltd. | Nitrogenated aromatic compound, organic semiconductor material, and organic electronic device |
CN106083936A (zh) | 2010-10-22 | 2016-11-09 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | 有机金属配合物、发光元件、发光装置、电子设备及照明装置 |
JP5870045B2 (ja) | 2011-02-07 | 2016-02-24 | 出光興産株式会社 | ビスカルバゾール誘導体及びそれを用いた有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子 |
US10147888B2 (en) | 2011-02-07 | 2018-12-04 | Idemitsu Kosan Co., Ltd. | Biscarbazole derivative and organic electroluminescent element using same |
KR102112440B1 (ko) | 2011-02-16 | 2020-05-18 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자 |
CN105957979B (zh) | 2011-02-16 | 2018-02-23 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | 发光元件 |
WO2012111680A1 (en) | 2011-02-16 | 2012-08-23 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting body, light-emitting layer, and light-emitting device |
US8969854B2 (en) | 2011-02-28 | 2015-03-03 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting layer and light-emitting element |
TWI831058B (zh) | 2011-02-28 | 2024-02-01 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件 |
JP5694019B2 (ja) | 2011-03-17 | 2015-04-01 | 株式会社東芝 | 有機電界発光素子、表示装置および照明装置 |
CN103443950B (zh) | 2011-03-23 | 2016-06-15 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | 发光元件 |
TWI552406B (zh) | 2011-03-25 | 2016-10-01 | 出光興產股份有限公司 | 有機電致發光元件 |
KR101994671B1 (ko) | 2011-03-30 | 2019-07-02 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자 |
KR102310048B1 (ko) | 2011-04-07 | 2021-10-08 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자 |
TWI613195B (zh) | 2011-08-25 | 2018-02-01 | 半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件,發光裝置,電子裝置,照明裝置以及新穎有機化合物 |
EP2787549A4 (en) | 2011-12-02 | 2015-09-23 | Univ Kyushu Nat Univ Corp | ORGANIC DEVICE EMITTING LIGHT AND DELAYED FLUORESCENCE MATERIAL AND COMPONENT USED THEREIN |
KR101803537B1 (ko) | 2012-02-09 | 2017-11-30 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자 |
JP2013232629A (ja) | 2012-04-06 | 2013-11-14 | Semiconductor Energy Lab Co Ltd | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器、および照明装置 |
KR101419810B1 (ko) | 2012-04-10 | 2014-07-15 | 서울대학교산학협력단 | 엑시플렉스를 형성하는 공동 호스트를 포함하는 유기 발광 소자 |
JP6158543B2 (ja) | 2012-04-13 | 2017-07-05 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器、および照明装置 |
JP6158542B2 (ja) | 2012-04-13 | 2017-07-05 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器、および照明装置 |
KR101909775B1 (ko) | 2012-04-20 | 2018-10-18 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 발광 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
KR102198635B1 (ko) | 2012-04-20 | 2021-01-05 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 유기 화합물, 발광 소자, 발광 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
WO2013157591A1 (en) | 2012-04-20 | 2013-10-24 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, light-emitting device, electronic appliance, and lighting device |
US8994013B2 (en) | 2012-05-18 | 2015-03-31 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, light-emitting device, display device, electronic device, and lighting device |
US20140014930A1 (en) | 2012-07-13 | 2014-01-16 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Organic Compound, Light-Emitting Element, Light-Emitting Device, Electronic Device, and Lighting Device |
JP6298602B2 (ja) | 2012-07-31 | 2018-03-20 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器、及び照明装置 |
TWI720697B (zh) | 2012-08-03 | 2021-03-01 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件 |
DE102013214661B4 (de) | 2012-08-03 | 2023-01-05 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Licht emittierendes Element, Licht emittierende Vorrichtung und Beleuchtungsvorrichtung |
JP6312960B2 (ja) | 2012-08-03 | 2018-04-18 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器、照明装置及び複素環化合物 |
KR102358426B1 (ko) | 2012-08-03 | 2022-02-08 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 발광 장치, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
TWI651878B (zh) | 2012-08-03 | 2019-02-21 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件、發光裝置、顯示裝置、電子裝置及照明設備 |
KR102054342B1 (ko) | 2013-08-26 | 2019-12-11 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 발광 장치, 표시 장치, 조명 장치, 및 전자 기기 |
KR102717395B1 (ko) | 2013-12-02 | 2024-10-16 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 표시 모듈, 조명 모듈, 발광 장치, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
DE102015213426B4 (de) | 2014-07-25 | 2022-05-05 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co.,Ltd. | Licht emittierendes Element, Licht emittierende Vorrichtung, elekronisches Gerät, Beleuchtungsvorrichtung und organische Verbindung |
KR102245164B1 (ko) | 2014-08-22 | 2021-04-27 | 엘지디스플레이 주식회사 | 유기 발광 소자 및 그의 제조 방법 |
KR102353647B1 (ko) | 2014-08-29 | 2022-01-20 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
KR102399397B1 (ko) | 2014-09-30 | 2022-05-19 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
KR102409803B1 (ko) | 2014-10-10 | 2022-06-17 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
US9991471B2 (en) | 2014-12-26 | 2018-06-05 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, light-emitting device, display device, and electronic device |
US10903440B2 (en) | 2015-02-24 | 2021-01-26 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, light-emitting device, electronic device, and lighting device |
US10062861B2 (en) | 2015-02-24 | 2018-08-28 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, display device, electronic device, and lighting device |
TWI836636B (zh) | 2015-03-09 | 2024-03-21 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件,顯示裝置,電子裝置,與照明裝置 |
TWI814143B (zh) | 2015-03-09 | 2023-09-01 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件、顯示裝置、電子裝置及照明設備 |
WO2016185321A1 (en) | 2015-05-21 | 2016-11-24 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, display device, electronic device, and lighting device |
TWI837587B (zh) | 2015-05-21 | 2024-04-01 | 日商半導體能源研究所股份有限公司 | 發光元件、顯示裝置、電子裝置、及照明裝置 |
KR20160140393A (ko) | 2015-05-29 | 2016-12-07 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 발광 장치, 표시 장치, 전자 기기 및 조명 장치 |
DE112016003078T5 (de) | 2015-07-08 | 2018-04-26 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Licht emittierendes Element, Anzeigevorrichtung, Elektronisches Gerät und Beleuchtungsvorrichtung |
US20170271610A1 (en) | 2016-03-18 | 2017-09-21 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Light-emitting element, display device, electronic device, and lighting device |
JP6761463B2 (ja) | 2016-03-31 | 2020-09-23 | コニカミノルタ株式会社 | 発光性薄膜及び有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子 |
DE112017002347T5 (de) | 2016-05-06 | 2019-01-17 | Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. | Licht emittierendes Element, Anzeigevorrichtung, elektronisches Gerät und Beleuchtungsvorrichtung |
KR102242294B1 (ko) | 2016-05-06 | 2021-04-19 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 |
CN109994628B (zh) * | 2017-12-29 | 2021-05-04 | 昆山国显光电有限公司 | 有机电致发光器件及有机电致发光器件的制备方法 |
CN111954939A (zh) | 2018-03-07 | 2020-11-17 | 株式会社半导体能源研究所 | 发光元件、显示装置、电子设备、有机化合物及照明装置 |
KR20210010456A (ko) | 2018-05-11 | 2021-01-27 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 소자, 표시 장치, 전자 기기, 유기 화합물, 및 조명 장치 |
-
2019
- 2019-02-21 CN CN201980017679.6A patent/CN111954939A/zh active Pending
- 2019-02-21 US US16/977,612 patent/US11950497B2/en active Active
- 2019-02-21 JP JP2020504470A patent/JP7218348B2/ja active Active
- 2019-02-21 KR KR1020207028270A patent/KR20200130348A/ko not_active Application Discontinuation
- 2019-02-21 DE DE112019001181.2T patent/DE112019001181T5/de active Pending
- 2019-02-21 WO PCT/IB2019/051403 patent/WO2019171197A1/ja active Application Filing
- 2019-03-06 TW TW108107389A patent/TWI844530B/zh active
-
2023
- 2023-01-25 JP JP2023009348A patent/JP7480372B2/ja active Active
-
2024
- 2024-04-24 JP JP2024070262A patent/JP2024091882A/ja active Pending
Patent Citations (6)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
JP2002256168A (ja) * | 2001-03-05 | 2002-09-11 | Toyo Ink Mfg Co Ltd | 蛍光着色剤 |
WO2006098080A1 (ja) * | 2005-03-15 | 2006-09-21 | Idemitsu Kosan Co., Ltd. | 芳香族アミン誘導体及びそれを用いた有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子 |
JP2017502516A (ja) * | 2013-12-20 | 2017-01-19 | ユー・ディー・シー アイルランド リミテッド | 非常に短い減衰時間を有する高効率のoledデバイス |
WO2015198988A1 (ja) * | 2014-06-26 | 2015-12-30 | 出光興産株式会社 | 有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子、有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子用材料、および電子機器 |
US20160104847A1 (en) * | 2014-10-13 | 2016-04-14 | Universal Display Corporation | Novel compounds and uses in devices |
WO2018097153A1 (ja) * | 2016-11-25 | 2018-05-31 | コニカミノルタ株式会社 | 発光性膜、有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子、有機材料組成物及び有機エレクトロルミネッセンス素子の製造方法 |
Cited By (9)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
JP2023033637A (ja) * | 2018-03-07 | 2023-03-10 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 |
JP7480372B2 (ja) | 2018-03-07 | 2024-05-09 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 |
JPWO2020217129A1 (ja) * | 2019-04-25 | 2020-10-29 | ||
WO2020217129A1 (ja) * | 2019-04-25 | 2020-10-29 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光デバイス、発光装置、電子機器、および照明装置 |
WO2020229918A1 (ja) * | 2019-05-10 | 2020-11-19 | 株式会社半導体エネルギー研究所 | 発光デバイス、発光機器、表示装置、電子機器及び照明装置 |
JP2021064641A (ja) * | 2019-10-10 | 2021-04-22 | 国立大学法人九州大学 | 組成物および有機発光素子 |
JP7395136B2 (ja) | 2019-10-10 | 2023-12-11 | 国立大学法人九州大学 | 組成物および有機発光素子 |
KR20220044658A (ko) | 2020-10-02 | 2022-04-11 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 디바이스, 에너지 도너 재료, 발광 장치, 표시 장치, 조명 장치, 및 전자 기기 |
KR20230137317A (ko) | 2021-01-28 | 2023-10-04 | 가부시키가이샤 한도오따이 에네루기 켄큐쇼 | 발광 디바이스, 발광 장치, 전자 기기, 표시 장치,조명 장치 |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
DE112019001181T5 (de) | 2020-12-10 |
KR20200130348A (ko) | 2020-11-18 |
TW201938526A (zh) | 2019-10-01 |
US11950497B2 (en) | 2024-04-02 |
CN111954939A (zh) | 2020-11-17 |
JPWO2019171197A1 (ja) | 2021-03-25 |
US20210043840A1 (en) | 2021-02-11 |
JP7218348B2 (ja) | 2023-02-06 |
JP7480372B2 (ja) | 2024-05-09 |
JP2023033637A (ja) | 2023-03-10 |
JP2024091882A (ja) | 2024-07-05 |
TWI844530B (zh) | 2024-06-11 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
JP7480372B2 (ja) | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 | |
JP7440219B2 (ja) | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 | |
JP7330176B2 (ja) | 発光素子、発光装置、電子機器および照明装置 | |
JP7573082B2 (ja) | 発光デバイス、電子機器及び照明装置 | |
KR20210015825A (ko) | 유기 화합물, 발광 소자, 발광 장치, 전자 기기, 및 조명 장치 | |
JP2024144481A (ja) | 発光デバイス | |
JP2023164891A (ja) | 発光デバイス、電子機器及び照明装置 | |
JPWO2018158659A1 (ja) | 有機化合物、発光素子、発光装置、電子機器、および照明装置 | |
WO2020229918A1 (ja) | 発光デバイス、発光機器、表示装置、電子機器及び照明装置 | |
JP7538132B2 (ja) | 有機化合物、発光デバイス用材料、発光デバイス、発光装置、電子機器及び照明装置 | |
TWI856017B (zh) | 發光元件、顯示裝置、電子裝置、有機化合物及照明設備 | |
JP2024156943A (ja) | 発光デバイス | |
TW202434703A (zh) | 發光元件、顯示裝置、電子裝置、有機化合物及照明設備 | |
TW202434702A (zh) | 發光元件、顯示裝置、電子裝置、有機化合物及照明設備 |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
121 | Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application |
Ref document number: 19764207 Country of ref document: EP Kind code of ref document: A1 |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 2020504470 Country of ref document: JP Kind code of ref document: A |
|
ENP | Entry into the national phase |
Ref document number: 20207028270 Country of ref document: KR Kind code of ref document: A |
|
122 | Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase |
Ref document number: 19764207 Country of ref document: EP Kind code of ref document: A1 |